A Comprehensive Study of Accounting System and Consolidated Accounting in Vietnam Focusing On The Factor Analysis of Consolidated Financial Statements
A Comprehensive Study of Accounting System and Consolidated Accounting in Vietnam Focusing On The Factor Analysis of Consolidated Financial Statements
Doctoral Dissertation
PHI THI DIEM HONG
Supervisor:
Professor TAKASHI OGURI
i
Chapter 4: DEVELOPMENT OF ECONOMIC GROUPS................................................. 58
4.1. ECONOMIC GROUPS IN VIETNAM....................................................................... 58
4.1.1. A quick tour on literature on economic group development .................................... 58
4.1.2. Current and prospective strategy for development of economic groups .................. 64
4.2. DEVELOPMENT OF ECONOMIC GROUPS AND CONSOLIDATED
ACCOUNTING PRACTICE IN SOME OTHER COUNTRIES .................................... 68
4.2.1. International tendency in converging to IFRS .......................................................... 69
4.2.2. Practice in Japan ....................................................................................................... 70
4.2.3. Practice in China ....................................................................................................... 73
4.2.4. Practice in Germany ................................................................................................. 77
Chapter 5: CURRENT SITUATION OF CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS PREPARATION BY ECONOMIC GROUPS IN VIETNAM ................ 81
5.1. DATA BACKGROUND ............................................................................................... 81
5.1.1. Overview of target economic groups........................................................................ 81
5.1.2. Overview of targets outside economic group ........................................................... 83
5.2. PRIMARY DATA ......................................................................................................... 85
5.2.1. View by economic groups ........................................................................................ 85
5.2.2. View by targets outside economic group ................................................................. 87
5.3. CURRENT SITUATION OF CFS PREPARATION ................................................ 90
Chapter 6: EXAMINATION OF FACTORS INFLUENCING CFS PREPARATION BY
ECONOMIC GROUPS IN VIETNAM ................................................................................. 99
6.1. IDENTIFYING THE FACTORS ............................................................................ 99
6.1.1. Hypothesis and Tests for normality, reliability and validity of data ........................ 99
6.1.2. Factor exploration ................................................................................................... 114
6.2. EVALUATING THE FACTORS .............................................................................. 116
6.2.1. Influence by each factor ......................................................................................... 116
6.2.2. Correlation among factors in CFS preparation ....................................................... 123
Chapter 7: CONCLUSIONS................................................................................................. 127
7.1. SUMMARY.................................................................................................................. 127
7.2. MAJOR FINDINGS.................................................................................................... 127
7.2.1. Some casual points on establishment and operation of economic groups .............. 127
7.2.2. Current limited capital market and small demand for CFSs .................................. 128
7.2.3. Poor management of CFS qualify .......................................................................... 128
7.2.4. Legal framework as an influencing factor but not as the most influencing...................... 129
7.2.5. Internal regulation and business characteristics as two biggest influencing factors
.......................................................................................................................................... 130
7.2.6. Managers and accounting staffs’ knowledge influencing paradoxically CFS preparation .. 130
7.2.7. Building frame of factor analysis in CFS preparation ............................................ 131
7.2.8. No way rather than gradually harmonizing with IFRSs ......................................... 131
7.3. RECOMMENDATIONS ............................................................................................ 131
7.4. FURTHER CONSIDERATIONS AND CONCLUSIONS ...................................... 133
REFERENCES ....................................................................................................................... 135
APPENDIX ............................................................................................................................. 154
ii
LIST OF ABBREVIATIONS
AD Anno Domini (Refer to the years after the birth of Jesus Christ)
BC Before Christ
EU Europe Union
FS Financial Statement
iii
MOF Ministry of Finance
WB World Bank
iv
LIST OF TABLES
Table 3.1: Key points of legal reformation and international integration.................................. 31
Table 3.2: National hierarchy of legal proclamation in Vietnam .............................................. 32
Table 3.3: Relationship among convergence, harmonization and adoption .............................. 54
Table 3.4: Non-convergence areas in consolidated accounting between VAS and IFRS ......... 56
Table 4.1: Listed companies following characteristics of consolidation and business types
before listed in stock market ....................................................................................... 66
Table 4.2: Characteristics of legislation for consolidated accounting in Japan, China and
Germany...................................................................................................................... 80
Table 5.1: Ownership, business or industrial area and market of target economic groups ....... 81
Table 5.2: Parent and subsidiary company of groups listed in stock market ............................. 82
Table 5.3: Characteristics of economic groups in CFS preparation .......................................... 83
Table 5.4: Occupation and working experience of interviewees (outside economic group) ..... 83
Table 5.5: Working experience and CPA ownership duration (outside economic group) ........ 84
Table 5.6: Obstacles to CFS preparation (views of target economic groups) ........................... 85
Table 5.7: Knowledge of accountants/staffs on consolidated accounting (views of target economic
groups) ......................................................................................................................... 86
Table 5.8: Internal regulations for consolidated accounting in Vietnamese groups .................. 86
Table 5.9: Obstacles to CFS preparation (views of outside economic group)........................... 87
Table 5.10: Evaluation about accounting technique and staffs’ skill and knowledge by targets
outside economic group .............................................................................................. 88
Table 5.11: Details of current legal framework ......................................................................... 88
Table 5.12: Shortcomings of managers’ knowledge and internal governance .......................... 89
Table 5.13: Motivation of CFS preparation by Vietnamese groups .......................................... 90
Table 5.14: CFSs’ received Authorities ..................................................................................... 90
Table 5.15: Kinds of financial statements for entire group and reasons for not making CFSs . 91
Table 5.16: Accounting techniques for investment ................................................................... 92
Table 5.17: Accounting techniques for goodwill ....................................................................... 93
Table 5.18: Accounting techniques for NCI .............................................................................. 94
Table 5.19: Views in working out internal regulations.............................................................. 94
Table 5.20: Inappropriate points in internal regulations ............................................................ 95
Table 5.21: Contents of internal regulations for consolidated accounting ................................ 95
Table 5.22: Accounting adjustments and recognitions for business combination ..................... 96
Table 5.23: Training courses and approach to improve academic knowledge on CFSs ........... 96
v
Table 5.24: Obstacles of CFS preparation (views of whole sample) ......................................... 97
Table 5.25: Inappropriate aspects of regulation system............................................................. 97
Table 6.1: Survey contents in testing hypothesis 1 .................................................................... 99
Table 6.2: Survey contents in testing hypothesis 2 .................................................................. 100
Table 6.3: Survey contents in testing hypothesis 3 .................................................................. 101
Table 6.4: Survey contents in testing hypothesis 4 .................................................................. 102
Table 6.5: Survey contents in testing hypothesis 5 .................................................................. 103
Table 6.6: Overview of total samples ...................................................................................... 103
Table 6.7: Tests’ contents for normality and validity .............................................................. 104
Table 6.8: Descriptive statistics of relationship between occupation and having CPA........... 104
Table 6.9: Chi-Square Tests of relationship between occupation and having CPA ................ 105
Table 6.10: Directional Measures of relationship between occupation and having CPA ....... 105
Table 6.11: Symmetric Measures of relationship between occupation and having CPA ........ 105
Table 6.12: Descriptives .......................................................................................................... 106
Table 6.13: Test of Homogeneity of Variances ....................................................................... 106
Table 6.14: ANOVA ................................................................................................................ 106
Table 6.15: Post Hoc Tests ...................................................................................................... 107
Table 6.16: Ranks of Interviewee’s Job................................................................................... 107
Table 6.17: Test Statistics ........................................................................................................ 107
Table 6.18: Variable Matrix of Tests for reliability................................................................. 108
Table 6.19: Case Processing Summary.................................................................................... 109
Table 6.20: [What is your job] * [the content of VASs is matching]- Crosstabulation ........... 109
Table 6.21: Chi-Square Tests of Correlation between occupation and evaluation of the matching of
VAS ........................................................................................................................... 109
Table 6.22: Directional Measures of Correlation between occupation and evaluation of the
matching of VAS ...................................................................................................... 110
Table 6.23: Symmetric Measures of Correlation between occupation and evaluation of the
matching of VAS ...................................................................................................... 110
Table 6.24: Descriptive [the content of VASs is matching] by ANOVA Test ........................ 110
Table 6.25: Test of Homogeneity of Variances: [the content of VASs is matching], by ANOVA
Test ............................................................................................................................ 110
Table 6.26: ANOVA-One Way: [the content of VASs is matching] and [job] ....................... 111
Table 6.27: Levene's Test of Equality of Error Variances ....................................................... 111
Table 6.28: ANOVA-Two Way for dependent variable: [the content of VASs is matching] . 111
vi
Table 6.29: Ranks of Kruskal-Wallis Test: [Job] and [the matching of VASs] ...................... 112
Table 6.30: Test Statisticsa,b by Kruskal-Wallis Test : [Job] and [the matching of VASs] ... 112
Table 6.31: Chi-Square Tests for Relation between experience and evaluation of internal
regulations ................................................................................................................. 112
Table 6.32: Symmetric Measures of Kendall's tau-b and Gamma for Relation between
experience and evaluation of internal regulations .................................................... 112
Table 6.33: Test of Homogeneity of Variances for Relation between experience and evaluation of
internal regulations ...................................................................................................... 112
Table 6.34: ANOVA-One Way for Relation between experience and evaluation of internal
regulations ................................................................................................................. 113
Table 6.35: Tests of Between-Subjects Effects for Relation between experience and evaluation of
internal regulations ...................................................................................................... 113
Table 6.36: Test Statisticsa,b for Relation between experience and evaluation of internal
regulations ................................................................................................................. 113
Table 6.37: Investigation of obstacles to CFS preparation by two target groups .................... 116
Table 6.38: Evaluation about internal regulations ................................................................... 117
Table 6.39: Main types of inter-transaction in economic groups (views of economic groups)118
Table 6.40: Main accounting entries for inter-transaction of selling goods/products (views of economic
groups) ....................................................................................................................... 118
Table 6.41: Evaluation about accounting staffs’ expertise ...................................................... 119
Table 6.42: Evaluation about accounting staffs’ skill .............................................................. 119
Table 6.43: Differences in evaluation of managers’ knowledge on CFSs ............................... 120
Table 6.44: Evaluation of legal framework by two target groups ........................................... 121
Table 6.45: Different evaluation of business characteristics by two target groups ................. 122
Table 6.46: Different authorities between State and private sectors when submit CFSs ........ 122
Table 6.47: Descriptive Statistics for Factor Analysis............................................................. 123
Table 6.48: Correlation Matrix for Factor Analysis ................................................................ 123
Table 6.49: KMO and Bartlett's Test ....................................................................................... 124
Table 6.50: Communalities for Factor Analysis ...................................................................... 124
Table 6.51: Total Variance Explained ..................................................................................... 124
Table 6.52: Component Matrixa for Factor Analysis .............................................................. 125
Table 6.53: Rotated Component Matrixa for Factor Analysis ................................................. 125
Table 6.54: Component Transformation Matrix ...................................................................... 125
Table 6.55: Component Score Coefficient Matrix ................................................................... 125
Table 6.56: Component Score Covariance Matrix .................................................................. 126
vii
LIST OF FIGURES
Figure 1.1: Research area - Consolidated financial statements ................................................... 5
Figure 1.2: Dissertation struture .................................................................................................. 9
Figure 2.1: Basic diagram of Common Factor........................................................................... 12
Figure 2.2: Simple factor analysis model for CFSs ................................................................... 13
Figure 2.3: Protocol of SERVQUAL model .............................................................................. 13
Figure 2.3: Protocol of SERVQUAL model .............................................................................. 14
Figure 2.4: Factor analysis frame for CFSs ............................................................................... 15
Figure 2.5: Factor analysis process on SPSS ............................................................................. 16
Figure 2.6: Conceptual framework ............................................................................................ 17
Figure 2.7: Analytical framework .............................................................................................. 18
Figure 2.8: Methodological framework ..................................................................................... 19
Figure 2.9: Document analytical map ........................................................................................ 21
Figure 3.1: Sketch of Vietnamese history .................................................................................. 28
Figure 3.2: Accounting historical development in Vietnam ...................................................... 33
Figure 3.3: Current Vietnamese accounting regulation system ................................................. 39
Figure 3.4: Relationship among actors in accounting system.................................................... 42
Figure 3.5: Vietnam accounting regulation system following enterprise types......................... 43
Figure 3.6: Linkage between enterprises and authoritaties in submitting financial reports ...... 44
Figure 3.7: Accounting harmonization process ......................................................................... 55
Figure 4.1: Models of combinative organization ....................................................................... 58
Figure 4.2: Types of business combination ............................................................................... 59
Figure 4.3: Development of Vietnamese economic groups ....................................................... 61
Figure 4.4: A common form of Japanese economic groups ...................................................... 70
Figure 4.5: Accounting regulation system for economic groups (large companies) in Japan ......... 72
Figure 4.6: Common form of State owned economic groups in China ..................................... 74
Figure 4.7: Form of economic groups in Germany.................................................................... 77
Figure 6.1: Survey area of implementation by economic groups for CFS preparation ........... 102
Figure 6.2: Mechanism for influent factor exploration of CFS preparation by primary data .. 114
viii
ACKNOWLEDGMENT
I arrived in Tokyo three years ago (2014) as MEXT holder to study as Ph. D student in
accounting major at Komazawa University. Indeed, I did not know how could pass successfully
this program without the great support of a number of people. I would like to take this opportunity
to acknowledgment and express my deep gratitude to them who gave me encouragement and
enthusiasm to the completion of this thesis.
First of all, I am particularly indebted to my first supervisor, Professor Takashi Oguri, for his
support and encouragement throughout my years of study in Komazawa University. His continual
comments, criticisms and help in weekly research meeting were instrumental in improving my
research ideas in the right direction. In addition, his careful explanation, patience, understanding
and supervising me, especially the help of administrative needs in Japanese, during this program
encouraged me to survive and research well in Tokyo at poor Japanese skill.
To my second supervisor, Professor Junji Ishikawa, I would like to send my sincere thanks
for his academic guidance to me as well as his comments and suggestions on the final draft of
my dissertation.
I also would like to express my special thanks to Mrs. Machiko Oguri, who is my Japanese
teacher, for her help during three years. With her special Japanese lessons in traditional food,
culture or field trip and daily equipment preparation in the first days coming Japan gave me a lot of
exciting views about Japanese society as good motivation to pass the loneliness and homesick.
I wish to record my appreciation to Professor Yosiaki Jinnai and other participants in the ISAF
2014 conference, the 29th and 30th conferences of academic accounting in Komazawa University,
and the specific conferences in Rikki University 2014, Gakushiun University 2016, for their
guidance and support in supervising my research.
My special appreciation is due to Japanese Government (MEXT scholarship) for the financial
support, Financial Accounting Division of Accounting and Business Management Faculty in
Vietnam National University of Agriculture, my working place, for the administrative process,
without their contribution my study would not have been possible.
I am grateful to the officers as well as staffs in Komazawa International Centre and Komazawa
Campus for their assisting and administrative needs. My warm thanks go to a number of
individuals who have supported me in various stages of my study. In the data collection, I greatly
benefited from the officers of VAA, VNCPA, DAP, managers and accountants of economic
groups, my colleagues in university as well as my friends and students, for their support and
encouragement in my study. In the edition, I would like to thank Mrs. Nguyen Thi Thu Huong, an
English lecturer in Vietnam University of Transportation and Communications, for her advices and
editing the final draft.
My appreciation is also directed to my parents, my parents in law, sisters and brothers, for
supporting and accompanying me throughout the many years of this challenging academic journey.
Last, but most importantly, I owe a debt of my great gratitude to my loving husband,
Nguyen Minh Tien, my daughter, Hong Minh, and my son, Minh Duc, for their understanding,
patience and moral support. Their invaluable love, caring and sacrifices helped make this
research work possible.
ix
ABSTRACTS
As a new emerging country in Asia, Vietnam is becoming attractive nation for international
investors (MoiT and UNIDO, [2011], p.10). Since the renovation in 1986,Vietnam’s economy
has changed significantly, for example the average proportions of GDPand the foreign trade
growth have been around 7.5% and nearly 20% per year respectively (Chaponnière and Cling
[2009], p.106). These achievements shifted Vietnam from country of staple food products to
that of the highest export growth rate in Asia in 2007-2008 (ibid, p101), and had become an
important nation of the region. The contribution of this change is Vietnam’s effort in the
regulatory reformation, in which the accounting sector’s improvements have created
significantly fruitful results. Unfortunately, up to now the goals of this renovation have been
not yet reached. Especially the gap between the legal system and its implementation by
enterprises still existed.
During the national economic development, Vietnam had joined many international
organizations (WTO, AFTA, ASIAN, APEC), and now has been facing a lot of tensions of this
integration. It seems more urgent when globalization is worldwide tendency nowadays.
Paradoxically, under conditions of a developing country, Vietnam cannot adopt immediately
all international standards for its national development. Since, it is not simple to successful
integration, while the nation still wants to protect the value of traditional properties. This is
why finding solutions for successful integration of Vietnam has become big concern to not
only the government but also every enterprise.
With focusing on the consolidated accounting that engages the business combination of
economic group, this study was conducted to aim exploring current situations in Vietnam. By
searching influent factors for preparing consolidated financial statements, the study made
contribution to issurance of appropriate solutions to improve this situation.
Starting with research question, through the approach of combining document and data
analysis, the core pictures of history and current development in accounting system and
business combination were described. The contents of respective literature reviews were
presented in Chapters 3 and 4, the information of practical cases were put forward Chapters 5
and 6. In addition to Introduction (Chapter 1) and Conclusion (Chapter 7) sections, the study
atempted to propose the figure, diagram and interpretation to clarify logical methodology in
Chapter 2. The data collection was conducted by a sample survey of 74 interviewees in total,
including 15 of economic groups and 59 of accounting professional. They are the accountants,
managers, auditors, researchers, consultants, lecturers and officials work at different
organizations in Vietnam. By answering the questionnaires, designed for each group of
interviewees, the responders expressed their views on practical side of the consolidated
financial statements. A part from literature review, these views contributed to defining the
influening factors. With the primary data, the study analyzed continuously to explore the
relationship among these factors using the analysis factor tools of SPSS version 20.
The findings indicate that although the convergence of Vietnamese accounting system with
the international accounting standards has increased, the goal of harmonization is still far from
expectation. Typically, the existing system of Vietnamese accounting standards was designed
x
based on most of the content of international accounting standards. While the contents of
international system came out in 2004, Vietnamese standards have not changed. Regarding the
economic groups, they were established in 1990s, still there have been unusual points in their
foundation and operation. Many State-owned groups have been under strict direct control of
government. Therefore, the demand for the consolidated financial statements has been small.
The current capital market and qualification of business managers are important causes of this
situation in Vietnam.
As far as enterprises are concerned, the internal regulations and business characteristics
were found as the biggest influencing factors in preparing consolidated financial statements,
while the legal framework is not the strongest factor as concluded by earlier researchers.
Notably, the study provided the evidences regarding to both of positive and negative influences
on accounting techniques and accounting knowledge respectively for consolidated financial
statements preparation by economic group. The further findings can be taken as one of very
few references on Vietnamese accounting in English, especially in building frame of factor
analysis in the accounting sector.
xi
Chapter 1: INTRODUCTION
1
1.1.3. Accounting regulation and government strategy
In the inadequate conditions of a developing country, Vietnamese accounting system has
also displayed significant obstacles to international integration (Tran [2013]; Phan et
al.[2013]; Nguyen and Gong[2012]; Nguyen and Richard [2012]; Vo and Le [2011]). The
accounting regulations (especially before 2001) included a lot of inappropriate points as Chu
[2004]) commented:
…Vietnamese accounting policy prevents financial statements from giving a faithful
view of the financial position and performance of an enterprise because of a number
of shortcoming, for example, assets are overstated expenses are capitalised, and
reported income does not reflect te real performance of the enterprise [p. 294].
For instance, Vietnamese accounting system still stresses on supplying information to the
local government and higher authorities. The Accounting Law was introduced in 2003 and
most of the existing Vietnamese Accounting Standards (VASs), promulgated in the period
2001-2005, were based on the international accounting standards (IASs). However, these
IASs have been revised several times, specifically upgraded to the IFRSs as far as 2004 while
the existing VASs (except the regulations under standards) have not yet changed. It is noted
at the beginning of issuance, the devergence between IASs and VASs was significant. This
also means the current accounting system in Vietnam has been an asymmetrical system at
least for the purpose of integration. Considering this situation, the government, represented
by the Ministry of Finance (MOF), declared the national intention to rebuild the existing
system of the VASs and the Accounting Law to align with the IFRSs (Chu [2004]; MOF
[2013a,2013b]; Phanet al. [2014]). However, at the time of this study, the results of such
revision have not yet come out.
1.1.4. Accounting technique; Goal of financial reports; and Tendency of previous studies
Many people claim that a financial report is merely a technical matter and plays an
important role in the general welfare (Zimmermann and Werner [2013]). Compared with the
common financial reports, the CFSs often require more techniques for inter-transactions.
These transactions could become so complex in matrix of multi measurements or
recognitions that occur not only two but also more than two entities including both internal
and external groups. Hence, the quality of CFSs is greatly influenced by their accounting
techniques.
According to Nobes and Parker [2000], the CFSs are dominant reports to provide the
financial information that protect the interest of investors and others when making business
decisions. Obviously, the CFSs are considered as the optimal leading option for the
international accounting harmonization. Nevertheless, this seems quite different in Vietnam, for
example: the function of financial statements in general and CFSs in particular in many cases is
for initial expectative presentation of enterprises rather than investors’ willingness (Vu [2007]);
There are cases when the users (including investors and directors) complained that they did not
use the information of the financial statements prepared by their business to make decision for
investment (Vu [2008]; Nguyen [2013]). The main reason for these differences is mostly the
2
asymmetric information between managers and outside equity investors (or the inadequate gap
between users and suppliers of reports). According to Hang Phuong [2012], the frauds on
financial statements at Vietnamese enterprises have been not only in number but also in format
(Hai Phuong [2012]). The mismatches among the numbers on the CFSs before and after
auditing, even before and after listing in the stock market occurred, especially in their
transparent financial information (Nguyen and Nguyen [2013]). It seems critical in some cases
of listed companies not suppling positively their financial reports to meet security market’s
requirements (Tran [2014], p. 93). Consequently, the lack of trust from users in the CFSs in
Vietnam can be caused by wrong adaptation of functions of these reports.
In the researches worldwide (both national and international levels), very few studies
have attempted to investigate into the CFSs in Vietnam, even the less is known about the side
of practical entity. Shortly after the first issuance of VAS on the CFSs in 2003, some studies
on this topic were found, yet most of them were Master theses or lecturers’ reviews. Recently,
there have been more studies on consolidated accounting. However, a lot of them have
focused on theoretical views or a particular case of one business entity/ group of entities. For
example, Doan [2012] studied the case of one private group (Hoang Ha group); Nguyen
[2015] focused on one State group (National Coal –Mineral Industries (VinacominGroup));
Pham [2015] researched the CFSs of a civil engineering construction corporation (Cienco);
Tran [2014] emphasized the side of regulations for the CFSs related to the convergence
between the VASs andthe IFRSs. Typically, up to the time of this study, there have been few
researches (even no researches to directly consider statement problem of the practical side
(economic groups)) in preparation of CFSs in Vietnam.
3
Research questions and hypothesis
1. Why have many economic groups in Vietnam supplied the CFSs with the lack of trust
from the users/investors?
Hypothesis 1: All CFSs of economic groups are prepared based on current accounting
principles, standards and methods in right ways
Hypothesis 2: The CFSs by economic groups are supplied in order to serve the demand of
investor rather than others
2. What are the causes of the negative situation or obstacles at Vietnamese economic
groups in preparing the CFSs?
Hypothesis 3: Most accounting staffs in economic groups have good knowledge of
consolidated accounting.
Hypothesis 4: The current system of VAS on CFSs is fairly fruitful in the case of
economy, at least at the present
3. How do the Vietnamese economic groups comply with VAS and legal framework to
prepare the CFSs?
Hypothesis 5: Do most of Vietnamese economic groups prepare their CFSs by themselves
in absolute harmony with VAS and the current legal framework?
4
enterprises, the growth of business corporations also means more requirements of changes in
company law to protect their functions. On the side of the government, they need to control
successfully the inter-transactions of business entities, especially transactions outside the
borders, by the law on taxation. In contrast, on the side of investors, increasing investment
leads to diversified risks. In order to satisfy these functions, the financial statements are
designed as the facade of accounting to solve the conflicts in society. Through the financial
reports set as a mandatory rule, the business entities often present the accounting information
(or financial situation) mainly to address conflicts within the group of owners, creditors or
employees. Basically, the State organizations also determine the taxable base and vice versa,
that has consequences for the State budget as well as effects from political goals. On the side of
securities market, popularly, the financial statements also provide the core systematic and
quantitative information. They cover most situations of the past, present and future of a
company, and are elements to establish the base for price mechanism of the market. With these
explanations, the financial statements standard in general has been acknowledged as the
important content of accounting system for any nation.
5
existing international accounting regulations. Therefore, the prudent preconception is needed
to discuss whether to create an appropriate system of accounting regulations in harmony.
That is also the explaination for the research area of this study (Figure 1.1).
6
[2008], p.60-61). On the other side – national level, the actors can be understood as a social
entity or an organization able to act on or exert influence on a decision. With combination of
the above definition of actors, the government, enterprises and accounting professional
association are determined as the main actors of macro level, while the bookkeepers,
professional accountant as accounting practitioners; academic researchers; accounting
officials play the role as the actors of micro level in Vietnamese accounting system at least in
this study.
“Economic group” in this study implies any business entity that engages in a combination
of business under the partial consolidation (security holding) or complete consolidation (merger
or amalgamation). It can be when one company acquire a controlling interest in the outstanding
common stock of another company; or one company acquire all of the assets and assume all of
the liabilities of another company (Herring [2003]). Notably, the definition of consolidation
following presentation of Haney [1993, 2003] is provided in more details in Chapter 4.
7
1.4. EXPECTED RESULTS
One of the significant expectations in this study is identification of the factors that have
effects on CFS. This contributes to help business managers make decisions with more
adequate achievements for their groups. Besides, the internal management policy can also be
designed to prepare the CFS with higher quality by referringto the advantages and drawbacks.
Additionally, the results could work as a guideline for policy makers to improve the legal
framework for CFS. Furthermore, the aim of this study is also to enrich the existing literature
in several ways. Firstly, it is one of a few, if not the first, comprehensive study to evaluate the
factors of practical side in preparing the CFSs in Vietnam. Secondly, the survey Statements
used in this research is different from those found in the previous studies related to
Vietnamese CFSs. From the findings of this study, the obvious evidences of the gap between
different levels of accounting regulations or between regulations and implementation were
explored. With these findings, the study will be an invaluable reference for later researches of
the CFSs or business combination sector.
The outputs of the study
1. The list of main factors (influence on the preparing CFS by Vietnamese economic groups)
2. The recommendations are proposed respectively to improve the current status in Vietnam.
3. At least two articles related to the topic of study will be published (one in the national
and another in the international journal or conference).
4. The study will play a certain role to make the CFS field more popular in Vietnam
through the interviewers and the readers.
8
Chapter 1: INTRODUCTION
Present research reasonable, objectives,
research questions and scope of research to
answer question: Why do research this topic?
Chapter 4 investigates into the development of economic groups in Vietnam including the
sketch, and the current and prospective strategies of development. This chapter also
introduces the practices in other countries for development of economic groups as well as the
relationship between economic groups and the growth of consolidated accounting (or the
CFSs). This understanding, then, creates a clearer view of Vietnam’s current case in
international integration progress.
Chapter 5 deals with an overall picture of CFS preparation by Vietnamese economic
groups though the primary data of survey. It is described according to the views of enterprises
(economic groups) and accounting professional sectors. The main information (or data) has
been collected including both general and specific details in accounting adoption to prepare
the CFSs. For example: business size, operating sector, accounting methods, recognition or
measurement of investment, non-controlling interest, goodwill, etc.
Chapter 6 directly explores the factors influencing CFSs preparation in Vietnamese
economic groups. Based on the research results in Chapter 5, the discussion focuses on
9
identification of influencing factors and their linkage. An analysis in-depth by the non-
parametric test in SPSS is undertaken to bring about the reliable information for research.
Chapter 7 supplies a summary of key findings and recommendations of the study. This
chapter also states the actual contributions of research, and proposes further research.
10
Chapter 2: RESEARCH METHODOLOGY
2.1. THEORY OF FACTOR ANALYSIS
As mentioned in the previous chapter, finding influencing factors towards CFSs
preparation is one of the expected results of this study. Accordingly, the factor analysis is
employed to identify the relevant variables in accounting for groups, relating to disclosure of
their consolidated financial statements. Along with its theory, the original content (basic
theory) is provided to answer the question “why it is used”, while the presentation of
improving contents, in the following section, implies how to apply it to this research.
11
Regarding the key technique of complex and multivariate statistical instruments, it is close to
the mathematical procedures to discover patterns of variables (Yong and Pearce [2013], p.79).
It also combines to account for an individual’s degree or levels on the surface attributes
(Tucker and MacCallum [1997], p.4).
Basically, one unobservable characteristic includes two kinds of factors: the first is
specific factor, usually influencing only one of the surface attributes while the second is a
common factor that affects not only two but also more than two surface attributes. In the case
of mistakes in using measurement of analysis, however, there is also another factor as
transient event, namely error of measurement influencing the surface attributes. The
mechanism of relationship between them is expressed in Figure 2.1 bellow:
Common Factors
(Internal Attributes)
Attributes
Specific Factors
(Internal Attributes)
Errors of measurement
Factors
From Figure 2.1, it is not difficult to realize the determination of the nature of the
underlying factors, which is one main purpose of factor analysis. Additionally, the
development of understanding relationships among these and each of them to the surface
attributes is also its another target. These are the reasons why factor analysis is the main
methodology of this study (presented in Figure 2.2). Wherein, the CFSs imply the surface
attribute that can be observed through the disclosure of numbers (data/indicators) and its
interpretation. The relevance, reliability, comparability and understanding ability of financial
information (the number and words of reports) are considered as the main factors of the
internal attributes of the CFSs. They are influenced by the accounting measurement and
recognition that the entity applies to accounting work.
Notably, up to now, many researches have applied the factor analysis to researches in
various aspects, such as human behaviour, health care and medicine, marketing and quality
management, informatics technology, geography and so on (Young and Pearce [2013], p.79).
But in the field of accounting, there have been very few, even not enough studies to create a
normal (or major) option (or tendency) (at least in Vietnam).
12
Relevance
Measurement
Consolidated Reliability
Financial Statement
Data Interpretation
(number) (word) Comparability
Recognition
Specific factors
Internal Attributes
Source: Owned contribution
Figure 2.2: Simple factor analysis model for CFSs
2.1.2. Comply factor analysis to find the influencing factors of financial reports
The primary objective of factor analysis is to determine the volume and nature of
common factors which influence the surface attributes (Tucker and MacCallum [1997], p.16-
17), whereas the advanced factor analysis, nowadays, is used to examine how underlying
constructs influence the response on a number of measured variables including both common
and specific factors (DeCorter [1998]). Its purpose is to resume data so that correlation and
patterns can be easily interpreted and understood (Youngand Pearce, [2013], p.79). Even
though it is similar with “Principle Component Analysis” in declining the number of
variables, the factor analysis differs in observation of variables. It is in linear combinations of
latent variables to exert causal influence and account for the common variance (as opposed to
unique variance) of a total variance (Albright and Park [2009]).
Depending on the study’s context, the exploratory factor analysis (EFA) or confirmatory
factor analysis (CFA), two main types of factor analysis, is chosen for their appropriateness
(Hurley et al. [1997], p.681).The EFA often attempts to discover the nature of constructs
13
influencing a set of responses, while the CFA focuses on the tests whether a specific set of
constructs is effective responses following a predicted way (DesCoter [1998]). The purpose
of EFA is to discover the number of common factors affecting a set of measures. Moreover, it
is also used to examine the weight of relationship in each factor and another observed measure.
But the CFA has the aim of evaluating the ability of pre-defined factor model to fit an observed
set of data. In case of using the CFA for research, the index of goodness-of-fit and re-
specification of the model should be considered. Otherwise, choosing the EFA, the CFA should
be also used together in specific area (Hurley et al. [1997]). Notably, in the case of a researcher
who has no expectation of the number or nature of the factors, the EFA is often chosen rather
than the CFA. This means that the EFA allows the investigator to explore the main variables to
create a theory or model from a relatively large set of latent constructs often represented by set
of variables (Williams et al. [2010], Taherdoost et al. [2014]).
X1
X2
Reliability X3
X4
X X6
Tangible X7
Expected X8
Service X10 X9
Perceived Responsiveness X11
service X12
quality X13 X14
Perceived X15
Service Assurance X16
X18
X19 X17
X20
Empathy X21
X22
Source: Cronin and Taylor [1992]; Parasuraman et al.[1985]
Figure 2.3: Protocol of SERVQUAL model
Under the proposal of factor analysis, in the enormous patterns of research worldwide, the
studies of Parasuman [1985] and Cronin and Taylor [1992] have been successful in assessing
quality of product (or service). Based on investigation of quality in four business services,
they identified the quality of service (Q) under the expectation (E) and the perception value
(P) of customers. Typically, they found the analysis model of quality of service/products
namely SERVQUAL and SERVPERF model. The original theoretical content of them is the
factor analysis of five components following the 22 item scales (Likert type X1-X22) that
come from the individual questions respectively (see Figure 2.3).
With the focus on the CFSs, the influence on report presentation implies the impact of
factor to quality of financial information presented on it. This depends on the way of
disclosure or interpretation of information. Employing the utility of quality analysis in
SERVQUAL and SERVPERF, this study has developed the frame for factor analysis in
details for the CFS following Figure 2.4.
As mentioned in Section 2.1.1, the quality of data or interpretation, demonstrated in the
CFS of entity, has been influenced by the measurement and recognition of accounting, in
which the environment of business and legislation often directly affects accounting technique
of entity. The performance of the existing regulation system (include firm and national level)
14
reflects the legal environment. The environment of business largely depends on human ability,
the size and industry of business or the facility and energy source the enterprise has invested
on it. With the similar regime, it is not difficult to notice that each element (human ability,
business industry,…) is also influenced by others factors at respective level during business
operation.
.
Regulation .
Environment system .
Measurement of Legislation
Number .
CFSs .
of Entity Human ability .
Word
Recognition Business .
Environment Business industry .
.
Business size .
(Facility, energy…) .
.
Source: Owned contribution
Figure 2.4: Factor analysis frame for CFSs
Due to the research objectives, the specific technique of analysis designed for it, and the
levels of factors or variables will be explored. Notably, the sizes of variables, designed for
factor analysis, should have at least 5 to 10 observations for one factor (Young and Pearce
[2013], p.80), and the total number of measured variables should be at least 3 to 5 times of
the number of expected common factors (Fabrigar et al. [1999], p.273). Generally, the
selection of measured factors should include enormous variables influenced by each of
common factors. Normally, if the size of samples is larger, the research achievement is more
explicit and closer to the practical situations (Costello and Osbome [2005]; Taherdoost. et al.
[2014]). In this research, the factor analysis in SPSS is used and the detailed approach of
factor analysis is demonstrated on the analytical framework in the next sections.
15
under the formal title of SPSS in the 1970s[1]. Since 1975 when the SPSS Company was
established, SPSS has been the dominant software of predictive analysis with various
different versions released. Recently, SPSS has become a leader in the predictive analytics
market space that combines both advanced analysis and decision optimization[2]. The process
of factor analysis on SPSS is showed in Figure 2.5
Data input
Determine how many factors Determine how many factors should be retained
should be retained Retain when there are too many factors after extraction
Issue solution of interpretation Factor loading/ Show the correlation between factors and
Factor score coefficients used to produce the factor score
Data output
Notably, both the EFA and CFA are provided on SPSS. Beside the method of factor
rotation and factor loading in the correlation matrix, the SPPS uses the extractive factors to
investigate into the relationships among factors in five main stages: descriptive, extraction,
retain, rotation and scores (Young and Pear [2013]). For extraction, six methods (unweight
least squares, generalized least square, maximum likelihood, principle axis factoring, alpha
factoring and image factoring) are designed, while the rotation got the five different methods
(varimax, quartimax, equamax, direct oblimin and promax). The descriptive statistics of
sample adequacy is often checked by Kaiser-Meyer-Olkin test (KMO test) or Bartlett’s test.
The correlation and covariance are normally calculated to identify the communality of factors
by reproduced matrix or anti-image matrix. The score of the original variables in the
subsequent was commonly tested by ANOVA. The SPSS outputs are presented by rotated
factor matrix and factor correlation matrix (Costllo and Osbome [2005]).
[1],[2]
Spss.com.hk/corpinfo/history.tm
16
Based on the advantages of factor analysis in SPSS, the respective version 20 was applied
in this research to supply the evidences for research contributions. Their details will be
interpreted in the last sections of this chapter and Chapters 5 and 6 of the thesis.
Issue recommendations or
solutions
1. Contents
2. Methods
3. Skill and knowledge
4. Others
1. Fullness
2. Reality
3. Faithful Legal regulations
4. Timeliness
…
Size of business
Preparing CFSs
Structure of organize Characteristics of
the business entity Quality of CFSs
…
Industrial sector (1).Relevance;
(2).Reliability;
(3).Comparability;
1, Education levels; (4).Understanding
2, Specific knowledge; ability
3, working skill; Knowledge and skill
… of accounting staff
Educationlevelsof managers
Management policy
Specificknowledgeof managers
Source: Owned contribution
….
Figure 2.7: Analytical framework
18
Apparently in the business entity, the decision of preparing or not preparing the CFSs
depends mainly on legal framework; knowledge and skill of human resource; characteristic of
enterprise and internal controlling policy. Paradoxically, each element is also activated by the
separate variables. For example, the factor of legal regulations is compiled based on their
fullness, creditability, timeliness or reality; the knowledge or skill of staffs has been affected
directly by their education levels, working skill or specific knowledge. Using the mechanism
of factor analysis, the analysis framework of research is showed on Figure 2.7.
Data survey
Current speciality of
CFSs in Vietnam Sample:
- Economic groups (15): accountants;
Literature review direct managers; executive managers;
Positive Negative head of internal control, etc..
Relativearea Sources points points - Accounting professional sector (59) :
-VASforCFSs -Internetdatabank auditors; accounting consultants;
-Accountingpolicies -Academicinstitution researcher; lecturers, officers, etc…
Methods:
-previousresearches -Accountingprofessors - Questionnaire online and hard copy
inCFSs -etc… - Direct interview
-Relative Location:
acceptaccept - Hanoi, Hai Phong, Quy Nhon, Ho Chi
Minh city;… anywhere in Vietnam
H … H
- Emerging problems 1 unaccept 5
- Empirical research
Preliminary data
- Basic regulations: Hypothesis -Business size; etc…
Treatment Quantity
Direct -Presentation of CFSs:
Measurement Quality comparing
analysis
+ Goodwill
Principles analysis Current situation in accounting: + Non-controlling
Etc…
principles Purpose interests
Treatment Staff skill + Etc…
Comparison
Measurement Recognition Data evaluation: Chi-
method
Fullness , Timeliness, Apparent , Surface square Test; ANOVA;
Note: (1): H1…H5 =Hypothesis Source: Owned contribution
(2): : direct results; (3) : comparative relation; (4): direct relation
Figure 2.8: Methodological framework
19
A full description of the methodology is illustrated in Figure 2.8, wherein the document
analysis and sample survey are the core elements of data collection. The literature review or
document analysis stresses on the CFSs, as a result, significant factors have been found.
However, these could not tell the full story as their contexts and circumstances have been
available. It will be better exploration if they are compared with the situation in reality. For
this, from the interviewees’ perspectives, this study took place in real-world enterprise
situations without any attempt to manipulate the phenomenon of interest. The descriptive
statistics are applied to explore such factors, which will then be calculated and analysed. The
standard deviations are also used to indicate the extent of diversity among variables.
Academic tests and specific tests are conducted to get the expectation of quantity analysis
Furthermore, to facilitate the observed factors, this study assumed the hypothesis to test
the reliability of collective data, which serves as the background to propose the solutions and
attest the results of pervious researches in the same topic. Internet data bank to public, any
books or documents of university library and private archives and information were collated
as the key research references. During the entire research, the comparison method has been
used to make clear interpretation and SPSS version 20 is the main tool (or instrument) for the
data classification and exploration of relative factors in the purpose.
20
formulating accounting regulations in other countries are drawn to give research comments.
On the side of practitioners, the human ability (skill and knowledge of accounting staffs and
managers), business industries and internal management policies are main points for analysis.
For the professional agencies including the accounting association and institution, their
structure, power of control and capability of experts are considered to capture a full view of
the accounting work. Furthermore, the topics of international accounting harmonization or
convergence have been also of priority to provide the current perspective of accounting
development
Research worldwide
CFS
Accounting research Businesscombination
research research
Vietnamese
accounting
Structure
Accounting staff
Power of control
Internal governance
Specalizeability, …
Business industry,
Accounting law
Accounting standards
Accounting regulation
21
view of both inside and outside of the entity. Thus, the interviewees were identified in two
groups respectively: the first one, named “inside group”, includes accountants, financial
executive management, financial, managers who work at the economic groups; the second
one, called “outside group”, includes auditors, officers, investors, researchers, financial
consultants, or any accounting professors working outside economic groups.
By the way of “snowballing”, the sample was selected through the researcher’s own
network to lead to another network that received tremendous support of potential
interviewees. The total number of samples was 74 participants, including 15 from the inside
group and 59 from the outside group. Each group has separate questionnaires, and each type
of questionnaire has two respective elements: the first is called the main-question list and the
second one is sub-questions. The list of main questions was also divided into two separate
sections: one for the general information of interviewers or groups; another for collection of
its accounting majors (also covered the CFSs). The sub-questions list was only applied in the
case the information of main questions did not meet the expectation (e.g. the interviewee had
no answer; or the information that needs collecting goes beyond interviewees’ knowledge,
etc…).
For the first interviewing group (inside group), the main question list was designed over
150 criterions, set up in 28 questions including the general information of enterprises (for
example: the business model, enterprise size, business sector, etc.) and specific information
related to consolidated accounting (for instance: accounting method, accounting measurement,
or recognition of goodwill, etc.). For the second group of interviewees (outside group), the
main list of questions was formed with over 145 criterions put in 23 main questions which
one part focusing on the information of working experience, accounting basic knowledge,
working skills of interviewers and the other part concentrating on academic information
similar to the first list.
The time period was predefined to 2014-2015, especially in May, August and December
each year when the fiscal year in Vietnam always starts annually in 1st January and ending in
31st December. The pre-survey was conducted as an important step in August 2014 to
improve the quality of questionnaire’s temporary version. The great results of this grade
contributed to the changes in how to build a questionnaire from a specific approach (multi
levels of questions) to general approach (less specific levels). Furthermore, the interviewees
of the inside group who were defined for pre-survey moved from only the directors or the
chief accountant (as predefined) to any person with major in the CFSs. Additionally, the
approach of interview also changed from one by one to group of interviewees through the
annual CPA classes in 2015. Notably, there was no limitation to the location of each
interviewee/economic group, rather than in Vietnam. After pre-survey, the formal
questionnaires were improved for a continuous survey in December 2014. However, it was
untimely for such a survey because December is the last month of a fiscal year when most
groups and participants were busy with accumulation of accounting and preparation of
financial statements. This means that the pre-intendancy for survey paused, and the
achievement of collecting was not obtained because of little interviewee consensus in survey.
That is why, once again, the approach of survey changed from the hard-copy to online. It also
22
means that the online meetings have existed instead of face to face meeting in collective data
since then. Nevertheless, the face to face meetings continued to take place in May and August
2015 with the purpose of high quality information as well as being satisfied the expected
volume and quality of sample.
2.3.3.2. Interviews
Actually, the specific or academic information was determined following several steps. The
first step of study was based on the literature review to formulate the analytical framework and
primary key dimensions (in section 2.2.1). Then these dimensions were verified by pre-interview
through a “snowballing” sample of around 10 interviewees. Wherein the dimension of regulation
was divided into internal regulation and legal framework, human ability was separated between
accounting staffs’ skills and manager’s knowledge about the CFSs. Typically, the business
characteristics were investigated through the infrastructure or facility applied to carrying out
accounting operation in the entity. After success in forming the questionnaire, the formal
interviews were conducted.
Generally, before the interview, the researcher made contact by email or telephone to have
the appointment with interviewees. Under their acceptations, the time of discussion was planned
and follow-up seeking an interview. For each interview, it is important to create the positive
atmosphere before turning to the key questions for discussion and data collection. Thus, the
researcher used to begin with introduction of some information about the purpose of research and
negotiated the time of interview. Each interview lasted from 30 to 60 minutes based on the
questionnaire. The ethical considerations (such as the secretive information, advantage of
discussion, the length of time for interview, etc.) were presented to encourage the interviewees to
feel comfortable about talking openly. A set of open-ended descriptive questions were given prior
to the interview and follow-up the specific or academic questions were discussed.
During the interview, to ensure that the interviewee well understood each question, the
researcher gave the guideline or sub-questions or not sub-questions depending on their answers in
order to obtain the best outcome. In case the researcher was aware that the interviewee could
spend longer than expected (for example, the answers interested in the topic of discussion; or they
are ambitious by interviewing to get suggestions for their confusing in working, etc.), and then
the “warm-up” time would be keep to talk. On the other hand, the discussion only focused on the
key questions to get research objectives. Fortunately, the interviews were done longer than
expected in many cases. Moreover, the answerers felt ready to “speak out” what they knew and
want to receive the recommendation for their case in business. Therefore, the researcher was able
to seek collecting information in depth by the follow-up multi-choice questions.
To avoid losing information, when the discussion with the interviewee finished, after sending
the warm thanks to the answerer, the researcher read again carefully all answers and translated
them into English. Although most of the interviewees were quite keen on talking, some answers
lacked desired information. In these cases, firstly the researcher relied on her memory to write
down the notes as quickly as possible. Then depending on the cause of inappropriate answers, the
researcher found a proper solution. For instance, there were some typical occasions of the non-
answers (academic information) going beyond or due to limited knowledge of the interviewees.
23
The solution was the researcher contacted the interviewee again (if possible and by email) to
recommend another better answer (normal in the same organization with the prior interviewee) to
collect more information or data, or directly connected to directors of subsidiary or holding
company to get their help. The work of collecting data finished if most of key questions got the
respective answers.
2.3.3.3Data evaluation
After collecting data, the processing and classifying data were conducted immediately to
supply the information for analysis as the next step of study. The primary data was
aggregated in the groups of objective criterion directly following the research objectives. The
descriptive statistics and the mean tests in SPSS version 20 were used as the main source for
data cataloguing. Following this, most of raw data was reported by means of description,
while the academic or detailed information came via using the tests of statistics functions.
Basically, the structure equitation model approach was selected to test the research
hypothesis or assumptions. A technique of collection in statistics allows a set of relationships
between the independent or dependent variables, either continuation or discontinuation to be
examined (Doan [2012], p.89; Tabachnick and Fidell [2007], p.676). In this line, the factors
or talent variables are measured indirectly by consistent investigation between the observed
variables.
It was noted that before the structure equation model was constructed, all the assumptions
of model were satisfied by the number of tests including the normality; reliability and validity
of data. The normality test has the purpose of examination of the distributed shape of data
corresponding to normal distribution. The reliability is conducted to ensure that the variable
is not too varied difference in time period and situation, and it is also to investigate the
consistence and correlation between the variables. Unfortunately, the validity test is used in
order to evaluate the magnitude of structural relationship between the observed variable and
talent variable and identify whether a variable of study differs from another one.
Under the statistical process of SPSS, this study used mainly the tests of Kolmogorov-
Smirnov, Bartlett for checking the normality of data, while the tests of tau-b of Kendall, d of
Somer, Gamma of Goodman and Kruskal, Cronbach alpha, Kaiser-Maer-Olkin (KMO), or
Chi-square tests were applied for reliability and validity tests as dominant ones for quality
data in this study. Normally, Chi-square was used to convince the relationship between two
factors of sample based on the test Null Hypothesis (Ho) that the assumption is not related to
variables of factors. Through the p-value and the mean α –the reliability (normally 90%) of
test, the acceptation or denial of Ho was attested as the proof of the research conclusion. In
case the result of Chi-square cannot provide reliable information or no meaning for statistics,
the study designed the extra tests such as Kendall’s tau-b, Fisher’s Exact test and ANOVA
like the strong tests of SPSS in purpose of validity test. Through the flexible tests, the study
verified the reliability of all tests to give the final results in the case of highest prudent of
expected conclusion.
24
Furthermore, a function of relationship between the factors is satisfied by specific tests in
reliability and validity has been formed to clarify the expected research output. It is modified
as a multi-variable function- F (X):
F(X) = a. A + b. B + c. C+ d. D
Wherein:
F(X): Objective function-the relationship among factors influence on CFSs preparation
X: representing factor/variable that is A or B or C or D.
a, b, c, d: weight of variable A, B, C, D respectively
A, B, C, D: variable or factor
A: Legal framework
B: Economic group’s chracteristics
C: Accounting staff’s skill and knowledge
D: Management policy
25
Chapter 3: HISTORICAL DEVELOPMENT AND BACKGROUND OF
CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
3.1. ACCOUNTING SYSTEM IN VIETNAM
It is important to learn about the background of development. It seems to be true that the
history could never be ignored (Kanamori [2005], p 244). In other words, the history of a
country has made important contributions to the development of its accounting sector (Nobes
and Parker [2000], p.4). The extant accounting literature showed that accounting has been
affected by its environment, including the culture (ibid, p.16) and legal system of the country
(Zimmermann and Werner [2013], p.9). The tendency of changes in the environment leads to
changes in the accounting system (Micheline and Nguyen [2007]). Therefore, before
presenting a quick tour on the development of accounting system, a short history of Vietnam
is necessary to be reviewed.
[3]
Website:asia.isp.msu.edu/wbwoa/southeast_asia/Vietnam/history.htm
26
Chinese colonists exerted to set all aspects of society including the language, education,
literature and culture following Chinese line (Odell and Castillo [2008], p.82). Moreover,
they had to face a lot conflicts with the native people. The significant number of revolts
against Chinese rule was conducted by Vietnamese people, such as the movements of “Trung
sisters”, “Trieu Quang Phuc”, “Mai Hac De”, and so on. With the dynasty’s controlling, as
prominent approach, a lot of similar campaigns occured against Chinese invaders. After A.D.
939 as Ngo Quyen successfully drove out the Chinese rulers, Vietnam had to face the
suppressions by feudal lords (from 10th to 19th centuries) and the attack of the larger Mongol
army (around 1257-1284). Notably, under Vietnamese dynasties (such as the emperor of Tran,
early Le, Ly, etc.), the system of taxation and penalty were promulgated. The Nguyen Lords
(in the south) and Trinh Lords (in the north) were two powerful dynasties during 1627-1775
in Vietnam (ibid, p. 82). After many years of civil war between Trinh and Nguyen Lords, the
power controlling of whole country belonged to the monopoly of Nguyen dynasty in 1786
(Lambert [undated]). Under the Nguyen kings, the taxation and penal systems remained. In
the late 18th century when the Nguyen dynasty radiated the weaken control, Nguyen Anh
(Prince of Nguyen tribe) asked for the supports from the French. From 1802-1820, Nguyen
dynasty under emperor Gia Long was located in the middle of Vietnam (Hue province). With
the great French’s assistance, the emperor tried to extend their power to rule his own people.
In 1858, under the rule of Napoleon III from France, French phalanx invaded Vietnam
easily even though their colonization officially started in 1874[4]. Meanwhile, Catholicism
was tolerated and the infrastructure (road, rail way, bridge system) was built. The French
language, culture and literature were introduced in the local regions, thus the society was
intertwined both regional and French dominant. Consequently, the native people were
suppressed by the policies of heavy tax and a centralized government which was enforced to
maximize the colony’s profit (Chu [2004], Nguyen [2013]). At times, during colonization, the
tight security that ignored some freedom of pressand personality was imposed on all the
Vietnamese. It led to the tendency of the uprising movement by regional communities.
In early 20th century, the modernization movements occurred quite strongly in Vietnam
such as: Dong Du (Go East) movement sending the Vietnamese students to Japan to learn
modern skills; and Duy Tan (Modernization) movement promoting the education to enlighten
and modernize the mass in purpose of getting achievement of peaceful transition (Odell and
Castillo [2008], p.82). Typically, the young Vietnamese intellectuals found the theory of
Marxism-Leninism which attracted many colonized people over the world. The most famous
of Vietnamese intellectuals was Ho Chi Minh, who traveled a lot in foreign countries (China,
Russia, France, England, etc…) to seek a way of struggling for the Vietnamese’s
independence. In 1925, he founded the Revolutionary Youth League as the radical
organization of Vietnamese Communists Party (VCP) formed later in 1930 (Chu, [2004]).
During World War II, when French colonist rule became weaker, Japan invaded
Indochina and quickly replaced the position of the French in Vietnam until March 1945. In
1941, the group named “Viet Minh” was established in North Vietnam under the leadership
[4]
Website:Website:asia.isp.msu.edu/wbwoa/southeast_asia/Vietnam/history.htm
27
of VCP. Immediately, after the surrender of the colonists (August Revolution event), on 2nd
September 1945, Ho Chi Minh declared the independence of Vietnam and established
Vietnam Democracy Republic. Unfortunately, the French soon returned to invade Vietnam
and began fighting in the South. In September 1946, Ho Chi Minh as the first president of
Vietnam was forced to accept the control of Cochin China back to the French. Notably, later
that year, the French once again escalated to some provinces in the North of Vietnam. The
war between French and Vietnamese troops reoccurred in December 1946. It lasted until
1954 after the battle of Dien Bien Phu (led by General Vo Nguyen Giap) and the Geneva
Agreement (signed in Paris), the French’s colonial presence in Vietnam went to the end. The
whole country temporarily was separated into two States at the 17th parallel: the communist
North led by Ho Chi Minh; and non-communist South led by Ngo Dinh Diem, who received
the supports from the US (Lambert [undated]).
In the 1960s, South Vietnam was forced in the extremely unstable situation (Odell and
Castillo [2008], p. 83) when the demonstrations occurred everywhere. In 1963, Ngo Dinh
Diem was ousted in a coup d’etat. Gradually, the US started as the military advisers of Ngo
Dinh Diem in South Vietnam then became to invade through the unprovoked attack in North
Vietnam in 1964 (Lambert [undated]). However, they were not successful even using the
superior firepower and modern technology. In fact, by the guerrilla approach, Vietnamese
army defeated American troops and reclaimed the whole territories on 30th April 1975.
Vietnam was officially re-unified and renamed the Socialist Republic of Vietnam. Currently,
after many years of reformation in economy and re-structure of internal regional areas,
Vietnam has over 50 ethnic groups residing in 64 provinces (GSO [2014]). The summary of
Vietnam history is described in Figure 3.1 bellow. *North: VCP
*South: Ngo
Chinese Dinh Diem&
Domination French America colony
colonzation
III BC 1858 1945 1975 Present
29
France (1945-1954). French troops were not defeated by Vietnamese army until 1954. In the
north, Vietnam adopted Soviet-style legal system with the support of Soviet, while French legal
system still was supplemented in the middle under the control of Ngo Dinh Diem and the legal
advisors from the USA (existing of a presidential system and separation of powers between
judicial, executive and legislative elements) in the south (Odell et al. [2008]). According to Bui
[2011], Nguyen and Richard [2011] and Nguyen [2013], the socioeconomic model in Vietnam
was controlled under the capital path (capitalist economy) in the south while the socialist path
(centrally planned economy) existed in the north during the period 1955 to 1975.
b. Vietnam in recent time
After 1975, the US neo-colonists withdrew from Vietnam, the country was reunified
under the leadership of VCP. The national legal system was improved as an early step in the
nation by resetting the respective regulations in the provincial areas (in late 1975), in trading,
agricultural production, training and education (in 1976) and other fields. The legality was
proclaimed as the best in formal system with continuously important role of the State sector.
The agriculture still remained as the leading field of the economy, while the private sector
was not encouraged or even made unlawful. Under the blocked market, there was neither
foreign investment nor heavy industries, and the bureaucracy restricted the market force
(Odell and Castillo [2008]). Especially, at the time when the Soviet Union collapsed around
the 1980s, and their economic assistance for Vietnam was reduced, as a result, the country
fell into the status of insufficient domestic financial resources and exceeding inflation rate
(Le [2015]). In order to survive, in 1986, at the Sixth Communist Party Congress, the
economic renovation policy - “Doi moi” was announced in Vietnam.
Starting in 1986, the economic liberalisation was encouraged. The economy shifted from
a centrally planned one to an open market economy. The State sector was defined as the
leading role of development and a fundamental feature of the socialism oriented to market
economy (Pham et al. [2007], p.11,12). First of all is agriculture, then industries and service
were priority sectors for improvement in an effort of controlling the hyperinflation in late
1980s (Tran [2003]).
Thanks to the introduction of Doi moi (renovation), most sectors of the economy were
improved significantly. This contributed to reducing the poverty level and stimulating the
foreign investment as well as controlling the import-export balance, and the formal accept of
private sector. Moreover, the legal system was dramatically approved or renewed following
the promotion of all sectors in the open-market economy. The renovation of the Constitutions
in 1992 contributed to replacing the main political bodies and restructuring of the government
(Odell Odell and Castillo [2008]. The form of State owned enterprises (SOEs) moved closely
to mergers and consolidated structure of modernising economy (Le [2015]). The economy
embraced positive changes and followed the trend of transformation from an agriculture-
based economy towards an industry and service based one (Pham et al. [2007], p.26). The
average per capital GDP increased from less than 2% in 1976-1990 to 6.6% in 1991-1995
(Tran [2003], p. 5).
30
By continuously developing the economy in the path of market orientation, apart from the
vigorous reformation of the legal system in the 1990s (shown in Table 3.1), Vietnam has
maintained a policy of encouraging foreign investment and enhancing its status by taking part
in such international organizations as ASEAN (Association of South-East Asian Nations) in
1995; APEC (Asia Pacific Economic Cooperation) in 1998; Bilateral Trade Agreement with
the US in 2001. Recently, Vietnam has been a formal participant of WTO (World Trade
Organization) in 2007 and TPPs (Trans-Pacific Partnership) in 2015.
Table 3.1: Key points of legal reformation and international integration
2006-2010 * Law on Real Estate Business (2006) WTO membership (2007); AFTA- Korean
*Ordinance on Exchange Law (effective2006) (2007); AFTA-Vietnam-Japan(2008); AFTA
* Security Law (2006) -Australia-New Zealand; AFT A India
*Law on management of Taxation (2009); Vietnam –EU; Vietnam-Chile FTAs
(2006 revised 2012) (2010); TPP negotiation (began2010)
*Enterprise Law (2005, revised 2013)
[c]
*Free Trade Agreement China-ASEAN
2001-2005 *Competitive Law (2005);* Electricity Law (2005) (2005)
* Investment Law (2005)[a] * Agreement von Marketing Opening
* Intellectual Property Law (2005) with EU (2004)
* Law on Bankruptcy (2004); Land Law (2003)[d] *Bilateral Trade Agreement with US
* Accounting Law (2003);CommercialLaw(2005) (2001)
[g]
1996-2000 *Land law (1998, replaced 1993) Found ASEM (1996)
*Enterprise Law (1998)[b] APEC membership (1998)
*Law on Foreign Investment (1996
revised 2000, replaced 1987)
1987-1989 Land Law (1987); Law on Foreign Investment (1987, revised 1990, 1992)
With regards to the legal system, at national level, the National Assembly has been the
highest political body operating in both executive and judicial systems. Through the National
Assembly, the positions of heads of the State and the Government have been elected. The
President has the authority to promulgate legislation (including Constitutions and Laws)
passed by the National Assembly, while the Government (headed by the Prime Minister)
promulgates decrees and clarifies laws and regulations as the second level of the national
system (detailed in Table 3.2). The judicial system has various courts, tribunals and Supreme
People’s Procuracy at the district, provincial and governmental levels.
31
Along with the legal reforms, the economic growth reached the significant achievements.
For instance, the average GDP per year of 7% in the period 1996-2000 increased to 7,5% in
2001-2005 and gained stability in 2006-2010 (Mai et al. [2013], Le [2015]); the Foreign
Direct Investment (FDI) of 20.67 billion US dollars (approximately 24,32% of total social
investment capital) in 1990-2000 increased to 69.47 billion US dollars (approx. 22.75% of
total social investment capital) in 2000-2011 (Mai et. al. [2013], p.377). In recent years, the
inceasant efforts of the government in abolishing subsidies in State enterprises, innovating
Administration Reforms and emendating legal framework have helped create a favourable
environment for business operation (Le [2015], Mai et al. [2013], Thorburn [2009], Tran et al.
[2008]). However, Vietnam has still been a “middle –income country” (Truong [2013],
Donor Report to the Vietnam Consultative Group [2012]). Moreover, the challenges from the
group’s benefits, the partial area of economic transition (Mai et. al. [2013]) and the lack of
fundamental conditions of international integration (MOF [2013a, 2013b]) have worsened the
instability of economic development. The reputation of economic development has been very
poor in the international market. Vietnam’s position in Ease of Doing Business was ranked
78 out of 189 countries, while Global Competitiveness Index for 2014-2015 (on the World
Economic Forum) was 68 out of 144 economies. It seems the economic growth is stagnating
and the national growth has been below its potential (Le [2015], p.33). Hence, in order to get
the higher expectations of an open market economy, Vietnam continues to live up to reform
the economy.
Table 3.2: National hierarchy of legal proclamation in Vietnam
Declarers Type of regulation Level
National Assembly - Constitution (Hiến Pháp)
(Quốc hội) - Law (Luật)
-Resolutions (Nghị Quyết) Law/ regulations
Ministry
*Prime Ministry - Decree (Nghị Định) Secondary
*Head of Respective - Decision (Quyết định) regulation
Ministries or equivalent - Circular (Thông Tư)
Agencies National level
Source: Vietnamese Constitution 2013
3.1.2. Development of accounting system
The study of accounting history is to review the evolution of accounting through practice
and institution in response to changes in the environment and societal needs. It helps us to
know our past and gives us the guidance to how our current practices and problems came into
being (Oseni et al. [2011] p.2). Being influenced by the colonial war for a long time,
Vietnamese accounting development also has transited through a number of different periods.
Depending on the research manner’s objectives, the stages of its accounting history are
separated into specific different criteria. Chu [2004] writes in his dissertation that the history
32
of Vietnamese accounting system spans over two main periods: socialism and economic
transition. He classified historical period of Socialism into three specific phases: the initiation,
setting foundation, improvement and unification, while the another main period in the
initiatory, radical and standardization phase. Nguyen et al.[2012], their article presented the
reformation period of Vietnamese accounting system in three stages: the first was from 1981
to 1990 when the main reformation was related to the private sector and served the planning
economy; the second was from 1991 to 1995 with the strong restructuring of State-owned
enterprises; the last was since 1996 until now when he stressed that Vietnam had executed
many activities to integrate into the international regulations not only in the accounting sector
but also in other aspects of Vietnamese economy, especially these changes contributed
significantly to making the legal accounting framework in the country better.
According to the view of accounting experts as showed in their project No. 2000-98-027
under supervision of Vietnamese Ministry of Finance in 2001, the history of Vietnamese
accounting system lasts also in three periods. They are 1945-1988, 1989-1995, and since
1996 up to now. In these experts’ opinions, during 1945-1988 the accounting system was
established as the initiatory stage, while the whole country focused on stability of politics and
structure of the government. In the second period, they commented that the accounting
regulation system was more uniform, and consistent than the previous time. Nevertheless, not
only accounting but also financial regulations were launched on the government’s purpose of
State financial management. In their last period, the economic liberalization affected
significantly the regulations of the accounting sector in Vietnam. The accounting system was
improved to meet enterprises’ demand for financial management, but it still existed the
inappropriate point out of many requirements of businesses or investors in accounting market.
33
accounting development. Unlike other researchers, Nguyen [2013] provided the accounting
development in four stages by connecting the movements against colonists to economic
renovation in Vietnam. They were the periods of 1864-1945; 1945-1975; 1975-1986 and
1986-onwards.
Particularly, most researchers also agreed that the accounting system in Vietnam had
really started before 1945 when the Vietnam was occupied by foreign aggressors, and they
made explicitly all detailed information since 1945 (declared as an independent nation) to
present as the valuable documents for any researchers afterwards. According to Narayan and
Godden [2000], the historical development of Vietnamese accounting was engaged in its
accounting practice, which has formed strong military, social or commercial links. (Figure
3.2)
Combining the utility of previous researches in this study, the development process of
accounting system in Vietnamese setting is emphasized more by others (including the
invaders). Furthermore, through the top-to-bottom approach, the study is based on the
hierarchy structure of a national legislation system to present the accounting system.
Therefore, the Vietnamese accounting history depicted in this research follows two main
periods: the before; and the after of the first Law on Accounting (2003).
3.1.2.1. Vietnamese accounting system before 2003
It was a typical situation when Vietnamese accounting practitioners did their jobs for a
long time without the accounting law from 1945 to 2002 (57 years). An explanation for this is
Vietnam’s historical context. According to the research by Ngo and Pham [2013],
Vietnamese accounting was formed along with the nation’s historical development. It first
appeared a thousand years ago and was recorded quite apparently at the time of Chinese
domination (III BC) and Vietnamese Dynasties (10th century) to control the emperors’
budgets. The accounting system, however, was very simple unlike the formal system. The
accounting elements were developed incoherently and engaged with a piece or part of King’s
budget management, such as the budget note, receipt paper or calculated sheets for evidence
of expenditure rather than accounting purpose (Ngo and Pham [2013]). After the mid-19th
century, the contemporary accounting history in Vietnam started with the French invaders
(Micheline and Nguyen [2007], p.7; Bui [2011])
a. French colonial rule period (1858-1945)
During the time of French colonists, French legal ideology was imposed on all regions in
Vietnam (Bui [2007], p. 24). Obviously, the French accounting system, as a result of their
colonial exploiting policy and primarily support colonial administrative, was also set up (ibid,
p.91). The preparation of accounting records as the budgets report were required to control
the revenues and expenditures of the colony. The accounting work was managed by the
French directly while the local Vietnamese were hired as the detail bookkeepers (Nguyen
[2013], Bui [2011]). The taxation was an important content of the colonial rule that played a
key role in budget generation and administration under French colonial control in Vietnam.
34
In order to exploit the resources in Vietnam, nevertheless, French invaders used their
accounting system to centrally control the colony’s operation rather than transited to the local
regions. According to Nguyen [2013], there was narrowly based point of the French
accounting which becomes the standard model in Vietnam during French domination. As Bui
[2011] summarized:
During 1858 – 1945, the French ruled the country, using its manpower to exploit resources
in Vietnam. They made little effort to train the Vietnamese in accounting. There have been
no records to indicate any positive impact by the colonial heritage on indigenous
accounting by the French during their domination in Vietnam (p. 98).
In fact, the market and community for accounting were absent. French accountants
undertook most accounting work, while Vietnamese people were confined to the role of
bookkeepers under French supervision. It was little action in setting up and improving the
indigenous accounting in Vietnam by the French at the time of their colonialism (Bui [2011],
p. 96-97). Consequently, the impacts of French accounting system on Vietnamese accounting
practice were not enough for the latter to develop (Nguyen [2013], p.15)
b. Period of the North separates from the South (1945-1975)
As mentioned in Section 3.1.1, after Vietnam declared as an independent nation, the French
came back to invade the South. The nation was temporarily separated into Northern and
Southern halves. Accordingly, there were differences in accounting practice in the two regions.
In the South, under the rule of French colonists, the budget accounting was still used by
the French, and so the local Vietnamese continued to be used as assistants of French
accountants in colonial operations. The first accounting plan in France (known as the Plan
Comptable Général) found in 1947 was practiced in South Vietnam (Bui [2011], p. 128). It
has been the main feature of the cash base, whereas the same characteristics of accounting
system to centrally control the colony operations before 1945 remained and the influence of
French accounting ideology in Vietnam was not lessened, as noted:
The French national accounting plan did not have an impact on the existing accounting
practice in the Republic of Vietnam during this time. Moreover, training Republic of
Vietnam personnel in accounting was not the US’s priorities, as their main interests were
political influence through military support (Bui [2011], p. 128).
After 1954, when the Geneva Agreement was signed and the French lost their war in
Vietnam, French occupation was replaced by Americans. Even though American accounting
experts tried to introduce their accounting system during their colonial time (Chu [2004]; Vu
[2012], p.31), they did not train the Vietnamese in accounting (Bui [2011], p.130). Therefore,
French accounting system remained the key role (until 1972) (Chu [2004]; Vu [2012]).
According to Nguyen [2013], flexible situations occurred in the accounting practice, such as:
It was observed that America-companies in Vietnam used America accounting system
because they had to report to their headquarters in the US. With regards to the matters of
taxes, companies which were operating in the South Vietnam had to report to the local
government using French accounting system (p. 17).
35
Some years later, American troops were knocked out in 1975 by Vietnamese army. This
means the practice of American accounting system in Vietnam did not last long enough to be
set up as a formal accounting system in Vietnam.
In contrast, in the North, at the early years of the independent declaration, in 1946, the
Ministry of Finance was established, as the highest organization of the government in charge of
setting accounting regulations in Vietnam (until now). The first accounting regulation related to
regulation on General Accounting framework and Revenue and Expenditure of the State budget
was issued on 25 September 1948. The characteristics of accounting at that time were simple
with the main purpose of recording the nation’s revenue and expenditure (Nguyen [2013]; Chu
[2004]). Notably, the direct and indirect assistance from China supported the major source of
military and economy, and the assistance of Soviet Union for Vietnam in its war against
colonies in the 1950s – 1960s, through education, training and support material in accounting
sector (DAP, 2001). The primary accounting regulations were issued, some of which served as
the original documents to promote the following accounting regulations in practice until now in
Vietnam. This system became strong when Department of Accounting Policy (DAP) in MOF,
for not only setting and issuing uniform of the accounting regulations but also controlling the
implementation by the enterprises, was formed in 1956. The DAP distributed significantly to
create the pre-framework of accounting and Vietnamese accounting system nowadays.
At first, in the 1960-1969, with the limited knowledge and experience, Vietnam received
the provision of extensive materials and human training assistance from Chinese experts to
set its accounting system following the Chinese model (Narayan and Godden [2000]). The
early decree on the Charter for Organization of State Accounting was proclaimed in 1961 and
the provisional Policy for Accounting control by Decision in 1962. However, due to political
conflicts with China in its US relationship in the late 1970s, Vietnam then followed the
Soviet Union accounting model until the 1980s (Bui [2011], p. 114, 125; Nguyen [2013]).
Consequently, Vietnamese accounting system was influenced by both Chinese and Soviet
models (Vu [2012]).
In Soviet Union model of a centrally-managed economy, accounting and statistical record
keeping were the basis, as controlling tools, in endeavor to manage a planned economy (Sarikas
et. al.[2009], p.186). Vietnamese accounting operation at that time, adopting Soviet accounting
model, focused on supplying the information for preparation of the State’s fiscal budget (Bui
[2011]) and functioned as a tool or State financial management (Chu [2004]). At the central
level, the State bodies including ministries and equivalent agencies played the monopoly role in
setting up their industry-based accounting regulations and the prescribed template of
accounting books and vouchers (Bui [2011]), which must be complied by enterprises as
compulsory rather than encouraging. The Decree was issued as the first high-level of
accounting rule (Chu [2004], p. 141, Odell and Castillo [2008], p.83). The SOEs were defined
as the dominant role of economic development (Pham et al. [2007]; Truong [2013]). Therefore,
the accounting regulations were issued for this purpose with significance. Moreover, the role
of Chief Accountant in SOEs was extended by the New Regulations on Chief Accountant in a
Decree in 1970 and the bookkeeping was stressed on accounting practice by Decision on the
Vouchers-Journal accounting system issued in the same year.
36
Thanks to Soviet Union, the human resource for accounting in Vietnam was improved
significantly through the young officials who were trained inland or overseas with the
assistance from Soviet experts during the 1960s-1970s (DAP, 2001). These officials
contributed strongly to forming the characteristics of accounting system at that time. Under
the socialist accounting, Vietnam applied only the model of Soviet, the most powerful
amongst socialist countries bloc. Vietnam also tried to use flexible approaches for the most
effectiveness, instead of initiating the original model (Bui [2011], p.116). By this approach,
Vietnam could create forms of accounting, accounting voucher system and reconciliation of
economic information (DAP, 2001). This means the fundamental accounting system of
Vietnam was found, at least in the North as noted by Chu [2004]:
[During 1961-1970] saw the laying of the foundation of the Vietnamese accounting
system. Accounting systems were set up in all types of entities including government
organizations, state enterprises and collective farms to create a complex accounting
apparatus used as a tool in administering economy (p. 142).
c. Period of reunification and prior to economic renovation (1975-1985)
It is difficult for Vietnam to move to a peaceful development stage right after the
reunification (Tran [2003]) because in the South the capitalist economy driven by market
forces remained and in the North the economy of socialist centrally-planned was applied (Le
[2015]). Therefore, one of the first steps taken by Vietnam was focusing on recovery and
rebuilding the national economy all over the country (Chu [2004]) to create a stable
environment. Under this impact, in the accounting sector, it was not easy to establish a
uniform accounting system across two regions immediately, while the distance of accounting
systems in the market economy (in the South) and the centrally planned economy (in the
North) was remarkable (Vu [2012]). It is difficult to control this system of the whole country
when the style of French and American accounting was applied to most enterprises in the
South, while all enterprises in the North were oriented to the Soviet style.
To build the socialist economy, a system of socialist accounting with a uniform chart of
accounts was defined to be applied to the whole nation (DAP [2001]; Chu [2004]; Micheline
and Nguyen [2007]; Bui [2011]). The accounting experts in the North were sent to transform
the capitalist accounting style in the South via the training courses. Generally, the feature of
the accounting system at this period was similar to the preceding system applied in the North.
Accounting information mainly served the purpose of facilitating the centralization of
economic planning. The cost accounting[5] system remained (Vu [2012], p. 31) and became
more sophisticated in supplying information for cost control (Chu [2004]). Regarding many
specific requirements from enterprises, there was an extremely strict system of accounting
regulations in Vietnam (Sarikas et al. [2009]). Accounting reports were prepared accurately,
yet the firms were not required to submit accounting information to the public (Vu [2012]).
As for the accounting regulations in Vietnam in this period, Bui [2011] commented:
[5] Cost accounting is commonly known as ‘internal auditing’ in the Western economies with its main focus on fraud, theft or inappropriate
use of resources rather than the accuracy of methods or formats of transactions (Vu [2012], p. 35)
37
[During 1975 – 1985] Accounting regulations were changed periodically, corresponding
with changes in the government’s political and economic policies… As such, there was no
market for accounting services. Accounting activities were mainly focused on recording
and reporting information for statistical and tax collection purposes. An indigenous
Vietnamese accounting profession, as in Western countries, did not exist in Vietnam
before 1986. The state continued its dominance, being both the market and community for
accounting (p. 151).
The fact was that the accounting document was enriched by a great number of Decrees
and Decisions on particular industries in this period, such as commerce, transportation or
agriculture, etc., but still in lack of consistent and coherent accounting theories for the
resolution of practical issues (Bui [2011], p.144). Most of the accounting regulations were put
under strict control by the government (Nguyen et al. [2012]). The accounting information
supplied by SOEs focused on safeguarding the assets and providing the information directly
to the higher authorities rather than meeting the managers’ demand on making business
decisions (Chu [2004]). This was also an underpinning reason why Vietnamese accounting
system seems to follow a “centralized” or “rule-based” concept rather than a “principle-
based”[6] approach (Nguyen et al. [2012]; Phan et al.[2013]).
d. Period between economic renovation and issuance of the first accounting law (1986- 2003)
In 1986 the economic liberalization began in Vietnam, the private enterprises were
acknowledged as a sector of the economy and the accounting system was reformed with
significant changes. The starting point of this change was the government issued Ordinance
on Accounting and Statistics in 1988, and started the substantial renovation in specific
industries, expressed in such forms as the regulation on chief accountants; the penalty for
violation as well as the reformation to unify the accounting reports. Particularly, Vietnamese
accounting regulation system was renewed at that time to adopt the non-State businesses (in
1990) which had ever been considered as the constraint organization in the first stage of
Vietnamese young government.
Moreover, the establishment of Vietnamese Association of Accountants (VAA) in 1994
brought many perspectives for development of Vietnamese accounting system (DAP, 2001). The
significant contributions by this association were the integration into International Federation
Accounting Committee (IFAC) and Accounting Federation of Asian (AFA) in 1998. Moreover,
the reformations of accounting policies, for not only State organizations but also non-State
enterprises, were applied the first time since the unification of the whole nation in around 1995. It
included three separate respective policies: one for SOEs; one for small and medium enterprises
(SMEs); and another for other kinds of State organizations (such as hospital, education sector). In
fact, this period (from 1991 to 1995), Vietnamese accounting was regarded as a tool for
management (Nguyen and Guangming [2012]) and radical reformation (Chu [2004])
There have been no documents of primary source (or I have at least not found any) to
show that the renovation of accounting regulations has led to increasing foreign investment in
[6] Principle-based system requires companies to report and auditors to audit the substance or business purpose of transaction; not
merely whether they can qualify as acceptable under incredibly detailed or overly technical rule …while a rule-based system allows
managers to ignore the substance and, instead ask “where is the rules does it say I can’t do this?” (Nisbett and Sheikh [2007],p .10):
38
Vietnam. But a considerable number of researchers claim that the accounting system of a
country certainly reflects its socio-economic and political characteristics (Nguyen [2013], p.
8). In fact, Vietnamese accounting system has had valuable benefits from major foreign
owned auditing firms (Deloitte & Touche, Ernst & Young (E&Y), KPMG and
PricewaterhouseCoopers (PwC) during this time. According to Chu [2004], these companies
contributed mainly to importing directly knowledge of accounting market into Vietnam. A
remarkable point is the launch of the first four VASs by the MOF in 2001 and the next six
VASs in 2002. Notably, the contents of the VASs were set up to align with international
economic integration. It is difficult for Vietnamese accounting practitioners to apply VAS,
nevertheless, in condition of insufficient uniform accounting regulations applied to the
domestic market. The MOF recommended application of VAS to SOEs or SMEs (small and
medium enterprises) while many of them were still not improved to change to an appropriate
structure or business size. In order to sort this out and also meet the requirement of economic
integration, the re-structure of SOEs and encouragement of developmental SMEs and the
promotion of FDI companies were conducted in early 2000s. However, these were not
properly adapted while most of the accounting practitioners are not professionally qualified
(Nguyen et al. [2012]) and the highest power of regulation, Law of Accounting was not
issued until 2003.
3.1.2.2. Vietnamese accounting system after 2003
The first law of accounting in Vietnam was promulgated on 17th June 2003 and complied
on 1st January 2004. Then the next three series of the VASs were also issued by the end of
2003 and 2005. Under the law and standards, the MOF enacted a significant number of
accounting policies and guidance for implementation. For example, in 2006 reformation of
the accounting regulation for enterprises (applied to all), State organizations (applied to
public organizations, such as hospitals, municipal organizations, etc.), and SOEs; in 2007
promulgation of the accounting policy for Social Insurance Organization, Funds of Public
Telecommunications services, and so on. Up to now, the accounting system includes one law
(2003, revised 2015), 26 Vietnamese accounting standards (issued by the fifth time from
2001-2005), and a great number of guide documents (as shown in Figure 3.3).
[7]
Article 28, Law on Accounting 2015
40
In fact, the revision of accounting regulations in recent years has contributed to
significant improvement in accounting development. It has shifted from the low integration to
high integration with international standards, and from no informal acceptation of fair value
to gradual application of fair value to assets accounting. However, it seems insufficient for
the transition to the expected case as Vu [2012] also commented:
[…] despite a concentrate effort to improve information transparency through issuance
of mandatory requirements, accounting reporting compliance in Vietnam was not very
well monitored and disciplined (p.58).
In order to review this current situation, the next section presents the characteristics of the
accounting system in Vietnam and a full picture of historical development of Vietnamese
accounting as illustrated in Annex 1 to demonstrate the government’s efforts in accounting reforms.
41
directly or indirectly many conferences and workshops. The purpose of these conferences is
to collect the guides, experiences or advices from the accounting market. They are views of
accounting experts, auditing professors, business managers, who come from not only
government offices or universities or academic institutions, but also the public accounting
firms or private companies, including both foreign and Vietnamese members (DAP [2001]).
Compared with the system of accounting regulation before “Doi moi”, the current accounting
system in Vietnam has covered all basic concepts which appeared on Nobes’ model [2000].
The drawbacks of enforcements, nevertheless, have been still seen in the government,
accounting practitioners and community, especially the role of setting regulations has been
still centralized mainly by the government.
Government body Accounting practitioners
National Ministry of Finance (MOF) Enterprises: SOEs, SMEs
Assembly (private, foreign, audit firms, etc)
Local government,
provincial, city level
DAP Tax
Office
Financial
Accounting Accounting Accounting regulation Accounting disciplines: Statements:
law standards under standards Tax regulation… disclosures,
preparing,..
Accounting regulation system
Source: Owned contribution
Note:
Directly issue; collected information; directly apply; directly submit
Figure 3.4: Relationship among actors in accounting system
Accounting
Accounting
Accounting law
law
law Big Co, FIEs. LOI (2014)
SOEs
Accounting SMEs(*) ≈54% total [**] Enterprises
standards big Co law.
1. Medium Co. No
Enterprises
enterpri ses non-SOEs 68/2014/Q13
Accounting
Accounting 2. Small Co. ≈ 18%total[**]
policy
policies SMEs
SMEs big Co
≈ 97% total [**]
3. Very small Co enterprises
Regulation
Accounting
Accounting
under law
circulars
standards
State/ government body;
Accounting regulation Accounting practitioners Business regulations
Source: Owned contribution
Note: 1. FIEs= Foreign investment enterprises; SOEs= State owned enterprises; non-SOEs = Non-stated enterprises
2. direct apply; 3. LOI= Law on Investment; 4. SMEs: Small and Medium enterprises
5,(*) entity has got under that 300 labors and 100 billion VND in owner capital/equity ( DecreeNo56/2009/ND-CPdated30/6/2009)
6.[**] Calculated base on the data of Vietnamreport, 2013: http://www.v1000.vn
Figure 3.5: Vietnam accounting regulation system following enterprise types
43
divided into the two separate systems: the first for SOEs or major companies and the second
for SMEs. The differences between the two systems are the volume of accounts and forms of
bookkeeping, format of financial reports and the number of VASs applied. The main
tendency is a smaller number of requirements for SMEs than big companies. Arguably, this
point is considered as an advantage for the increasing number of SMEs in recent years by
some researchers (Hansen et al. [undated]), in which the micro-small size is still prevailing
with over 50% of the total number of SMEs (Tran et al. [2008]).
Creditors / Bank
Investors/shareholders
Enterprises ≈ 1% total
enterprises(*)
(SOEs, FIEs, NonSOEs) Publish
…
Auditing
firms
Financial reports Tax office
Note:
BalanceIncomeOrCash - Note to Statistic office . Direct communication
flowstat FSs Submit (*) = totallisted companies/total
sheet state- statements
Financial e-ment enterprisesin 2013.
ment(FCs) ≈ 100% total Authorities of (**): accountingregulation
enterprises(**) Planning and
Investment
Local government
Source: Owned contribution
Figure 3.6: Linkage between enterprises and authoritaties in submitting financial reports
3.1.3.3. Local governments playing preliminary controller in accounting practice
Normally, the central government often wants to use the accounting regulations as an
adjunct of the national financial policy (Nobes and Parker [2000]), while professional
accountants and managers wish to supply accounting information based on the principles of
the market. As the spontaneous solidarity of Vietnamese community, the government plays as
an original body of most accounting decrees or policies, which practitioners have to follow as
an enforcement mechanism. In Figure 3.6, most of Vietnamese enterprises compulsorily
provide their financial reports to local governments’ agencies. This seems to create some
conflict in the domestic market, where those agencies often get the taxation through tax
accounting while the enterprises want to follow the accounting principles in several different
ways. Consequently, this causes Vietnamese book-keepers to focus on the compliance with
tax regulations rather than accounting regulations (Nguyen et al. [2012]). As a result, the
quality of financial statements published by Vietnamese enterprises is directly affected.
Moreover, local government officers are familar with and good at taxation or
bookkeeping rather than accounting (Chu [2004], Nguyen [2013]). In the purpose of tax
payment, it has created the pressure for enterprises making the satisfied administrative
procedures and ignored the function of accounting in making business decision. That is also
44
the reason one enterprise needs to prepare more than one accounting book system which is
mentioned in the next section.
45
For over 7 years in operation, up to June, 2012, VACPA had more than 1.400 members
nationwide who are Vietnamese CPAs and most of them are working in the auditing firms.
This association issued over 2.500 VNCPA’s certificates during 2005-2012, in which the
international qualification reached 700 auditors (VACPA [2012], p. 12). As establishments
operating in principles of volunteer, independence, equality and mutual benefits, Vietnamese
associations have the function of fostering, managing and reviewing accountants and auditors
as well as conducting inspection and review of compliance with laws and accounting,
auditing and service quality. However, both the entry requirements and regulation process are
supervised by the MOF only. Consequently, the power of these associations is still limited to
make them more academically as well as better operational.
46
excessive profits tax (by the Government) and requirements by banks and stockholders with
the main techniques of preparing, including adjustment, analysis (controlling and non-
controlling interests), elimination and accrual sum of respective items. According to Newlove
[1926], the cost value and actual value were mentioned as the key methods in preparing CFSs,
but the legal status for consolidated statement was still absent (at least in the US) (Newlove
[1926], p.6). Similar to this point, Walker [1978a] remarked:
[In the years before 1940] In short, the literature on consolidated statements was
messy (p.268)
In contrast, in the 1940s-1960s when the theory of combination was being agued quite
strongly, the fundamental promulgation of rules in the form and content of consolidated
Statements were clearly described. The security market, the financial press and the
accounting profession emphasized more on the CFSs than the previous period (Walker
[1978a], p 386-388). The consolidated statements were debated as a corollary of major
premise in the interests of investors and creditors (Moonitz [1942], p237; Walker [1978a],
p.344). The proprietary and entity theories were mentioned like two main approaches for
preparing of CFSs (Gardini and Grossi [2014], p.315). The purchase and pooling methods
were debated as key accounting methods for business combination (Walker [1978a], p.355).
In which, the CFSs in proprietary theory stress on providing information to the proprietors on
the part of parent company, while the CFSs by entity approach are presented in the viewpoint
of the whole group as a single entity. It means that in the proprietary approach, the non-
control interest is not disclosed in CFSs, while there is no distinction between control and
non-control interests in entity theory. Moreover, the intercompany transactions are adjusted
in partially elimination by the proportional method in the proprietary theory, whereas they are
eliminated in full under acquisition method of full consolidation in the entity approach.
(Gardini and Grossi [2014], p323). Although, at that time, the controversies about the aim
and disclosing rules for the preparations of CFSs still existed, the CFSs had been accepted as
a vehicle for corporate reporting that described a “group” of companies as a single entity
(Walker [1978a], p386). Additionally, the equity method was accepted in accounting for
inter-corporate investment as the major change in the context of CFS (ibid, p.388).
In 1966, in the efforts to standardize accounting practice, the professional associations in
the UK, Canada and the US established the Accountants’ International Study Group. This
group contributed to setting the preliminary contents of CFSs (Zimmermann and Werner
[2013], p.20-21; Walker [1978a],p.348). In 1973, International Accounting Standard
Committee (IASC) was founded with the great ambition of developing one reporting system
for international level, and then the international collaboration among accountants started to
grow (Zimmermann and Werner [2013]). Shortly afterwards, in 1976, the Committee
published the International Accounting Standards (IAS) No.3 “Consolidated Financial
Statements”. The basis of this document is to supply better information to the shareholders of
parent company and other users. However, it has not been based on a thorough consensus on
the purpose of consolidated statements and still accommodated conflicts among its members
(Walker [1978a], p. 350). After that a series of IAS version were issued and revised to
improve the regulations in CFSs. The early publication in 1983 was IAS 22 “Accounting for
47
Business Combinations” and IAS 27 “Consolidated financial statements and accounting for
investments in subsidiaries was promulgated to supersede IAS 3 in 1989. Notably, after 10
years of applying, in 1993, IAS 22 was amended under a new title “Business Combination”
and once again amended in 1998.
The international accounting harmonization was rising strongly when the IASB was
founded in 2001 to replace the IASC to issue the IFRS since 2004. Consequently, the IAS 27
was amended in 2003 with the new name “Consolidated financial statements and Separate
Financial Statements” and was replaced by IFRS 10 “Consolidated financial statements” in
2011, while the IAS 22 (revised 1998) was superseded by IFRS 3 “Business Combination” in
2004 (amended 2008). Along with the development, the theory of combination and accounting
method for consolidation has fulfilled context, even though they are continuously critiqued in
some details. For instance, the parent company and parent company extension theories have
been discussed as the two variations in international accounting practice of consolidated theory.
From perspective of accounting technique, these theories are more similar to entity theory
rather than proprietary (Gardini and Grossi [2014], p.317), or in other words, the parent
company concept falls somewhere between the entity and proprietary approach (IASB [2006])
(details of different points between these theories are presented in Annex 2). Moreover, the
recent controversy about the advantages of accounting approach for CFSs preparation between
the rule-based and principle-based approaches has risen (Nobes [2004]; Nisbett and Sheikh
[2007]; Ferdy van Beest [2009]; Collins, Pasewark, and Riley [2012]).
According to the current standards, IFRS 10 and IFRS 3, the CFSs are prepared for an
entity (the parent) that controls one or more other entities (subsidiaries) in which the purchase
method is required to account for all inter-transactions. Therefore, the assets, liabilities and
contingent liability of the acquiree need to be recognized by the acquirer at their fair value at
the acquisition date. The goodwill is also recognized and tested for impairment (IFRS 3
[2008]). Moreover, the investor is stressed as the major user of consolidated statements but
investment entities are not accepted to consolidated accounting (IFRS 10 [2011], par 31).
48
group of companies, especially in case of a large proportion of shares and ownership of a
controlling interest (Walker [1978a], p. 148-151).
Proceeding Dickinson’s researches, there were also other studies related to CFSs (at least
in the US) but developed slowly, until 1917-1918 when they was required by the income tax
law, even though they still did not concentrate on the references (Newlove [1949]). In fact,
the topic of CFSs really flourished in the 1920s. One type was the book “Consolidated
balance sheets” by Newlove in 1926. In this book, the underpinning details of accounting
techniques for preparing consolidated balance sheet were interpreted as the elimination
entries for investment, debt between the subsidiary and holding companies; adjustment
entries for surplus, goodwill, minority interest or cost; calculation of cost value, profits or
receivable, etc. The success of his book was presentation of accounting methods including
both the “cost value” and the “actual value” to prove clearly the differences between them in
supplying accounting information of holding company. The book was very useful for
practical accounting because no reference before that was mentioned or presented in a
specific way. In 1949, Newlove continuously developed this topic by publishing the book
“Consolidated Statements: including mergers and consolidation” wherein he provides the
history of article and book about the consolidated accounting and also interpreted the
techniques of preparing consolidated statements in a more logical structure.
Going to the mid 1930s and early 1940s, the research on CFSs in intermediate and
advanced books as well as articles, working papers of training for CPA and students were
continuously published, whereas the principles and procedures of consolidated accounting were
explored deeply. The article by Moonitz in 1942 on the Accounting Review (Vol. 17, No. 3)
was a significant item, in which he proposed the outline of consolidated theory following the
entity approach to consolidated statements. His paper showed the contradictions between the
conventional accounting form and companies’ performance, and the conflicts between the
concept of economic entity and legal entity to conclude the approach from entity to prepare the
CFSs as the advantage mechanism. This was upgraded to the formal theory by himself in 1951
with “The Entity Theory of Consolidated Statement”. From the same aspect of consolidated
principles, Robson [1946] and Childs [1949] also contributed to improvement with books
“Consolidated accounts, principles and procedure” and “Consolidated Financial Statements:
Principles and Procedures”, respectively. However, the consolidated accounting theory only
developed strongly starting in 1950s, with the significant researches concentrating to formulate
the theoretical framework for consolidated accounting such as “Accounting Theory and The
Large Corporation” by Suojanen [1954]; “Enterprise Theory and Corporate balance sheet” by
Suojanen [1958]; “Consolidated and other group accounts holding companies and their
subsidiaries: principles and procedures” by Robson and Duncan [1969].
It was a more attractive theme after 1973 when the IASC (International Accounting
Standard Committee) was founded. One of the early working contribution to this sector is the
research by Walker [1978a, 1978b]. He supplied a full manuscript to scholars and a research
on CFSs through the interpretation of reasonable functions and process of developing CFSs.
He also presented in details the background of regulations for consolidated reporting.
49
Although his book only mentioned two cases of CFSs in the US and the UK, the main whole
theoretical framework of CFSs was reviewed.
In the period of 1980- 2000, the theory of consolidated accounting continued to be
studied extensively on multi elements of CFSs. For instance, the concepts, issues and
techniques by Taylor [1987]; the preparation by Blonimaert [1996], Oguri [2002]; the
disclosure by Kitchen [1973], Walker and Mack [1998]; the innovation or adoption by
Bircher [1988], Edwards and Richard [1991]; adjustment by Day and Sparos [1996], Pan et al.
[2014]; national case study by Whittered [1987]; Lowe [1990]; Heald and Georgious[2000];
Kanamori [2005]. It was noted, in recent two decades, the harmonization or convergence of
CFSs has become a so booming topic (Baltariu and Cîrstea, [2012]; Muller [2014]; Cîrstea
and Baltariu. [2014]) that the considerations about creating the national standards following
the international system (IFRS) have been strongly debated (Baker and Barbu[2007]), even
most of them merely concentrated on theoretical system rather than practitioners.
Generally, from the viewpoint of business companies, we have not found many first -
hand researches about CFSs (at least at the time of this study). As mentioned in previous
paragraphs, the researches of theoretical framework were explored as early as in the 1920s,
but the first evaluation of CFS preparation was not conducted as the academic reports until
1980s. Typically, the studies (articles) were undertaken by Yoshio [1978] in the US;
Whittered [1986, 1988]in Australia; Bircher and Paul [1988] in Great Britain; Mora. and
Rees [1998] in Spain; Walker and Mack [1998] extended the research by Whittered [1987] in
Australia. In recent years, the researches by Srinivasan and Narasimhan [2008] concentrated
on the case of India companies through an analysis of CFSs between Parent-only and whole
group; Müller [2011, 2014] studied the quality of CFS by European countries; and so on.
Generally, most researches used primary data through the stock markets or the publications of
CFSs by companies, a limited number of studies use the direct approach by business entity.
Similarly, this situation has also occurred in Vietnam. Generally, there are not so many
studies on CFSs in the approach of direct enterprise aspects.
3.2.2. Accounting context for Consolidation and Consolidated Financial Statements in Vietnam
50
No.25) - Consolidated Financial Statements and Accounting for Investment in Subsidiaries. In the
same tendency with other VASs, built basing on IASs, the VAS 25 was also designed following
IAS 27 (1989) respectively. In 2005, nearly two years after issuing VAS 25, the relevant
guidelines for implementation were published by Circular of guidance for implementation of the
VAS (system of third series) amended in 2007. In the same year, 2005, on the publication of the
next four VASs, the VAS 11 “Business Combination” was issued. Especially, on 12 December
2014, the MOF promulgated new Circulars “Guideline for Preparation and Presentation of
Consolidated Financial Statements” to replace the previous regulations under standards about
the CFSs. It is noted that this is the first Vietnamese regulation of CFSs separated from other
aspects of accounting sector. It was directly applied to the economic groups as well as State
corporations with the full valuation at present. Although the main accounting measurements and
treatments for consolidation seem to be not new, even not fruitful and inconsistent compared with
other regulations (Le [2015], Nguyen [2015], Tran [2015]), this Circular has significantly helped
to clarify many accounting consolidated regulations in Vietnam at present.
Following the current regulation system, the CFSs are prepared mainly following entity
theory of combination, while several specific areas still accept theory of parent company (such as
accounting for the intra-group transactions) as presented in VAS 25 below:
In preparing consolidated financial statements, the financial statements of the parent
and its subsidiaries are combined on a line-by-line basis by adding together like items
of assets, liabilities, equity, income and expenses. In order that the consolidated
financial statements present financial information about the group as that of a single
enterprise, (par.12)
The purchase method is a current regulation in accounting for business combination in
Vietnam while the historical principle is still applied to recognition and measurement of major
business transactions. There are only few practical cases of acceptation in the fair value (Law on
Accounting 2015, article 28). The goodwill and non-controlling interests require to be recognized
immediately at the acquisition date, and the amortization method is used to represent the manner
in which sources embodying economic benefits from goodwill can be recovered.
51
Statements and Accounting for Investments in Subsidiaries (VAS 25), was a project of a
lecturer group at the Academy of Finance in 2004 to develop the accounting system for
groups of company model. After that was the research by Ngo et. al. [2005] presenting the
CFSs as a part of content on the textbook about the implementation of VAS 25. Around that
time, most of researches in consolidated accounting were conducted in training programs
held at the academic institution or university as the graduate thesis or post-graduate
researches or working paper. For example, one author [2006] researched the CFSs of
Vietnam Airline Corporation as the case study for her master thesis; Tran [2007] also
reported, in her master thesis, the current situation and gave recommendation for preparation
and presentation of the CFSs in Vietnamese enterprises through the evaluation of the existing
VASs. In the last years of the 2000s, the situation of CFS studies was improved by the
academic articles, namely Dang [2009] who published his research on Accounting Review
related to the inter-transaction as the guideline for CFS preparation in Vietnam; Chuc [2009]
who supplied the book entries of accounting for income-tax in process of consolidation;
Nguyen C. P[2009] who focused on the accounting method for consolidation and specific
explanation for presentation of CFSs; and Nguyen P. G [2009] who published the textbook
providing the guideline and basic book entries of consolidated accounting. Notably these
studies focused on the specific technique or accounting entries (as the guideline of regulation
implementation) rather than explored new points for improvement.
On the contrary, in early years of the 2010s, the CFS attracted quite strongly the academic
researchers nationwide. The early research by Mai [2010] supplied the detailed obstacles as
well as drawbacks of VAS on the CFSs, and respective accounting regulations for
implementation. Her research focused on the consistency of different regulation levels for
consolidated accounting and found gaps existing between them as the negative points of the
accounting system. Following that, in 2011, the study by Doan analysed in detail a typical
case study about preparation of the CFSs by Hoang Ha group for her doctoral program. This
research provided the whole system of accounting at private groups in CFS preparation. Her
study was successful as to reflect the negative side as well as the positive of business
characteristics affecting the accounting organization in consolidated purpose. In another one
by Nguyen [2013], the relationship between the information of the CFS and the
understanding of users was explored. His research provided the typical points of the CFSs in
getting financial position of entity and mentioned the prerequisite knowledge required of
users about the consolidated accounting as one of recommendations for improvement.
Similar to Nguyen’s [2013], the research by Nguyen and Nguyen [2013] also mentioned
the benefits to users in relation with the presentation of the CFSs by Vietnamese economic
groups. But it impressed the investors of listed companies rather than the users in general.
Their research conclusion provided the specific information to confront the inconsistence of
number on the financial reports (including the CFSs) of listed companies. This has been
assumed as unclear financial information.
Recently, Pham [2014] presented her article in Vietnamese Accounting and Auditing
Review related to the differences between the IFRS and the VAS for the CFS. Her paper
reflected the elements of the current regulations in Vietnamese consolidated accounting in
52
accounting method, measurements and recognition on consolidation as disadvantages for
international harmonization. The conclusions of her study contributed to a few of exiting
literature about consolidated accounting in Vietnam. However, the main contents of her
research were supplied based on the side of standards of accounting, while the whole system
of accounting regulation still was not revealed. Obviously, Tran [2014] described an almost
full picture of the accounting system on consolidated sector in her doctoral dissertation when
she researched directly the convergence of VAS with the IFRS for the CFSs in Vietnam. Her
study overviewed the detailed criterion of convergence on measurements and gave the
conclusions of the convergence level between the two systems respectively, through analysis
of different types of the regulations as well as the fluctuation of practitioners at listed
companies. The research results also contributed to making clear the current position of
consolidated accounting regulations in Vietnam, especially the influence of stock market on
requirements of the CFSs. Nevertheless, her sources of research data were main secondary
which was collected through the Internet database or public data of stock market.
During the recent decade, beside the researches who focused on convergence or
harmonization between the VAS and the IFRS, many other researches on accounting
technique, measurement or recognition of consolidation have been continued in Vietnam. For
instance, Le and Phi [2014] researched specific entry technique of the investment in joint-
stock or association company when preparing the CFSs. Their conclusions have been much
useful for practitioners, while the system of regulation is still in lack of appropriate points; or
the research by Nguyen [2015] was on a specific situation of Vinacomin group in
presentation and preparation of the CFSs as her doctoral dissertation. Her research provided
in detail the accounting organization for business activities between holding company and
subsidiaries in group as well as the business features of group effect on preparing the CFSs.
Notably, along with national economic improvement, there are more and more academic
studies about the Vietnamese consolidated accounting in multiple different aspects. Some of
them explored the specific consolidated accounting regulations which affect directly or
indirectly presentation of the CFSs, while others focused largely on the consistence or
convergence or harmonization of the VASs with the IFRSs for the CFSs with the higher
academy information. Nevertheless, it is not difficult to realize that the empirical researches
on Vietnamese consolidated accounting are still limited, especially in the field of economic
groups. While the regulation system still reveals the significant inconsistency (Pham [2014])
and the renew version of VAS has not yet come, the studies on the side of practitioners are
necessary to improve the current situation beside other elements. This is also the main reason
why interviews of economic groups were done for this study.
53
goal is still not achieved. A direct reason, which has contributed to this trend, is the rising
demands for comparability and transparency in financial reports to control the international
business activities, and another reason is the greater participation of multi- national companies
all over the world. The underpinning causes of these phenomena come from the tendency of
globalization nowadays. Obviously, the rapid integration of international economy leads to an
increasing formal harmonization of accounting across the world. The proponents of
harmonization contend that a mandatory setting standard across countries is a reasonable
approach in improving comparability among international financial statements (Zarzeki [1996],
p.18; Nobes and Parker [2000]). Wherein, the convergence and adoption of IFRS have been
discussed as part in the researches on international accounting harmonization.
Table 3.3: Relationship among convergence, harmonization and adoption
Level of Adoption Relationship area Convergence
harmonization case VASs IASs/IFRS degree
Full-harmonization Full adoption likely become one system of standard Full convergence
Multi-level of A lot of the same contents (not
Non-full or
harmonization Partial all) between two systems
partial
(including minimum adoption Partial same or similar contents between
convergence
harmonization) two systems
Separate system- Separate system -
Co-existence standards Non adoption Non convergence
national standards International standards
Source: Owned contribution
One point in the harmonization progress on accounting sector should be clarified, i.e. the
convergence does not have the same meaning as adoption. Both adoption and convergence
refer to applying different standards, policies or regulations for one objective. However,
adoption puts emphasis on how to apply rather than how to set up the content of this standard
or policy for objective area, while convergence is often attached to where the contents of
standard can fit or acclimatize one in the applied area. Following Zimmermann and Weiner
[2013], adoption designates the use of international standards (or another one) instead of
national standards (or national rule), whereas convergence depicts the successive alignment
of international standard (another one) and national standard. This means that a national
accounting standard remains in force but the national standard is aligned with international
one in an either unilateral or a reciprocal way (Zimmermann et al. [2013], pp. 28-29). For
example, in the case of Vietnam, the adoption of in Vietnam implies to create a similar one
nationally, while the convergence with IASs focuses on considering which point of IASs
should be put in the Vietnamese system to fit the domestic market. Notably, it is difficult to
work out exactly distinctive meanings between convergence and adoption because the full
adoption also means the full convergence as well as the full harmonization. In other words,
the levels of adoption or harmonization go beyond the convergence degree, and their
relationship is summarized in Table 3.3.
In detail, the harmonization was close to “standardization” or “uniformity” (a single
standards or rule to all situations) rather than reconciliation or accompany (bringing together)
of different points of views (Alsharairi and Al-Abdullah [2009]). However, following the
time, these concepts sound more practical and logical, and the harmonization was often
54
defined as the process of easing the accounting differences to the extent of standardization
(Bran (Stan) et al.[2011], p.54), or a process of increasing the compatibility of accounting
practices by setting limits on how much they can differ. The formal (or de jure) and material
(or de facto) harmonization are the two main kinds in most of the researches on accounting
(Mijoč and Starčević [2013], p.127), in which the formal one implies to similarities and
diversities in rules and regulations among different countries, clusters or groups, while the
material type refers to the practical views by different enterprises (Fritz and Lämmle [2003]).
Normally, the formal harmonization will lead to material, whereas the material harmonization
also might take place without being furthered by formal one at the same time (Caňibano and
Mora [2000]).
Extending these options, the accounting harmonization has been discovered in various
theme including uniformity, conceptual framework, comparative studies, accounting
directives, environmental factor and now is the accounting harmonization among
industrialized countries applying IAS/IFRS ((Backer and Barbu[2007], p.292). Typically,
there are a number of study conclusions stating that the accounting harmonization also means
harmonization of financial reports, or setting limits to the difference among financial reports
of different companies of either the difference or same nation (Van der Tas [1988]; Fritz and
Lämmle [2003]). Supporting this option, this study developed that accounting harmonization
closes to harmonizing financial statements by economic groups. Therefore, accounting
harmonization following the IFRSs with a focus on the CFSs, has also been explored to
reflect the current situation in Vietnam in the next section.
Create Create
VAS VAS11
Economic
revolution
VASs IASs/IFRS
area
Non-convergence Rising convergence
Time flow
Source: Owned contribution
Figure 3.7: Accounting harmonization process
This process has been continued since that time up to now in Vietnam, wherein the
system of accounting regulation has developed from the indirect policies (in the 1990s) to the
direct policies (in 1997); from the situation without harmonization standards (in 1997) to the
55
case of setting the IASs being harmonization standards (in the 2000s), from the
harmonization process by non-convergence with the IASs (in 2001) to having the significant
convergence with the IASs in the CFSs. Obviously, the degree of convergence between the
VASs and the IASs has been rising following the existing accounting reformations in
Vietnam. Unfortunately, since 2005 the IASs have undergone many changes while the
reformation of VASs in CFS has not yet been conducted since 2003 except for the relative
guidance for implementation. In 2014, a new reformation was issued by MOF as an
accounting circular, which is also the regulation under standards on the CFSs. Although this
renew covers significant context as the updated and reformative prior regulation respectively
(Nguyen [2015]), the main accounting measurements and treatments for accounting
consolidation still remain intact.
Applying gradually the IASs (published before the 2000s) in building the current VASs,
the sandwich of non-convergence and convergence areas between two systems has existed.
The non-convergence seems stronger after the IASs has been converted to IFRS. Beside the
converging contents on objective, accounting method, reporting date and uniform accounting
policy, requirement, disclosure and recognition or measurement respectively are setting, the
key points of non-convergence in business combination and CFS between the VAS and the
IAS have been found as bellows:
(1) The measurement and recognizing goodwill and non-controlling on CFSs: In
accordance with IAS/IFRS, the non-controlling interest measurement in the acquiree includes
not only relevant amount at its full fair value but also at appropriate share of acquiree’s
identifiable net assets, while the recognizing goodwill relates to either 100% of the business
or the percentage interest acquired. In fact, the VAS required separately non-controlling
interest and the acquirer’s interest in the net fair value of acquiree’s identifiable assets,
liabilities and contingent liabilities.
(2) The accounting treatment: The IFRS only accepts the acquisition accounting, and
requires recording the assets acquired and liabilities assumed on the acquirer’s books at their
respective fair value, and it also permits the allowed alternative treatment. In contrast, the
existing VASs have regulated the benchmark treatment as unique measurement for the
respective areas, particular in accounting for non-controlling interest (Pham [2014]).
(3). The measurement principle of standards: Under the current IFRS, the acquirer
recognizes assets acquired and liabilities assumed at the acquisition-date fair value, and the
CFSs supply the financial information that enable users to evaluate the nature and financial
effects of acquisition. On the contrary, the fair value principle in the VASs is still limited,
even not acceptable in some areas of identifiable investee.
In detail, the non-convergences of VAS on consolidated accounting are showed as bellows:
56
Table 3.4: Non-convergence areas in consolidated accounting between VAS and IFRS
Non-convergence area
Criteria IFRS 3(revised 2008), IFRS 10 (2012) VAS 25(2003), VAS 11 (2005)
Improve the relevance, reliability and To prescribe the accounting policies and
Objective and comparability of information on the financial procedures in relation to business
scope statements in a business combination combinations
Establish principles and requirements for how
acquirer
Requires recognizing and measuring the Require measuring the cost of business
Acquisition identifiable assets acquired, liabilities assumed,
combination and allocating this cost,
method non-controlling interest in the acquire and at the acquisition date, to the assets
goodwill or gain from a bargain purchase acquired and liabilities and contingent
liabilities assumed.
Measurement The investment in each subsidiary is measured at Using the cost method to carrying
fair value amount of the investment
Consolidation Mention to combine or eliminate the cash flow of No mention to combine cash flow of the
Procedure the parent and its subsidiaries, respectively parent and its subsidiaries
Potential voting Regulate for the potential voting or other derivative Present on the regulation under
rights containing potential voting rights exist the rate of accounting standards
profit or loss and changes in equity allocated to the
parent and non-controlling interest in CFSs
57
Chapter 4: DEVELOPMENT OF ECONOMIC GROUPS
4.1. ECONOMIC GROUPS IN VIETNAM
Simple Compound
combination combination
Association Association
Consolidation Federation
58
compound combination has separated into three levels: “federation”, “association” and
“consolidation”. The federation is organization which remains separately and retain
considerable autonomy: mostly simple “agreements” and pools, while the association is
mentioned as the loosest agreements directly among individual members of different
associations: trade “association”; or some simple “agreements”. Unlikely, consolidation is a
combination form that the members may remain nominally separation, and business direction
is integrated. Under the consolidation, the partial and complete consolidations are key options.
The security holding is presented that belongs to partial consolidation. It implies the direction
of business organizations consolidated through the stock ownership, with separate existence
formally maintained. The complete consolidation is divided into: merger - similar securities
holding with the member of one business organization absorbed by another; and
amalgamation - similar securities holding with the member of two or more organizations
coalesce to form a new organization as the partial consolidation (Haney [1913, 2003]).
Generally, the main relationship among the different combination organizations is illustrated
in Figure 4.1. Notably, the word “association” is often used to imply personal relations linked in
fellowship rather than in trading or business firm, whereas both words “federation” and
“consolidation” can apply in business life. Among them, the best usage in business is the term
“consolidation” while the “federation” is popular in political sectors (ibid, p.73-74). The term
“business combination” implies a reference to the simple business event of one business
combining with other (Sapienza [1964], p.50). In other words, a business combination happens
when two or more entities come under a common ownership (Herring [2003], p.1). From these
views, the types of business combination are found mostly in the structure of under partial
consolidation (normal under the holding company) and complete consolidation (under the merger
or amalgamation). They can be modified basically in Figure 4.2.
CompanyA1 Company C
(B dissolved) (A and B dissolved)
Case 1: Merger of company B into company A Case 2: Consolidation of company A
and B into company C
Company A Company B
Company D
(A: parent; B: subsidiary)
Case 3: Acquisitions of stock business combination
59
of companies the assets and liabilities of one or more companies are combined into a single
company. Case 2 is similar to case 1, but the new company is often formed from the merger of
two or more companies. In the last case, through the acquisition of stock, one company
acquires more than 50% of the outstanding voting common stock of another company, but both
companies remain separate entities (Herring [2003], p.5-6). The acquirer is usually called the
parent company, while the acquiree is named the subsidiary company.
b. Performance of business combination in economic groups
In fact, the typical performance of business combination is popular in groups of
enterprises/companies or among economic entities (called economic groups herein after) that
business combinations are undertaken for the legitimate business reasons in one or more
nations. In a nation, they are usually observed in the emerging companies that include a
group of companies and is separated into one or more different levels. Each level has one
company which plays as the holding company or parent company to facilitate the
combination, and other companies play as subsidiaries. However, at the global level, the
business combination is usually performed as the multi-national enterprises that include
groups of companies in the different countries. The multi-national enterprises also have the
core features of business combination at national level, but they often operate in lager market
and business size.
Along with the increasing international integration, there have been more and more
economic groups under multinational enterprises. The date of the first establishment of a
multinational enterprise is not found in any literatures, whereas the time of the earliest
multinational enterprise in the United Kingdom, Gallerani Company that had a branch in
London was mentioned in the early 14th century in the book by Nobes and Parker [2000]. In
their book, they provided that since the late 16th century onwards, Gallerani Company kept
expanding as the charter land and trading companies to Dutch and French East India
Company. In the United States the mergers also occurred in 1850s, but the business
combination had not been great formation until 1870s when the general corporation laws
were promulgated. According to Haney [1913, 2003], the US Shipbuilding Company and
Bethlehem Steel Company were an effective trade combination during that time. But, only
after 1890-1900s the US business combination developed strongly with the famous case of
the Standards Oil Company as well as the American Tobacco Company under the holding
company or complete consolidation (Haney [1993, 2003], p.113-116).
The modern structure of multinational enterprises was also found in the period 1870 -
1914 in Europe (Nobes and Parker [2000], p. 8). After that, the business combination model
has grown in different countries all over the world, such as the model of “Consortium”,
“Conglomerate”, “Cartel”, “Trust”, “Alliance”, “Syndicate” “Group” in Germany, France and
other countries in Europe, “Zaibatsu” or “Keiretsus” in Japan; “Chaelbo” in Korea, “Jituan
Gongsi” in China, and so on. Up to now, many of them continue developing as the strong
groups on the international market. Unfortunately, in Vietnam, the economic groups still lack
reputation in the global market. It is noted that their establishment and development are
mainly under government’s interaction. In order to look at this point in detail, next section
presents a short review about economic groups in Vietnam.
60
4.1.1.2. Historical development of economic groups in Vietnam
Although both kinds of partial and complete consolidations occur in business
combination in Vietnam, most of them are based on conglomerate structure rather than others
(Ngo et al [2005]). This section discusses the brief history of establishment of business
combination to reveal a map on development of economic groups in Vietnam.
Following the chronological development, the study divides the economic groups’
improvement in Vietnam into the three stages in Figure 4.3 as bellows:
• Company Law and Law on
2005-present private enterprise (1990) 2005-present
• In 1994: State corp. 90 and
State corp. 91
•StateCorporationand State group
•Privateeconomicgroups
•Under SOEs Law(2003) and
1986-2004 EnterpriseLaw(2005, 2014)
•Equitizationof SOEs
•In 9/2012:13State groups;10“State
• Charter capital held by corporations 91”’, 2commercial
Government or rarely by banks ;80“state corporation90
1945-1985 private sectors “(OECD,2013)
• Under SOEs Law (1995,2003) •In 12/2012: 10 State groups
a. Period of 1945-1985
Early years of the first stage, after becoming an independent nation in 1945 and
knocking out American colonists in 1954, Vietnam chose SOEs as the essential entity of the
domestic market. These enterprises became the root of the current State economic groups in
Vietnam. At that time, they operated in the form of cooperatives and enterprises union.
Under the mechanism of central control, each union ran business on several aspects of one
specific industry including two levels: a high level as the organizations which included
different departments working as the general controlling; a low level as independent State-
owned firms or State owned companies that did business directly. Generally, the business
decision making was concentrated at the top level, while the direct managers did not
receive enough powers to do business activities by themselves (Doan et. al [2004]).
In fact, the economic groups’ operation at time, 1945-1985, was quite weak. The
business combination under the association model was more than consolidation, while the
private groups were not permitted by legislation. The term “economic group” was still far
from thinking of most investors in Vietnam in that period, at least as the name of business
entity in regulation.
b. Period of 1986-2004
Until 1986 when the economic reformation, “Doi moi” started in Vietnam, the private
sector had not shared the decision-making power in the market. The SOEs’ restructure was
conducted following the market economic strategy under the socialist orientation. Starting
with the Company Law and the Law of Private Enterprises issued in 1990, there were significant
61
changes in domestic market. Especially, in the March 1994, the government promulgated
Decision No 90/TTg to reform SOEs and No 91/TTg to establish the pilot business groups, the
State corporations were founded in Vietnam. Under Decision No 90/TTg, the “State corporation
90” was formed with at least five board members and book equity of VND 500 billion (typical
situation with 100 billion). Unlikely, the “State corporation 91” needs to have at least seven board
members and book equity of VND 1,000 billion as compulsories of No. 91/TTg. Comparing to
the independent SOEs, the State corporations were subject to higher governance standards and
closer with the aim of forming business conglomerates known as the current economic group
model in Vietnam (Kim et al. [2010], p.3).
In 1995, the Law of State enterprise was enacted on 20thApril as the common legal
regulation applied to all SOEs. One year later, the mechanism of State corporations was
declared on Decision dated 28th August 1996 by Ministry of Finance. This decision is a
detailed regulation to encourage SOEs development. Its new point is that more power of
decision making was moved to the direct managers than in the first period. Typically, at this
time, the stock market also started its early operation in Vietnam. The first step was the
establishment of Security Exchange Commission in 1996. Then the progress of equitization
began accelerating, particularly among the SOEs.
During five years (1992-1996), only five SOEs were equitized, but in 1998 this indicator
reached up to 30 SOEs (ibid, p.5-6). From 1999 to 2000, the SOE’s equitization continued in
Vietnam, yet, the number of SOEs with 100% State ownership reduced, from more than
12.000 in 1996 to 6,000 in 2000 (OECD [2013]). In 2000, the Security Exchange
Commission issued the regulations of member, listing, disclosure and securities trading as the
important regulation for the SOEs’ equitization. After that there was a number of SOEs listed
on the stock exchange. Although most of the listed former SOEs were of small and medium
size (Kim et al. [2010]), this tendency contributed to development of the domestic market and
the increasing demand for business combination in Vietnam.
In 2003, the new Law of State enterprises (on 26th November) was promulgated to replace
the Law of State enterprises 1995. Many decrees were published to continuously improve the
equitization program (Decree 44 (1998), Decree 64 (2002), Decree 187 (2004), etc.), the
movement of economic reformation became stronger. The achievement in SOE’s equitization
contributed to changes in legal framework of many aspects, which leads to the primary
success of economic development in market orientation. However, it still seemed to be far
from the expectation, and the international integration in Vietnamese regulation systems was
limited during that time. The State corporations’ structure (including state corporations 90
and 91) did not have enough differences between before and after equitization to create big
changes in the economy.
c. Period of 2005-present
Up to 2005, with regards to ownership and economic sector, the Enterprise Law was
approved and amended in 2009 to create a new legal framework for all enterprises. This legal
permitted the SOEs diversified into State companies, joint stock companies, limited liability
companies, economic groups and state corporations. Additionally, in the same year 2005, the
State Capital Investment Corporation (SCIC) was established to help the SOE in equitization as
62
an important step to improve the government’s ownership in economy (OECD [2013]; Kim et al.
[2010]), and then the business combination has become really a booming tendency in the
domestic market. In the Governmental Decree dated 5th November 2009 about the pilot
establishment of State economic groups, the State corporations’ reformation was conducted
continuously and more explicitly in Vietnam. Typically, the big-size State enterprises model was
built in strategically important sectors in economy, namely insurance, post and
telecommunications, electricity, petroleum, coal and minerals, oil and natural gas, textile and
garment, rubber, etc. The transferring tendency from general State corporation to State economic
group has increased. The economic group structure is operated mostly under the parent-
subsidiary companies, while the general State corporation is designed an independent enterprise.
The group itself does not have a legal identification, and therefore does not register under the
Law of Enterprise, whereas the one general State corporation must be formed by SOE Law 2003
and partly under the Law of Enterprise (2005, revised 2013).
By the end of 2012, Vietnam had 13 State economic groups, 10 State corporations 91, 2
commercial banks fully owned by the government (to sum up 25 State economic groups and
State corporations), and over 80 independent State corporations mainly converted from State
corporation 90 (OECD [2013], p.12). Among 13 State economic groups, twelve have been under
the control of the Prime Minister and one (BaoViet-group) has been under control of the Ministry
of Finance. Most of them (except for BaoViet group) have been held by the State as the
dominating share of capital (at least 51 percent capital in parent companies) (World Bank and
Donor working group, 2012, p 47). However, at the end of 2013, three State economic groups
had to transfer to holding company or corporation model because of their inefficiency in practical
business operation. They are HUB group, VNIC group, Vinashin group (detailed in Annex 5).
The plan limiting the number of State economic groups (less than 8 groups) has been debated
recently in mass media (Nguyen and Nguyen [2013], p.45)
For private sector, although there are not any direct regulations that the private economic
groups have or have not been allowed to be established in Vietnam, in fact, many private
enterprises have operated in the domestic market such as Vinagroup, Hoa Phat group, FPT group,
Vincom group, Kinh Do, Trung Nguyen, and so on. Most of them are organized as the merger or
conglomerate including the parent and subsidiary companies. They are operated under the Law of
Enterprise (2005, replaced 2014) and focus on the specific industries that are not monitors of the
economy. Compared to the State economic groups, the private groups do not have much support
from the government, while the State economic groups have been provided with the privileged
access and autonomy to enable them to compete with foreign firms and others. They are designed
as a tool for macroeconomic adjustment to perform the government’s social functions (World
Bank and Donor working group, 2011, p 36), while the absence of respective supports from the
government for the private sector has existed. During 2005-present, there have been many
different regulations as the guideline for implementation in economic groups, even though they
mainly focus on the State groups (such as: Decree No. 111 on 26 June 2007 about organization,
operation the State corporation and the conversation of independent corporation to the parent-
subsidiary companies; Decree No 101 in 2009 about pilot establishment of State economic group;
Decision No. 929 in July 2012 about SOE restructuring puts the focus on restructuring of State-
owned economic groups and State-owned corporations in period 2011-2015; Decree No. 69 in
63
July 2014 replace Decree No 101 in 2009; etc.). With big reformation in legislation for doing
business in the recent years, especially Law of Enterprises in 2014 (replaced 2005), Law of
Investment in 2014 (replaced 2005), the economic groups’ development in Vietnam has been
more explicit and academic than in previous periods.
Overall, the business combination form in Vietnam started in the 1990s, but the mechanism
of group following the parent-subsidiary has been functional for only the last decade. At the
moment, there are both private and State economic groups in Vietnam, whereas the State group’s
contribution to GDP is still dominant in domestic market (OECD, 2013, p 11). The economic
group’s structure encompasses simple (one way) and complex (two ways) consolidations. In
which the simple is a popular structure with two levels (one parent and one or more subsidiaries),
while the complex consolidated model has often performed in more than three levels (one parent,
one or more subsidiaries and one or more grand-subsidiaries) (Tran [2014, p.92).
4.1.2.1 Characteristics
For a long time as a colony in the past and a developing country for the time being,
Vietnamese economic groups have embedded typical characteristics in forming motivation
and developing perspective. This section focuses on some of their emerging features, i.e.:
The first: Establishment based on the interaction of government rather than the market demand
This is much different from the cases in other countries (compares with the US, the UK
and Germany), Vietnamese economic groups, especially in the State sector, have been
formed mainly by reforming or transferring from the general corporation (State corporation
90 and corporation 91) rather than based on the market demand. They are often through the
direct government interaction (Decision of the Prime Minister) instead of the market
development or increasing competition. Consequently, the business management in economic
groups has been controlled by the administrative procedure rather than its actual requirements.
It is popular that the subsidiaries’ operations are under control or absolute care of the
parent/holding company. For example, in the inter-transaction of investment, the investment
movement often occurs from the subsidiary with extra capital, to another subsidiary in lack of
capital for business operation, under decision of holding company rather than the real demand
for investment among themselves (Nguyen [2014]). Moreover, the relationship among capital,
finance and market is loose, while the connection between experts, researchers and business
managers among the subsidiaries has also been inappropriate (ibid, p.25).
The second: No legal status but must to prepare the CFSs
According to the current Law of Enterprises 2014, an economic group has no legal status
and does not need to register business under this law. Its parent company, nevertheless, has to
prepare and present the CFSs for the entire group. For this, the parent company plays as a
presenter of the whole group to disclose their CFSs, while the CFS’s quality depends directly
on the separate financial reports or financial information from the subsidiary companies.
Unfortunately, many of them do still not manage these reports well. Thus, the financial
information on their CFSs is often in lack of the credence, fullness for users to make
64
decisions (Pham [2014]). Moreover, in some cases of State economic groups, the parent
companies do not focus on running business in the same line with their subsidiaries, whereas
they are the big investors with strong power to interact deeply on their subsidiaries’ operation
by the internal specific policies (Truong [2008]). Therefore, the business combination model
is still far from the complete consolidation, and the consolidated financial statement in
Vietnam has not yet in full development.
The third: Private groups have been gradually but lack of driving legislation from government
Along with the economic development, more and more the private groups have contributed
significantly to improvement of the economy nowadays in Vietnam (CIEM [undated]).
Especially, the investment ratio of private sector increased from 22.9% in 2000 to 33.9% in
2009 (Nguyen [2010], p.6). In 2012, its manufacturing value reached about 50% of GDP of
nation. One of the causes of these results is the legal reformation for business environment in
practice during the last decades. However, as mentioned in the previous section, the formal
legal regulations to drive these groups have been limited as presented by CIEM [undated]:
[…]during last time [before 2008] the model of private economic group seems to be
still not accepted, many of them have to operate under the Vietnamese name that is
not business consolidation, for example “Công ty cổ phần tập đoàn”, “công trách
nhiệm hữu hạn tập đoàn”, etc. (p.6).
In fact, the private groups operate mainly under Law of Enterprise (amended 2014).
There has been no specific regulation, including under law and standards respectively,
formally issued for direct control of private groups until now. This means the private
economy has been still confusing with common private enterprise in legal system. This seems
unfair, while the State economic groups have been taken by many regulations as mentioned in
the previous section. Paradoxically, a lot of major private groups have created their reputation
(at least in domestic market), such as Vinamilk group, FPT group, Vincom group, etc.
The fourth: A limit development in stock exchanges
After moving to market orientation in 1986, the first Vietnam stock market opened in 2000 in
Ho Chi Minh city (HOSE). Then the second market appeared in Hanoi capital (HNX) in 2005.
The total number of the listed companies at that time in both markets was over 30 and
increased to 193 in early 2007 and reached over 580 by mid-2010 (Truong [2013]). By the
end of 2015, there were around 700 listed companies in the both HOSE and HNX
(cophieu.68). Nonetheless, most of the listed companies are small-sized joint stock
companies, majority of them were from former SOEs (Truong [2013]).
According to Tran [2014], there were only 140 in 650 listed companies of her survey in
2011 under economic groups (including parent and subsidiary), while the main ones were
under single entity (only parent or subsidiary company). Particularly, many of them have
the subsidiaries formed in different methods of consolidation: equity, acquisition or merger.
65
Table 4.1: Listed companies following characteristics of consolidation and business types before
listed in stock market
Characteristics of Consolidation (parent/subsidiary/group and Business type before listing on stock Total[#]
method of combination) market[#]
SOEs Non-SOEs New enterprise
1. Non-consolidated company (joint-stock company) 52 24 36 112
2. Consolidated company
2.1. Subsidiary company[*] 204 13 37 254
2.2. Parent/holding company[**] 69 42 33 144
Notably, most listed companies must submit their financial statements (including the
CFSs) under strict requirements of stock market and current Law of Enterprises.
Unfortunately, some of the parent companies did not supply (Tran [2014]), while some others
(more than non-supplying) provided their CFSs without one or more separate financial
reports from their subsidiaries. For this matter, Tran [2014] presented different reasons such
as: the temporary power for control; or newly formed subsidiary; or the subsidiary that does
not submit its financial statements; or very few business activities in combination; and so on.
It is noted that there is no interpretation or explanation from these companies to account for
their regulation breakup.
The fifth: Still weak governance and few achievements, especially in State groups
The modern system in business governance including information system for
management and report system for business governance following international standards has
not been yet popular in Vietnam (Pham [2014], Nguyen [2014]). The governance model that
complies with corporate governance rules or between Chief Executive Officer (CEO) and
Chief Financial Officer (CFO) is not so much applied to Vietnamese State economic groups
(Nguyen [2014], p.27). Especially, there is much confusion in terms of power of owners,
manager/director, governor and controller in these groups (Pham [2014], p.14). It is often a
case that a manager can be a member not only in the board of directors but also the CEO,
while the power of a CEO in making decisions in these groups depends largely on the
government (Nguyen and Nguyen [2013], p.44). This has influenced directly business
achievement during the last decade as put in the presentation by Nguyen [2014]
Despite of some big economic groups at the top level of Vietnamese business ranking
but none of them on list of top 500 enterprises of Forbers ranking. […]. The business
results of Vietnamese State economic groups have been low. Many subsidiaries have
operated ineffectively […](p.26).
66
In order to interpret this situation, according to MAG [2014] there are two main reasons:
one is a great ratio of the State sector in economy, another is the governance structure with
multi-levels and the lack of straightforward operating manner (p.112). For the governance
structure, in fact, many managers or directors in the State groups do business with the
attitudes of avoiding their legal responsibilities from the business loss (Nguyen and Nguyen
[2013], p.46). In other words, they still lack skills and abilities for business management, or
such economic groups still have weak mechanism of internal governance as Kim et al [2010]
presented:
[…] this process (economic group development) is dominated by the bureaucrats in
Vietnam. […]. Also, no rules exists disqualifying board members that directly or
indirectly have business relationship with the company they serve. Vietnam also
introduced performance-based pay and target-completion pay for its SOE managers.
But, the pays are structured in a way that may distort the incentives of managers. […].
Also, pay is not based on long-term performance, but solely based on prior year’s
performance. This may induce managers to make myopic business decisions. (p. 10-11).
67
The divesting capital movement takes place in two levels (Pham [2014], p.4). The first
arises at the government that has divested State capital in the most non-key sectors of
economy. For example, the government is monopoly (controlling 100% equity) in the
enterprise on macroeconomic stabilization (such as: political, security, infrastructure
industries), and also can hold less than 100% equity of business (even less 50%) on the
specific sector of industries (such as: mineral processing; insurance; environment protection,
etc.). The second occurs at economic groups, in which State groups reduce their investment
outside their main line business. For example, a State economic group that is assigned main
lines of business on electricity will divest their capital outside electrical sector.
The third: Gradually adopting international standards on economic groups’ governance
The current national strategy (announced in 2012) is to develop economic groups following
the international standards of governance structure (ibid; Nguyen [2014]), which means to
continue improving mechanisms and issuing regulations on representatives and supervisors of
State economic groups. Accordingly, the regulations have been revised to empower
management and supervision agencies with sufficient ability for improving supervision
efficiency. Generally, the governance structure is based on the appropriate integration of CEO
and CFO. The CEO concentrates on creating and doing the business plan for development
while the CFO does the tasks of controlling the financial budget and business results.
Under current regulations for SOEs group (issued 2014), a group structure can be only
extended to up to three levels including the highest level being the parent company. The parent
company must have a charter capital of VND 10,000 billion (about US$ 480 million) of the group.
At least 50% of the subsidiaries in the SOE group must be operated within its core business, and
the parent company must control at least 60% of the capital invested to all subsidiaries of the
group (Article 4 &9, Circular No. 69 about SOE Group and SOE Corporation, 2014).
68
4.2.1. International tendency in converging to IFRS
There are three main current scenarios of converging to IFRS: (1) convergence by
applying direct IFRS (full or near-full convergence); (2) convergence by moving local GAAP
towards IFRS (partial convergence) and; (3) convergence by alignment with IFRS in
reciprocal way.
Generally, the first scenario occurs mainly in the countries where the capital market has
grown and the “true and fair view” concept is accepted as general standard for financial
reporting (Zimmermann and Werner [2013]). The CFSs are prepared and presented
absolutely (or most of the main contents) following the IFRS. Some of them have adopted
full IFRS issued by the IASB, or they have replaced a full national standard with IFRS
(Canada, Israel and South Africa are typical examples of such a scenario). Some others use
IFRS inland after they have amended their national accounting regulations so as to be
familiar with IFRS. In these countries, although their changes following IFRS do not pass
seamlessly into the national law, these changes are incorporated once in a wide range of
referential norms (ibid, [2013], p.30). At the time of study, the national standard contents are
no longer applied or aligned with IFRS in most of the regulations. Some countries in EU that
are good examples in this scenario are Germany, France, and the United Kingdom.
The second scenario happens when a local standard is improved to be close with IFRS in
an either unilateral and a mutual way, instead of applying or adopting directly. Normally, the
members support the advantages of following IFRS, but they have separate characteristics of
a capital market. Some of them do not want to share or reduce their control power in capital
market, especially in domestic market, while others do not have enough ability to apply
directly to the IFRS because of influencing tradition or economic structure. Under the
pressure from the international organizations in which these countries integrated, they choose
carefully the way of gradually moving to IFRS to face the lowest risks for their domestic
market. Consequently, the national standards are applied as the main regulations but the
contents of them have changed following IFRS, even having significant distinctions between
the existing national standards and IFRS. For the CFS sector, a number of countries in this
scenario permit IFRS for their public companies, while the local standards are also applied to
other companies. Examples of this group include Japan, China, Iceland, India, Paraguay,
Singapore, and the like.
The last scenario of convergence is that both national and international standards are
accepted in a country. Differences from two previous scenarios, in this scenario the local
standards have not been changed in order to adopt or apply to the IFRS. Relationship between
IFRS and national standards is in a reciprocal way. This likes the cooperation of equals
between them. The regulatory implementation permits the registration one or two standards,
depending on each company’s choice without any intervention from others. The United
States is a famous example in this scenario. Being one of the biggest capital markets, the US
has a significant role in the quest for global accounting convergence. While the US standards
(US GAAP) are applied to most of their listed companies, the non-US companies also accept
to use IFRS for financial reporting presentation in the US market.
69
In order to collect specific lessons for Vietnam, the study presents in details three
different cases that have similar characteristics in tradition, political as well as economic
structure. They are:
Company A
(Parent Co.)
Company E
Company B
(Produces Part N )
(Produces Part X )
Commercial
Company F Bank Company C
(Produces Part M ) (Produces Part Y )
Company G Company D
(Trading Co. ) (Produces Part Z )
70
A common type of Japanese economics is described in Figure 4.4 including the parent
company (at the top) assembling a number of subsidiary companies through mutual
stockholding around a large commercial bank. Each subsidiary has been also a huge parent
corporation (sub-parent company) with numerous another subsidiaries (grand-subsidiary) and
affiliated companies
Under parent company’s controlling, the group operates following the long-term
transactional relations (Sunder and Yamaji [1999], p. 66), while its members are the
independent firms in their own oligopolistic industries. The vital feature in the maintenance
of Japanese group style is group consciousness with a strong orientation towards
interdependence (Lowe [1990], pp.5-8). In which the group consciousness is manifested
similarly to the individual tendency in Japanese society to perceive by themselves but in
terms of group. The control power depends on direct or indirect majority share ownership and
the presence of a holding company or a dominant parent company.
71
regulations, any company listed publicly on the Stock exchange must prepare two financial
statements: one for shareholders in requirement of the Commercial Code; another for filing in
requirement of Securities and Exchange Law. Only enterprises subject to FIEA must prepare
the CFSs (Kawasaki and Sakamoto [2014]). In order to illustrate these regulations in
consolidated accounting, the study presents Figure 4.5.
Financial Statements
(Accounting profits) Finalization of accounts
General shareholders’
meeting
Formal
Regulates principles of
final accounts
* Ordinance on Financial Statements, etc.
* ASBJ Statements, Principles for CFSs, Computing taxable
Business Accounting Principle, etc. income
FIEA
Determines Return
adjustments
* Business accounting standards
Regulates Taxable
income
* Business Accounting practices
Corporation
Companies Act Tax Act
Although the Japanese CFSs have been required by Securities and Exchange Law since
1978, they had not become full consolidated reports mandatory until 1984 (Herrmann et al.
[2001], p. 1117). Initially, the Ministry of Finance did not strictly enforce the CFS (Sunder
and Yamaji [1999], p. 60) until the 1990s, and the CFSs only began to serve its active
informational function after the financial system was transformed. Then the standards–setting
institutions and the material content of accounting standards in Japan have moved closer
towards international regulations (Zimmermann and Werner [2013], p. 90).
The first changes occurred when the BADC revised a number of crucial accounting
standards in 1997. The main competence in accounting regulation shifted from Company
Law to securities legislation and the standard-setting body-the Accounting Stand Board of
Japan (ASBJ) that also apply to companies prepared under the Commercial Code. In 2001,
the Financial Accounting Standards Foundation (FASF) was established as the core
accounting for listed companies, while the ASBJ produces information-oriented accounting
standards as a private body (ibid, p. 92). In 2005, the Japanese accounting harmonization with
IFRS has been improved when the ASBJ started to make more attractive to international
investors to Japanese exchange market.
72
The enterprises that follow FIEA accounting rules are required to prepare the CFS in
accordance with Japanese Generally Accepted Accounting Standards (J-GAAP) or IFRS. In
contrast, the companies under the Company Act and the Corporation Tax Act are only
required J-GAAP. In case these companies are classified as the large companies, they are
required to follow the guideline of ASBJ or the General Accounting for SMEs. In August
2007, the ASBJ and IASB signed together “Tokyo Agreement” as the treaty on the
convergence between Japanese accounting standards and IFRS. Although Japanese
accounting standards are still applied mainly to all enterprises in domestic market, the IFRS
is also accepted for appropriate areas. In 2008, Japanese GAAP was considered as equivalent
to IFRS by the European Union (ibid, p.93). Since March 31, 2010, Japan has allowed
voluntary application of IFRS as the endeavor with the expansion to IFRS in domestic market.
However, the number of Japanese companies adapting to IFRS does not change except for
the listed companies.
73
State agency
Note: (Local government)
Controlling Interest
Business transaction Direct investment by state
owned enterprise
(xingzheng zhuguan bumen)
Company A
(Parent company -mu gongsi)
Source: Review based on Baker et al [2010], Baker et al [2009], Biondi and Zhang [2007]
Figure 4.6: Common form of State owned economic groups in China
Currently, the Chinese economic group is formed among business entities of both private
and State-owner, but the State-owned entities still dominate in significant sectors of the
economy such as petroleum, telecommunication, and automobile. Typically, some large
State-owned groups have enhancing power of competition from the government (Biondi and
Zhang [2007], p. 715). It is noted that the Chinese State-owned groups have significant
characteristics different from groups in other countries as Backer et al. [2010] presented:
State owned enterprises in China are often controlled by a State agency (xingzheng
zhuguan bumen), colloquially known as a “mother company” (mu gongsi). Each
state-owned entity typically owes a subsidiary’s duty of loyalty to a number of
administrative units [...]. The mother company may list its most profitable
subsidiaries in the capital market, while continuing to be the controlling shareholder.
Other less profitable subsidiaries may continue to be fully owned by the mother
company (p. 111).
Ironically, many Chinese State corporations are not listed in stock markets, while some
others are listed companies but their shares are also not circulating in great numbers. To
interpret this situation, Eccher and Healy [2000] assumed that the decision on listing in
exchange market of SOEs in China depends strongly on a political factor, that is the
government has the effort to balance the interests of different ministries and geographic
regions. Moreover, these State groups also have difficulty in enforcing standards for listed
companies, while Chinese government has tended to retain a majority ownership and an
interest in limiting release (p.5-28).
74
Su [2008], the Chinese accounting system attempted to do international practice beginning in
1979 when the joint ventures with foreign investment were accepted (p. 475). However, the
accounting regulations had not launched officially until 1985 when the securities market had
started operation in the domestic region. The first regulation on securities in China was
founded in 1984 by the Shanghai Municipal Government, but it only became a significant
innovation around the 1990s after the establishment of the Shanghai Stock Exchange (SHSE)
in 1990; the Shenzhen Stock Exchange (SZSE) in 1991 and the Chinese Securities
Regulatory Commission (CSRC) in 1992 (Peng et al. [2008]). Later this year, the Ministry of
Finance of China issued the Accounting System for Selected Shareholding Companies in
May 1992 (Haw et al. [2000], p. 111). In November 1992, the first conceptual accounting
Standard framework for Business Enterprises was founded. Two years later, the first
exposure draft of detail accounting standard for payables was issued in February 1994. These
regulations imposed the basic rules and did set the conceptual framework for domestic
market, but they were applied mainly to Chinese State enterprises and based on Russian –
style fund accounting system (Bao and Chow[1999], p. 88). During 1994-1996, the next
groups of exposure detail standards drafts were published, wherein the standard on
Consolidated Financial Statements and Business Combination were issued in 1995 and after
1995 respectively. Then the formal system of Chinese accounting standards became effective
for implementation since 1997. Notably, the accounting system of China in this period was
largely rule-based accounting regime which was commonly difficult for diverse companies to
produce consolidated accounting in full (Lee et al. [2013], p. 9)
In Chinese accounting regulation system, the Accounting Law was enacted by National
People’ Congress. The first Accounting Law was found in 1985 and revised in 1993 and 1999.
The Accounting Regulatory Department of Ministry of Finance has responded to set and issue
all the accounting standards, while the Chinese Institute of Certified Public Accountants
(CICPA) was formed in 1987 that controlled by MOF has qualified to engage in the auditing of
joint stock companies. Under the Accounting Law, the accounting standards are applied to
business enterprises, whereas the listed companies must disclose their accounting information
under not only these standards but also the regulation of the CSRC. Moreover, the foreign
invested enterprises need to prepare more than one financial statements: one following the
Chinese accounting system and the other based on the IASs/IFRS (Bao and Chow [1999], p.
86). In 2001, the MOF implemented a comprehensive Accounting System for Business
Enterprises (ASBEs) that replaced the Chinese Accounting Standards 1998. Especially, this
system was built in further toward convergence with the IASs (Peng et al. [2008]; Pacter and
Yuen [2001]). All enterprises including State-owned enterprises and foreign invested
enterprises are required to apply ASBEs.
It is noted that the Chinese accounting regulations were closely aligned to Tax Law and
the taxation system. All enterprises are required to prepare the financial statements that need
to be audited to calculate the annual income tax. The Tax Law and relevant regulations are
designed jointly by State Administration of Tax and the MOF (Deloitte [2014]). According to
Haw et al. [2000], the Chinese accounting regulations have restricted the accounts receivable
rate prescribed by many specific government policies (only limited percentage (3%) of
75
outstanding accounting receivable for foreign investment). It seems that they were designed
specifically to serve the government or banks, but not for the primary user or purpose of
financial statements (Nobes and Parker [2000], p. 309). Furthermore, they imposed a detail
chart of accounts as well as rules of financial reporting. Consequently, most listed companies
fulfill only the minimum disclosure requirements mandated by CSRC and seldom provide
earnings forecasts or voluntary information. The investors have little information available to
predict earning and especially no warning of bad news before it is officially released. One
discovery by Haw et al. [2000] is that we can find good news of firms earlier than bad news
on the annual financial statements of listed companies published on stock markets.
Furthermore, the accounting earnings prepared under the Chinese accounting standards are
useful for firm to valuate across different reportings of large groups (Haw et al. [2000], pp.
109,125,127).
In February 2006, the new system of Chinese Accounting standards was promulgated and
started effectively in January 2007. Generally, the existing Chinese accounting standards
have been set still not to fit with the IASs/IFRS (Ding and Su [2008], p. 475) but to have
significant converging modifications with IFRSs (ranging from 77 - 98%) (Eccher and Healy
[2000], p. 27).
In December, 2007, the Chinese Accounting Standards were identified as equivalent to
Hong Kong financial reporting standards. Since December 2010, Hong Kong Stock
Exchange has accepted the listed companies which use Chinese Accounting Standards to
prepare and present their financial reports. The Chinese Accounting Standards are now
compulsory for all entities such as State-owned companies, private companies or public
companies (Deloitte [2012], p. 29), but even the required level is different between them. For
instance, the current Chinese accounting system has two major issues: The first issue is that
related party entities are required IFRS to present financial situation, but it does not include
most of the SOEs in China, while Chinese SOEs operate no differently from other companies.
The second issue is a difference of the reversal of impairments for tangible long-term assets.
As for the CFSs, all the Chinese companies whose securities are traded in the public
market are required to apply the ASBEs, wherein the historical cost has been used to record
the business transactions among entities in business combinations. The fair value has been
also introduced in the ASBEs but the regulators in China are very reluctant to follow, because
it is so hard to determine the price in fair value in the unsophisticated market of China (Ding
and Su[2008], p. 476). Notably, the current accounting standards can utilize two accounting
methods for different forms of business combination respectively. One is the pooling of
interests for business combination under common control. Another is the purchase method
applied to the entities not under common control. Moreover, the treatment of goodwill is not
required to recognize for the case of entities under common control but it is compulsory to
recognize in case of groups not under common control. In which the goodwill is recognized
as asset without amortization, but the further test for impairment losses is conducted (Baker
et al. [2009], p.12; Biondi and Zhang [2007], p.710).
Although there are still significant variety distinctions between Chinese accounting
standards and the IAS/IFRS in the contents, this system was issued with substantial
76
convergence with IFRS. The government intervention through the changes in accounting
standards in China has contributed significantly to improve the flow of financial statements
information to equity investors (Lee et al. [2013] p. 19). Beside the domination of State’s role
in Chinese economy, China is a country that successfully adjusts and bridges the gap between
the national accounting standards and the IASs.
Notes: Notes:
1. Foundation of group based on the 1. Foundation of group based on the
control agreement “pure-bred” statutory
2. Parent Co. may have complete 2. Each member of group operates
control; as single
Source: Review based on Reich-Graefe [2005]
Figure 4.7: Form of economic groups in Germany
More than 40 years ago (in 1965), the Stock Corporation Act of Germany was enacted
directly by the German Federal Government including two specific forms of corporation
groups (ibid, p.788). One is the “contractual concern” (Vertragskonzern), and another is the
“factual concern” (faktischer Konzern). Both of them form a group with the parent company
77
and a number of subsidiary companies as presentated in Figure 4.7. The differences between
them are in their mechanism of foundation.
By the contractual concern, the economic group (or corporation group) may be controlled
completely by the controlling parent company. Although the contractual corporation group is
based on a voluntary and contractual arrangement, business activities of the subsidiaries are
influenced much by the parent company. All members of groups must consist the interests of
the entire group, while the parent does not render the subsidiary insolvency. In other words, the
subsidiary’s legal existence is protected strictly by statute.
On the contrary, the economic group under the factual concern has absence of a control
agreement, instead of a “pure-bred” statutory creation. In which the majority ownership of a
particular corporation by another company occurred, while the uniform and centralized
management structure is applied to most members of group. Each subsidiary operates as a
single entity, and the parent companies is considered as the centralize entity. Notably, in the
factual concern type, the interconnected companies are often highlighted with the multitude
of parental interferences.
78
of German Accounting Standards Board (GASB) were selected to develop recommendation
for group accounting and advise the Ministry of Justice in accounting legislation proposal and
international standardization bodies. Although the membership of GASB was fully
determined by the private sector, its standards must be approved by the State.
From the tax provision, the tax accounts were required as accounting principles by
Commercial Code and based on the commercial balance sheet. The taxable income is also
determined by the tax law. Hence, the accounting principle development has been close to the
taxation. Since 2000, improving capital market transparency and prompting legal framework
for investor have been performed following the Financial Market Promotion Acts. Then both
the Tax Law and Accounting system have been changed significantly. This leads to more
extensive differences between financial and tax accounts (Nobes and Parker [2000], p. 235).
All the listed companies are required preparing the CFSs, hence the German Code also
required the standards of formats to be used for the CFSs, while the tax-based valuations can
be retained in the consolidated accounts. The techniques of consolidation have been provided
in commercial legislation in Germany, including full consolidation, proportional
consolidation and the equity method for associated enterprises. The measurement and
recognizing any goodwill or negative goodwill are also explained as the key requirement of
consolidated accounting in the law. Especially, the Accounting Law Modernization Act
(BilMoG) of 2009 has greatly aligned German accounting laws with IFRS (Zimmermann et
al. [2010], p. 5). It is explicit that the standard of CFS has applied full the IFRS for all group
accounting.
Although many alternatives remain, Germany has achieved standardization of accounting
principles. The legal provision takes precedence over the true and fair view. The independent
concepts between commercial and tax accounts have been defined. The consolidated
techniques of CFS preparation following the IASs are accepted by German laws (Nobes and
Parker [2000], p. 245).
79
Table 4.2: Characteristics of legislation for consolidated accounting in Japan, China and Germany
Japan China Germany
Legislation Type of Key content Financial Legislation Type of Key content Financial Legislation Type of Key Financial
Sys. enterprise statements Sys. enterprise statements Sys. enterprise content statements
(FS)
Financial -Listed Co. -Ordinance on - Accounting All Co. Legislation -CFSs Stock -Listed Co. Statutory Adoption of
Instrument - Large FS Voluntary Law (by on (also Company of IFRS
and Co. -Accounting applicatio National accountant under Act corporate
Exchange Principles for n of IFRS People and CSRC) group
Act CFSs -Generally Congress) accountability -
- Financial J-GAAP Generally,
Statements China-
(Accounting GAAP
Standard
Board of
Japan- ASBJ
Company All Co. Accounting -Generally Accounting All Co. Conceptual - Accounting All Co Accounting Adoption of
Act (under (focus on standards J-GAAP system for framework , Generally, Law (including principle, IFRS
Commercial SMEs) (setting by Business accounting China- Modernization state and standards
Code) ASBJ) Enterprise standards and GAAP Act (since private (by
(by State general 2009) sector) German
Council and principle Under Accounting
MOF) Commercial Standards
Accounting Separate Accounting - Code Board),
regulation following regulation for Generally, (issued by disclosures
under industries different China- Federal FS
standards (by of Co. industries GAAP Ministry of
MOF) Justice)
Corporation All Co. Accounting -Generally Tax Law (by All Co. Accounting - Tax Law All Co Accounting -EU-
Tax Act for taxation J-GAAP State for taxation Generally, (EU- (including for GAAP
Administration China- Council) full taxation
of Tax and GAAP consolidation,
MOF) proportional
or quota
consolidation
(Source: Review based on Kawasaki and Sakamoto [2014]; Baker et al. [2009]; Biondi and Zhang [2007]; Deloitte [2014]; Peng et al [2008];
Zimmermann et al. [2010], Reich-Graefe [2005]; Nobes and Parker [2000])
80
Chapter 5: CURRENT SITUATION OF CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL
STATEMENTS PREPARATION BY ECONOMIC GROUPS IN VIETNAM
In order to present the full story of contexts and circumstances of Vietnamese CFSs, this
chapter concentrates to supply the real-world situation of CFS preparation by economic
groups. Through the preliminarily data and from the views of economic groups and
accounting professional sector, the contemporary conditions of practical side in CFS
preparation in Vietnam are explored.
81
manufacture, trade and service, 13.3% groups on only services. The groups’ industries were
various, including telecoms, transportation, gas and oil, textile, infrastructure, building,
investment of property, etc.
Normally, the parent subsidiary model (economic group) seems to be more professional
governance and equity than holding subsidiary (corporation style). In the study’s survey, it is
popular one economic group (with parent-subsidiary relation) has been able to cover with one
or more corporations as the subsidiaries. Under these corporations, there are also other direct or
indirect subsidiaries (these corporations are called the sub-parent companies in this study). For
instance: PetroVietnam group have Petrovietnam Oil Corporation (PV Oil) and Petrovietnam
Power Corporation (PV Power) as the separate subsidiaries. Under the PV Oil, there is a
significant number of Joint Stock Companies and two different subsidiaries with controlling
100% power (they are Laos PV OIL-Laos Oil and Gas Petroleum Company Ltd. and PV OIL
Singapore -Singapore International Oil Trade Company Ltd.). Under the parent or holding
company’s control, the subsidiaries are often the joint stock or limited entities. They can
operate as similar or different industries with their parent or other subsidiaries in group.
Table 5.2: Parent and subsidiary company of groups listed in stock market
Observation Observation
Criterion Criterion
Quantity Percent Quantity Percent
1. Parent Co or holding Co as listed company 2. Subsidiary as listed company
-Listed company 4 26.7 -Yes 13 86.7
-Non-listed company 11 73.3 -No 2 13.3
Total 15 100 Total 15 100
Source: Owned survey (2014-2015)
It is noted that most of the parent companies in State groups (at least in sample) were not
listed companies, but they had the sub-parent or subsidiary companies as the listed companies.
For example, Petrol-Vietnam (PVN) is one of the top tenth current big State economic groups
operating in oil and gas, the parent company of PVN (entity was surveyed) has not been listed
on the stock market, while at least two of its subsidiaries (Petrolvietnam Gas Joint Stock
Corporation - PV Gas and Petrovietnam Fertilizer and Chemicals Joint Stock Corporation -
PVFCCo) are listed companies. In the sample, the number of groups that has subsidiary
company listed on security market reaches up to over 86.7% (Table 5.2).
As for group’s structure, Table 5.3 shows most of economic groups have over 10
subsidiary companies, as many as 67 (Petrolimex group) and as few as 1, respectively.
Generally, these subsidiaries are mainly located in domestic market, whereas few of them
have been set in foreign nations. For example: Mobifone group has 4 subsidiaries in Hong
Kong, USA, Singapore, Czech; Petrolimex group has 2 subsidiaries in Singapore and Laos;
Vinacomin group has 3 subsidiaries in Laos (2 subsidiaries), Cambodia (1 subsidiary).
Among the economic groups in survey, most of them have prepared CFS by themselves
but one of them did not prepare and another did through academic service to make the CFSs.
The situation of non-making CFSs was in the foreign enterprise that has run business in
Vietnam as the role of sub-parent company rather than parent company. In fact, this company
only used its financial reports for tax accounting purpose and submitted them to its parent
company outside Vietnam.
82
Table 5.3: Characteristics of economic groups in CFS preparation
Observation Observation
Criterion Quantity Percent Criterion Quantity Percent
(in total) (in total)
1. Volume of subsidiary 4. Organize the separate group for making CFSs
- Only 1 1 6.7 - Yes 10 66.7
- From 4-5 1 6.7 - No 4 26.6
- From 5-10 4 26.6 - No information 1 6.7
- Over 10 9 60.0
Total 15 100 Total 15 100
2. Kind of FS for whole group 5. Prepare CFSs by
-CFSs 14 93.3 -Self-preparation 14 93.3
- Other(3) 1 6.7 -Hire the academic service 1 6.7
Total 15 Total 15 100
3.When does our group prepare CFSs 6. Number of staffs works for making CFSs(4)
a. The date of acquisition 2 13.3 - Only 1 3 20.0
b. The fiscal year or monthly 11 73.4 - Two staffs 6 40.0
c. Both of (a)&(b) 2 13.3 - Three staffs 1 6.7
- No information 5 33.3
Total 15 100 Total 15 100
Note: (3): case of foreign organization, wherein their FSs are prepared in purpose for local accounting tax
rather than CFSs, the CFSs of whole group are prepared by their parent Co in foreign country.
(4): case of economic group (parent company) organizes separately a department for making CFSs.
Source: Owned survey (2014-2015)
Notably, there were more than 73% groups in sample preparing their CFSs at the end of a
fiscal year or monthly, while there was only over 13% respectively at the date of acquisition.
And the same rate (over 13%) was at both time of fiscal year or monthly and date of
acquisition. Moreover, among the group of preparing CFSs in sample, there were only ten
groups that organized separate accounting staffs’ group for making CFS purpose. In which
most of them designed two staffs in this group among many others in the same accounting
department of whole group.
83
Lecturer or trainers 16 27.1 From 2 ->5 years 9 15.3
Creditor 2 3.4 From 5 ->10 years 24 40.7
Consultant 5 8.5 From 10-15 years 10 16.9
Policy maker 3 5.1 Over 15 years 13 22.0
Total 59 100.0 Total 59 100.0
3. Worked as auditor of CFSs 2. Working area relatedly to CFSs
Not yet 34 57.6 Auditing 28 47.5
Only one 1 1.7 Research &training 13 22.0
From 2->5 times 14 23.7 Consultant 5 8.4
From 5->10 times 5 8.5 Creditor of banking 2 3.4
From 10-20 times 4 6.8 Auditing & consultant 2 3.4
Over 20 times 1 1.7 Research-training & consultant 2 3.4
Total 59 100.0 Auditing, researcher-trainer & consultant 4 6.8
Officer (for making policy) 3 5.1
Total 59 100.0
Source: Owned survey (2014-2015)
For the working experience, the interviewee has the longest service of 35 years, while the
lowest was under 1 year. It is popular with 40% respondents having experience from 5 to 10
years equivalent to 24 interviewees in total sample. In which 25/59 interviews have ever
worked as auditors of CFSs (as the illustration on Table 5.4 and 5.5). In that, most of them
(14/25 auditors) have ever audited from 2 to 5 times and one of them has experienced over 20
times.
Table 5.5: Working experience and CPA ownership duration (outside economic group)
Occupation Year
under 1 1 ->2 2 ->5 5 ->10 10-15 over 15 Total
1. Working experience
Auditor 1 0 6 17 6 1 31
Researcher 0 0 0 1 0 1 2
Lecturer 0 1 2 5 1 7 16
Creditor 0 1 1 0 0 0 2
Consultant 0 0 0 1 3 1 5
Policy maker 0 0 0 0 0 3 3
Total 1 2 9 24 10 13 59
2. The length of having certified public accountant (CPA)
Auditor 5 4 10 8 2 0 29
Researcher 0 0 0 2 0 0 2
Lecturer 0 0 1 0 0 0 1
Creditor 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Consultant 0 0 0 2 0 0 2
Policy maker 0 0 0 0 3 0 3
Total 5 4 11 12 5 0 37
Source: Owned survey (2014-2015)
Moreover, some interviewees worked at not only one contemporary but also several
positions relevant to CFSs. For example, one lecturer can work as a researcher as well as
consultant instead of working only as a trainer. Additionally, not only the auditors but also
significant researchers, trainers or consultants got the certified public accountant (CPA).
Although their CPAs were only domestic power in major the total number of this was up to
62.7 % (37/59) reflecting their academic knowledge in well. In fact, in sample, there were
84
nearly 46% (or 17/37) answerers, who got CPA for over 5 years, especially 5 of them for
over 10 years.
5.2. PRIMARY DATA
5.2.1. View by economic groups
5.2.1.1. Most disadvantages of CFS preparation as current legal framework and staffs’
knowledge/skills
For the direct question: What are the obstacles to CFS preparation?, the study collected
interesting answers from group inside economic as illustrated in Table 5.6.
Table 5.6: Obstacles to CFS preparation (views of target economic groups)
Observation
Obstacles
Quantity Percent(6)
1.Legal framework 9 60.0
2.Staffs’s knowledge and skill 9 60.0
3. Accounting technique 0 0
4.Internal management policies 5 33.3
5.Characteristic of business and industrial area 8 53.3
6.Others(5) 6 40
Note: (5). characteristic of financial mechanism for business area by direct management Ministry, view of manager, etc.
(6): calculated bas on observation of multi-choice question in total number of sample inside economic group
Source: Owned survey (2014-2015)
From Table 5.6, it is found that the inconsistence of current accounting legislation and
staffs’ knowledge shortcoming are the two biggest disadvantages of Vietnamese economic
groups in CFS preparation with the same rate (60%). Especially, many answerers (40%)
claimed to face others obstacles such as the mechanism of financial management, and the
managers’ knowledge.
5.2.1.2. Most accounting staffs as poor basic specific knowledge on consolidated accounting
In Table 5.3, the data illustrates many groups in the sample (66,7%) preparing the CFSs
by themselves but Table 5.6 shows that their knowledge and skill of accounting staffs have
been a big current obstacle to CFS preparation. It is noted that most of their accounting staffs
(80%) have ever been trained in consolidated accounting. Nevertheless, their training courses
lasted a short time as updating new regulations or annual CPA program. Additionally, among
the staffs taking part in these courses, there were only few accountants (normally 2-3
persons) who are on duty in CFS preparation. Notably, their trainers were mostly auditors or
consultants from Vietnamese independent associations or professional accountancy. There
were few, even no cases in the sample when the trainers came from foreign organizations
(Table 5.7).
Moreover, the number of accountants who have the CPA was small in the sample, the study
only found one group with the staff getting temporary foreign and domestic certification
(Mobifone group) and three others with VNCPA, while the rate of groups that did not have any
CPA reached to over 70%. This is one of the reasons to explain for all the groups in the sample
having chosen the national system instead of foreign, even the current regulation encouraged
the listed companies following the IFRSs (circular No 210/2009/TT-BTC date 6/11/2009). In
fact, from the views inside economic group, the phenomenon of accounting staffs who
85
misunderstood respective accounting technique for CFS preparation was still popular, for
example: misunderstanding between the pooling and the purchase method; or the cost and
equity method; or subtotal, elimination, adjustment in full and not in full.
Table 5.7: Knowledge of accountants/staffs on consolidated accounting (views of target economic groups)
Observation Observation
Criterion Quantity Percent Criterion Quantity Percent
(Co.) (in total) (Co.) (in total)
1.Knowledge of consolidated accounting 3.Type of training
- Training 12 80.0 -Update the new regulations 9 75.0
- No training 3 20.0 - Training for CPA 1 8.3
total 15 100.0 - Others(7) 2 16.7
2.The certified Public Accountant (CPA) 4. People/ organization play the trainer
- Non 11 73.3 a. Independent association of
professional accountancy 5 33.3
- CPA 4 26.7 b. VAA 1 6.7
+VNCPA 3 c. Academic institution of MOF 1 6.7
+Foreign CPA 0 d. Foreign consultant/association 0 0
+Both 1 e. All above answers (a-> d) 3 20.0
f. other (8) 2 13.3
Note: (7).special courses that group invited directly consultant or auditors or officers to train (length of course: 2-3 days)
(8): the trainers were Vietnamese and foreign persons (followed the developing strategy of group’s plan)
Source: Owned survey (2014-2015)
86
3.Author of setting the internal regulations
-Internal auditing and accounting department 7 46.7
-Internal control department 1 6.7
-Management board of group 4 26.7
-Both of previous answers 1 6.7
-Others (NGO project, academic service, etc…) 2 13.3
4. Kind of legal framework
-Vietnamese accounting system (VAS) 15 100.0
-IASs/IFRSs 0 0.0
Note: (9): multi-choice question, the proportion was calculated base on the observation in total number of sample
Source: Own survey (2014-2015)
Under the current Vietnamese accounting regulation, both parent company and sub-parent
company must present the CFS for whole group respectively, however, the survey found that
the CFS’s position was quite different between them. Some of them organized separately
accounting department for business combination, while many of them (Table 5.3) (much in
corporation style) designed one system for both purposes of consolidated and non-
consolidated accounting.
5.2.2. View by targets outside economic group
5.2.2.1. Most current disadvantages of CFS preparation in accounting staffs’ skill
From the views outside economic group, the accounting staffs’ skill in consolidated
accounting has been the biggest current obstacle in economic groups. Although the primary
data on Table 5.9 shows almost elements of preparing the CFSs by economic groups are
evaluated as the obstacles for developing, there was nearly 100% (58/59 interviewees-biggest
portion) who agreed that the staff‘s skill about making CFSs was the problem.
Table 5.9: Obstacles to CFS preparation (views of outside economic group)
Observation
Frequency Percent (in totalsample of
(person) group outside = 59)
1. Internal regulation 48 81.4
2. Current accounting legal framework 47 79.7
3. Accounting technique 52 88.1
4. Skill of staff in making CFSs 58 98.3
5. Knowledge of manager 39 66.1
6. Infrastructures and tools 45 76.3
Source: Owned survey (2014-2015)
Quite different from the views of inside economic group (between Table 5.6 and Table 5.9),
from the views of accounting professional, the current accounting legislation is only one of
current disadvantages in CFS preparation by economic groups after the accounting technique and
internal regulation obstacles. It is noted that there are nearly 20% arguments in legal framework
by the views outside economic group than inside economic groups. Both of inside and outside
views agreed that the manager’s knowledge was also a negative point of economic groups in
Vietnam. Especially, in the views outside economic group, the ration of manager’s poor
knowledge was equal to nearly two thirds of the rate of accounting staffs respectively, while the
modernization of business infrastructure of economic group was also one significant influence on
CFS preparation with more than 76% in sample.
87
5.2.2.2. Accounting staffs’ skills at poor level in consolidated accounting
Regarding to the biggest obstacle, accounting staff’s low skill, 82.5% interviewees
commented as the reason of poor knowledge, while 70.2% and 57.9% as “accounting staffs
cannot identify the entries” and “their ability to synthesize was not well for consolidated
accounting” respectively. These numbers reflect the causes of not only staff’s knowledge but
also the academic technique for consolidated accounting.
Table 5.10: Evaluation about accounting technique and staffs’ skill and knowledge by targets outside
economic group
Observation Observation
Frequency Percent(*) Frequency Percent(*)
1. Lacking of accounting staff’s skill(a) 3. Matter of accounting technique (b)
a).Poor knowledge about CFSs 47 82.5 (1).Only simple entries for inter-transaction 35 67.3
b).Can’t identify entries 33 57.9 (2).Lack of adjustment for goodwill 33 63.5
(3).Lack of adjustment for profit by
c).Ability to synthesize not well 40 70.2 59.6
internal selling or buying 31
(4). Lack of adjustment for access the36 69.2
2. Level of accounting staff’s knowledge(c)
current value of investment
(5). Lack of adjustment for the inter-
(1). Empty the specific knowledge 5 8.5 26 50.0
transaction of dividends
(2). Low level 42 71.2
(3). Good 12 20.3
Note: (*) calculation bases on total accepted answers (excepted answers in “no information” or “miss answer”); (a): 57 total of
accepted answers; (b) 52 total of accepted answers; (c): 59 total of accepted answers
Source: Owned survey (2014-2015)
Basically, most interviewees evaluated that the accounting staffs had low level of
knowledge, and the consolidated accounting techniques of them were still simple or in lack of
academic entries for accounting on goodwill, profit, recognition of the current value as well
as inter-transaction related to dividends. In fact, there were 88.1% agreements outside
economic group for accounting techniques reason (Table 5.9).
5.2.2.3. Inadequate accounting regulation system for CFSs at present
On the side of legal framework, most interviewees in the sample thought that the current
regulation system had still not covered the practical business combination situations, while
the unique VAS was also a cause of the inadequate points in Vietnamese accounting system
Table 5.11: Details of current legal framework
Non full(a) Not matching(a) Un-clear(a) Inconsistency(a)
Frequency Percent (*) Frequency Percent(*) Frequency Percent(*) FrequencyPercent (*)
Accounting law 24 57.1 20 47.6 17 40.5 23 54.8
Accounting standard 25 56.8 24 57.1 16 38.1 5 11.9
Accounting policy 23 54.8 14 33.3 22 52.4 3 7.1
Accounting circular 29 67.4 9 20.9 19 44.2 8 18.6
Current legal frameworks(b)
Frequency Percent (*)
No multi-choice without VAS 21 43.8
Lacks of guidance for implementation 23 47.9
Still not cover the practical situations 36 75.0
Note: (*) calculation bases on total accepted answers (excepting answers as “no information” or “miss answer”);
(a)
: 42 total of accepted answers; (b): 47 total of accepted answers;
Source: Owned survey (2014-2015)
88
The detailed limitation of accounting regulation system has been provided in Table 5.11.
They included the fullness, matching, clearness and consistency. In which, accounting law
had some matters in fullness and consistency rather than two others, while the disadvantages
of VAS were located mainly in matching and fullness aspects. Both accounting policy and
circular were inappropriate in clearness point, while the fullness was also not a good feature
of most levels in legal system for consolidated accounting.
5.2.2.4. Managers’ knowledge and internal governance at low level
The primary data illustrates the managers’ knowledge about their CFSs was limited by
most of the respondents. Table 5.12 shows that many business managers or directors thought
their business could run well without the CFSs, or their business activities did not need to use
the compliable financial reports as the CFSs. In their views, this also contributes to
significant asymmetric points of internal regulation in Vietnamese economic groups.
In later part of Table 5.12, the data of economic groups with no internal regulations in the
CFS preparation is less than that of economic groups with internal regulations. But these
regulations are often intricate or inappropriate among their subsidiaries. The cases of
regulation with not credence function between subsidiaries in accounting operation of group
were 18.6%. Moreover, the contents of existing internal regulations need to be identified for
adjustment or elimination or subtotal to recognize and disclosure on the CFSs was still not
displayed well in most samples.
Table 5.12: Shortcomings of managers’ knowledge and internal governance
Observation Observation
Frequency Percent Frequency Perce
(person) (*) (person) nt (*)
1. Manager’s knowledge(a) 2. Matter of internal governance(b)
a).Running business well without CFSs 5 12.8 (1). No internal regulation 2 4.2
b.) Don’t necessary apply CFS 10 25.6 (2). Inappropriate regulation 5 10.4
c). Both (a) & (b) 24 61.5 (3). Inappropriate relation among subsidiaries 10 20.8
3. Detail of inappropriate internal regulation(c) (4). Both 1&2 1 2.1
(1). No unified regulation 4 9.1 (5). Both 2&3 20 41.7
(2). Inappropriate content 5 11.4 (6). Both 1&3 3 6.3
(3). Both 1&2 2 4.5 (7). all 1->3 7 14.6
(4). 2&3 1 2.3 4. Applying infrastructure for making CFSs (d)
(5). 1&3 10 22.7 1).Poor and drawback facility 2 4.4
(6). all 1-3 22 50.0 2).Inappropriate software 15 33.3
3). Both (1)& (2) 28 62.2
Note: (*)calculation bases on the total accepted answers (excepted answers in “no information” or “miss answer”);
(a)
: 39 total of answers;(b): 48 total of answers; (c): 32 total of answers;(d): 44 total of answers;
Source: Owned survey (2014-2015)
Typically, some interviewees mentioned that the knowledge level of both manager and
accounting staffs at the limited level had been the paternity of the disadvantage of internal
regulation in current economic groups in Vietnam. This was also reflected during the time of
survey, the study received significant declining answers with the same reason of empty
knowledge in CFSs or consolidated accounting. It is noted that some of them are auditors or
accounting lectures or accountants as shown in Table 5.10
89
Furthermore, the data in Table 5.12 also shows that both the poor or backward facilities and
limited informatics technology system applied to accounting operations were other reasons for
the current asymmetric case in CFS preparation in Vietnam.
90
Notably, the private sector normally needs to submit their CFSs to the security market,
manager boards and investors or shareholders, but the State sector must send their CFSs to
not only these three organizations but also MOF and other local government offices. For
instance: in the case of Vietnam Airline Corporation (VN Airlines), under the subordination
of MOF and Ministry of Transport (MOT), wherein MOF has supported directly financial
fund, while MOT has supported in running business or implementation, VN Airlines must
submit their CFSs to both of these ministries compulsorily; Similar to VN Airlines, under the
Ministry of Trade and Industry, Hanoi Construction Corporation-JSC (HANCORP) needs to
submit the CFSs
As an explanation for this difference between private and State groups, many respondents
agreed that the interaction of the government into State groups by subsidized capital was the
main cause. Especially, some other interviewees mentioned that most Vietnamese private
groups did not have enough business sources to create any reputation or great power in the
capital market, while the current key and big economic groups belonged to the government.
Additionally, many interviewees complained that a lot of Vietnamese economic groups
registered running business in the parent-subsidiary model, but their business activities were
so simple or without combination. With these characteristics, the State economic groups are
the tendency of sending their financial reports to get the purpose of administrative procedure
rather than satisfying investors’s requirements. In other words, the demand for CFS
preparations in Vietnam comes from the government’s interation rather than investors’ or
managers’s requirements at least at the time of this research.
Following the interviewees’ explanations in sample, there were some reasons for this existing
situation. One of them is that the CFSs need to be more specific than other kinds with 80% in 40
answers “yes”, while another is the economic groups in lack of academic staffs with 70%
respectively. Moreover, the limited knowledge of managers is also a key reason with 42.5%
91
contributing to their choice of CFSs or not CFSs to present the financial position for the whole
group.
5.3.2. Accounting measurement and recognition for investment, goodwill and NCI
5.3.2.1. Purchase method for business consolidation in regulations but quite different
implementation in economic groups
The data in Table 5.16 shows that the purchase and equity methods are main accounting
methods for investment in subsidiary and in the associates or jointly control entities on the date of
acquisition and CFS preparation respectively in Vietnam. These are also methods in the
requirements of current regulations for consolidated accounting. However, among the groups
or interviewees of sample there were significant different answers (not follow regulations).
For instance, in accounting for investment in subsidiary entities, the study still encouters the
answers in the pooling method, while it seems unacceptable in VAS; the cost method is
applied to investment accounting in associates or jointly control entities, while the VAS
requires only the equity method for this option. Moreover, the misunderstanding with
contents or when using recognitions in elimination or adjustment respectively are numerous
in the sample. Additionally, the number of answers in “No information/No answer” for
detailed consolidated accounting techniques has also been significant. This existing data
reflects that the asymmetric knowledge of interviewees in consolidated aspects is not
adequate at least in the current situation of Vietnam. It also explains for the phenomenon of
groups that did not prepare their CFSs by themselves as mentioned in previous sections.
Table 5.16: Accounting techniques for investment
Accounting technique observation
Quantity Percent
1. Accounting method for investment in subsidiary entities, on the date of acquisition
-The pooling method 3 4.1
-The purchase method 71 95.9
Total 74 100.0
2.Accounting method for investment in the associates or jointly control entities, on the date of preparing the CFSs
-The cost method 3 4.1
-The equity method 67 90.5
-Others (depends on specific investment) 1 1.4
-No information 3 4.1
Total 74 100.0
3. On the date of preparing the CFSs, the treat for received earning and profit fromthe investment in the
association and joint stock entities
-Subtotal entries 36 48.6
-Elimination in full 1 1.4
-Subtotal, elimination and adjustment 32 43.2
-No information 5 6.8
Total 74 100.0
Source: Owned survey (2014-2015)
5.3.2.2. A quite difference among economic groups in accounting for goodwill
The accounting technique for goodwill presented in Table 5.17 reveals the differences
among interviewees of sample. It seems nearly equal in the numbers of accounting for
goodwill with the NCI or without NCI, while the percentage in “amortization of historical
92
cost” as accounting method for goodwill after the date of acquisition is the highest with 81%
answers (correlating to 60/70 interviewees).
Table 5.17: Accounting techniques for goodwill
Observation
Quantity Percent
Accounting technique
(in total of
sample)
1. How account for goodwill
- Don't include the goodwill of NCI 37 50.0
- Include the goodwill of NCI 35 47.3
- No information 2 2.7
Total 74 100.0
2. Accounting methods for goodwill
-Amortization of historical cost 60 81.1
- Impairment loss 4 5.4
-Others (depends on specific goodwill) 1 1.4
-No information 9 12.2
Total 74 100.0
3. Contents disclosing for goodwill
-Long term investment 30 40.5
-Long-term assets 36 48.6
-Operating expense 2 2.7
-Others (depends on specific goodwill) 1 1.4
-No information 5 6.8
Total 74 100.0
4. Contents disclosing for bargain on purchase
-Long term investment 0 0
-Long-term assets 0 0
-Operating expense 40 54.1
-Income 2 2.7
-Others (depends on specific goodwill) 7 9.5
-No information 25 33.8
Total 74 100.0
Source: Owned survey (2014-2015)
There are 89.1% of the samples who support that economic groups have presented their
goodwill on their CFSs at the date of acquisition as the long time investment or long term
assets, whereas none of them has recorded their bargain on purchase as long term investment or
assets. Major tendency of accounting for bargain on purchase is the operating expense (54.1%),
while a low rate (2.7%) accounts for the income. Typically, the percentage of interviewees who
have considered both operating expense and income reaches 9.5%, while the percentage of “no
information” stands significantly at 33.8%.
5.3.2.3. Both methods of net value and fair value for non-controlling interest (NCI)
As for non-controlling interest accounting, the primary data in Table 5.18 shows the benchmark
method at the time of research was major answers with the rate of over 67%, while the allowance
method was only 10.8%. It is noted that the recognition of NCI following the net value of assets of
the acquire was 42/74 answers approximately 56.8% in sample, whereas there was also
nearly one – third of the interviewees who agreed the NCI was recognized following the fair
value of assets of the acquiree .
93
Table 5.18: Accounting techniques for NCI
Observation
Accounting technique
Quantity Percent (*)
1. How account for NCI
-Following the net value of assets of the acquiree 42 56.8
-Following the fair value of assets of the acquiree 24 32.4
-Others(depends on specific NCI) 1 1.4
-No information 7 9.5
Total 74 100.0
2. Accounting methods for NCI
- Benchmark method 50 67.6
-Allowance method 8 10.8
-No information 16 21.6
Total 74 100.0
3. Disclosing NCI on the CFSs
- Equity 3 4.1
-Separating criteria under equity of parent entity 53 71.6
-Separating criteria between liability and equity 11 14.9
-No information 7 9.5
Total 74 100.0
Source: Owned survey (2014-2015)
In Table 5.18, 71.6% (of the samples) presented their NCI on their CFSs as the separate
criteria in the equity of the parent entity, while nearly 15% disclosed the NCI as a separate
criterion between the liability and equity on the CFS. Moreover, the case of NCI was
recognized as part of equity (not separate into single criteria) at 4.1% beside 9.5% of the
answers in “no information”.
5.3.3. Business governance for consolidated accounting
94
(4). 1&2 1 1.4
(5). 2&3 25 33.8
(6). 1&3 5 6.8
(7). all 1-3 10 13.5
(8). No information 1 1.4
Total 74 100.0
Note: (*) calculation bases on total accepted answers (excepting answers in “no information”)
Source: Owned survey (2014-2015)
Table 5.20 shows that the internal regulation has not yet been created well. The
relationship among subsidiary entities is also a main disadvantage beside the regulation with
inappropriate points. Moreover, the rate of answers in all disadvantaged areas reached 13.5%
as another emerging drawback of internal regulations in economic groups.
Seeking detailed points of economic group’s internal regulation, the study did a survey
following several options as illustrated in Table 5.20. Wherein more than 31% answers claim that
the internal regulations are not clearly functional among subsidiary companies, no unifying
regulation in formats and significant inconsistence among specific regulations. There was 17.6%
interviewees who agreed on the inappropriate points in both functions of subsidiary and specific
regulation, while only 1.4% of sample commented on non-fullness system.
Table 5.21: Contents of internal regulations for consolidated accounting
Contents of regulations Yes for all entities Yes for separate No Total
subsidiary
Quantity Percent Quantity Percent Quantity Percent Quantity Percent
Format accounting document 62 83.8 6 8.1 6 8.1 74 100
Timeline of submit 54 73.0 14 18.9 6 8.1 74 100
Specific information for
61 82.4 6 8.1 7 9.5 74 100
accounting
Source: Owned survey (2014-2015)
The data of Table 5.21 provides the differences in forming internal regulations of
economic group. Beside the group in non-setting internal regulations for CFS preparation,
there were two types of setting: one was applied to all entities of group (including parent and
subsidiary entities); another was particular setting depending on subsidiary’s case.
In the sample, the type for all entities is major wherein the contents of regulation is over
83% in format, 73% in timeline and 82,4% in specific information. The detail of specific
95
information has related to the accounting methods in implementation for inventory, fixed
assets, or other internal transactions (such as sell products, investment, loan, etc.). In “setting
regulation separate subsidiary” answers, many interviewees explain that the economic group
should depend on the activities of business combination among entities in group to form the
appropriate internal governance. Moreover, these answers also suggest the economic groups
should base on the respective existing legislations to add the specific points in creating
regulation, instead of forming a new system. However, in the option of “setting regulation for
all entities”, most answers argued that the cause of lacking unification in internal regulation
was managers and accounting staffs with poor knowledge in CFS preparation.
5.3.3.2. Training course as main approach to improve human resource for CFS preparation
As mentioned in Section 5.2, the accounting staffs and managers’ skill and academic
knowledge about consolidated accounting is at low level. This has impacted directly on the
accounting treatments for CFS preparation. In fact, more than half the number of interviewees
in answers have used simple or lacked academic accounting entries to treat inter-transactions.
Typically, the recognitions of inter-transaction in selling or buying, or investment and goodwill
are still big current asymmetric points in the views of most interviewees.
Table 5.22: Accounting adjustments and recognitions for business combination
Accounting treatment Yes No No information Total
Quantity Percent Quantity Percent Quantity Percent Quantity Percent
(in total) (in total) (in total) (in total)
1. Only simple subtotal and elimination
45 60.8 22 29.7 7 9.5 74 100
entries for inter-transaction
2. Lack of adjustment entries for goodwill 42 56.8 25 33.7 7 9.5 74 100
3. Lack of adjustment entries for profit of
39 52.7 28 37.8 7 9.5 74 100
inter-transaction of selling or buying
4. Lack of adjustment entries for accessing
45 60.8 22 29.7 7 9.5 74 100
the current value of investment capital
5. Lack of adjustment entries for the inter-
35 47.3 32 43.2 7 9.5 74 100
transaction of dividends
Source: Owned survey (2014-2015)
96
- Short course & Specific training program 1 1.4
- All of previous answers 5 6.8
3. The way should be applied for upgrading
- Requirement option 17 23.0
- Compulsory option 47 63.5
- Both Requirement & Compulsory options 7 9.5
- No information 3 4.1
Source: Owned survey (2014-2015)
Table 5.23 shows about 90% interviewees in the sample agreed that accounting staffs
have ever been trained in updating the new regulations (82%) and specific information in
CPA’s program (6.8%), while training by consultants from the independent service is at the
small rate (only 6.8%). It is noted that there is a few economic groups that have ever
organized the course directly related to improving their accounting staffs’ knowledge in
consolidated accounting, while many of them have sent their staffs to apply the consolidated
training course under the pressure of local government’s requirement rather than doing it
voluntarily.
Moreover, the study also discloses the disadvantage of current legal system in the
Accounting Law. At the time of survey the Law of Accounting (2005) had not been yet
revised. All the comments of interviewees at that time, 2014 and 2015, concentrated on this
Law instead of its new version (issued in 12/2015). It is noted that many current regulations
under law have not yet been renewed at the time of this report, the inconsistent points among
different levels of system still have existed.
Table 5.25: Inappropriate aspects of regulation system
Observation
Quantity Percent
1. Accounting law 0 0
2. VAS 9 12.1
3. Guidance for implementation 12 16.2
97
4. Accounting law & VAS 9 12.1
5. Accounting law & guidance for implementation 5 6.8
6. VAS and guidance for implementation 5 6.8
7. All 1-3 7 9.5
8. No information 27 36.5
Total 74 100
Source: Owned survey (2014-2015)
Typically, some interviewees outside economic group claimed the staffs’ poor specific
knowledge in economic groups is an important cause of existing differences in legal
implementation. In their views, the accounting staffs do not have enough skills and
knowledge to understand and apply the current regulations (including accounting standards
and under accounting standards) rather than the existing inappropriate points of current legal
system. Although the primary data was limited in order to investigate this comment, the data
in Table 5.25 illustrated the limited information of interviewees who are considered as the
people with good knowledge of the CFSs in Vietnam with 36.8% answers in “no
information”. Additionally, this disadvantage, accounting staff’s knowledge and skill, also
reflected in data in Table 5.16-18 in Section 5.3.2. Between economic groups, for one same
business activity (goodwill or NCI), it was measured and recognized different ways, even in
one economic group the goodwill recognition was presented in both methods: amortization of
historical cost and impairment loss. This also implies that one point of regulation has been
implemented following different understanding by different practitioners in Vietnamese
economic groups.
98
Chapter 6: EXAMINATION OF FACTORS INFLUENCING CFS
PREPARATION BY ECONOMIC GROUPS IN VIETNAM
This chapter focuses on the data analysis to identify the factors influencing CFS
preparation in Vietnamese by economic groups. Before identifying factors, it is necessary to
qualify relative data resources or documents. This means a number of tests to satisfy the
assumptions of analysis models need to be conducted. These tests are presented in the first
half of this chapter. The second part presents the relationship among the factors by
evaluating their coefficient correlation in specific statistic tests of SPSS.
6.1.1. Hypothesis and Tests for normality, reliability and validity of data
As mentioned in Chapter 1, three key research questions were issued to reach the research
objectives. For each of these questions, the hypotheses were assumed to answer. This section
develops the hypothesis proposal and data analysis approach.
Hypothesis 1 (H1): All CFSs of economic groups are prepared based on current
accounting principles, standards and methods in right ways
It is no doubt that the principles (or standards or regulations) of any aspects (law, strategy,
action plan and so on) are often promulgated in order to create the balance and belief among
their relevant actors. In the case of business accounting, from the document analysis, the
trust of users depends directly on accounting regulation system (including law, standards and
regulations under standards). Therefore, with the purpose of answering the first question
(Q1: Why have many economic groups in Vietnam supplied the CFSs with the lack of trust
from the users/investors?) relevant to the trust of users for CFSs, this hypothesis is designed
to investigate the current accounting measurement and recognition for three emerging
aspects of consolidated accounting: the goodwill, NCI and investments.
Table 6.1: Survey contents in testing hypothesis 1
Main purpose of hypothesis Questionnaire or survey contents
(answering research question)
Hypothesis 1 (H1): All 1. General information:
CFSs of economic groups are Which entries does your company apply to prepare the CFSs?
prepared based on current 2. Measurement and recognition for investments (including
accounting principles, subsidiary and associates or jointly control entities)
standards and methods in right - On the date of acquisition, which measure is applied to access
ways the valued investment?
Q1: Why have many economic - On the date of preparing CFSs, what method is applied to
group in Vietnam supplied the access the valuation of investment?
CFSs with lack of trust from the - On the date of preparing CFSs, what entry is applied to
users/investors? account the valued investment?
- On the date of preparing CFSs, How treat the received
earnings and profit of investment?
99
3. Measurement and recognition for goodwill
- How account the goodwill on the date of acquisition?
- Which is the content for disclosing the goodwill on the CFSs
- Which financial reports is the goodwill disclosure?
- How account the goodwill after the date of acquisition?
4. Measurement and recognition for NCI
- How is the NCI accounted on the date of acquisition?
- How should account the NCI on the date of preparing CFSs
- How disclosure the non-controlling interest on CFSs
5. Others
- Have got any divest transaction in the group? And How
account these divestments?
- Have got other inter-group transactions? How account?
Hypothesis 2 (H2): The CFSs by economic groups are supplied in order to serve the
demand of investor rather than others
Basically, the CFSs are financial reports to present or perform the information about
financial position of a group of entities as style of single entity (IASCF [2004], IFRS 10
[2011], Zimmermann and Werner [2013]). For this function, the CFSs mainly supply
information to protect the interests of not only the internal but also external investors of
group, especially focusing on the investors (acquirers or stockholders) outside manager
board. As one stage in a cycle of accountability, the annual financial statements report the
information that starts by the budget process and ends with the tabling in reports to
parliament (Mack et al. [2004]). In this context, the CFSs provide great usefulness for any
users in effectively collecting economic group’s financial information to fit their natural
business purpose.
Table 6.2: Survey contents in testing hypothesis 2
Main purpose of hypothesis Questionnaire or survey contents
(answering research question)
Hypothesis 2 (H2): The CFSs by 1.What are the main reasons your organization of
economic groups are supplied in preparing the CFS
order to serve the demand of investor 2. Whom or What organization does your company
rather than others need to submit CFSs?
Q1: Why have many economic group
in Vietnam supplied the CFSs with
lack of trust from the users/investors?
Obviously, however, it is quite an opposite meaning between the theory and practical
aspects related to the CFS’s purpose in Vietnam. There are a lot of comments that
Vietnamese economic groups have not yet met requirements of investors (Hai Bang [2013];
Nguyen and Nguyen [2013]). Moreover, many others claim it is so difficult for investors to
access the information on the financial reports by Vietnamese enterprises (Vu [2007]). In the
same situation of financial statements in general, the CFSs are also facing the situation of not
powerful for investors. In other side, there are also few investors, who use the CFS’s
information to make decision by the CFSs, or it is the very low trust from investors for CFSs
in Vietnam (Tran [2014], p 128). It is noted that this contrastive phenomenon has occurred
not to all investors, but there are more than two concerns about this pattern, which means
having the reasonable for studying to test the trust of CFSs. This is also the cause of issuing
100
H2 to answer Q1. In which, the purpose of CFSs has been examined through the
organizations that economic groups have submitted or their motivation to prepare the CFSs.
Hypothesis 3 (H3): Most accounting staffs in economic groups have good knowledge of
consolidated accounting.
From the literature reviews, the study has found the asymmetric information between
inside and outside equity investors in many previous researches. Moreover, a significant
argument is the inadequate gap between users and suppliers of CFSs as urgent point in many
practical cases. For example: the distance between users’ understanding and using
information on the CFSs to make business decision (Nguyen [2013]); the number of
inadequate points in transparent financial information for CFS preparation by economic
groups; or the negative information (through CFSs) in the Stock market by listed companies
(Nguyen and Nguyen [2013]).It is noted that many others have also commented the
inconsistence of existing accounting regulation system as a major cause of these current
negative conditions in Vietnam (Vu [2007], Mai [2010], Pham [2014]).
In order to attest these conclusions of previous researchers, Question Two was issued:
What are the causes of negative situation or obstacles of Vietnamese economic groups in
preparing the CFSs? According to this question, there are two hypotheses assuming H3 and
H4, in which H3 concentrates on examination of accounting staff’s knowledge. Through the
views of both inside and outside interviewed groups, the accounting staffs; the knowledge
has beens evaluated following the specific points as illustrated in Table 6.3.
Table 6.3: Survey contents in testing hypothesis 3
Main purpose of hypothesis Questionnaire or survey contents
(answering research question)
Hypothesis 3 (H3): Most accounting 1. What are the obstacles of enterprises about preparing the CFSs?
staffs in economic groups have good 2. In your view, which level is accountant’s knowledge
knowledge of consolidated accounting about CFSs in the Vietnam economic group or
Q2: What are the causes of negative corporation?
situation or obstacles of Vietnamese 3. Economic group have organized the specific group for
economic groups in preparing the making CFSs? How many staffs are in this group?
CFSs?
4. How many accounting staff is CPA in the group?
5. Have got any specific training course or program for
accountant in order to prepare CFSs?
- Which kind of training courses were organized?:
- Who or which organization plays the trainer?
Hypothesis 4 (H4): The current system of VAS on CFSs is fairly fruitful in the case of
economic group, at least at the present
The H4 was issued to focus on examining the consistence of consolidated accounting
regulation system. The illustrative criteria include both direct and indirect contents following
the views of interviewees. The details of these criteria are displayed in Table 6.4.
101
Table 6.4: Survey contents in testing hypothesis 4
Main purpose of hypothesis Questionnaire or survey contents
(answering research question)
Hypothesis 3 (H3): The current 1. What are the obstacles of enterprises about preparing the CFSs?
system of VAS on CFSs is fairly 2. In your view, the Vietnamese accounting regulation
fruitful in the case of economic group, system is appropriate system forenterprises, isn’t it?
at least at the present 3. In your opinion, how to identify the parent company who
Q2: What are the causes of negative must to prepare CFSs following the Vietnamese
situation or obstacles of Vietnamese accounting regulation system?
economic groups in preparing the 4. Do you think the current Vietnamese regulation for CFSs
CFSs? need to renew?
Active flow
H5
Passive flow
Source: Owned contribution
Figure 6.1: Survey area of implementation by economic groups for CFS preparation
In the active cases (active flow), the economic groups apply the existing accounting
regulations to their CFSs preparation to fit their conditions, and they do not take the
consistence of regulations into so much consideration. Paradoxically, in the passive cases,
the economic groups are available to do their best to comply with the regulation but the
drawback or inconsistence of regulation causes them misunderstandings. This means H5 is
designed to attest the matching of accounting regulations rather than the conditions of
economic groups. The key contents for test H5 are showed in Table 6.5.
102
Table 6.5: Survey contents in testing hypothesis 5
Main purpose of hypothesis Questionnaire or survey contents
(answering research question)
Hypothesis 5 (H5): Do most of 1. Economic group prepares CFSs by yourself or hiring the
Vietnamese economic groups prepare academic service?
their CFSs by themselves in absolute 2. What legal framework does your company applies for
harmony with VAS and the current preparing CFSs?
legal framework - Why does not chose Vietnamese accounting regulation for
Q3: How do the Vietnamese economic preparing CFSs?
groups comply with VAS and legal 3. What document does your company use to prepare CFSs?
framework to prepare the CFSs? 4. What specific financial report includes into your
system of CFSs
103
6.1.1.2.1. Tests for normality and validity
In fact, the interviewees in this research come from different occupations and positions,
therefore, the serious asymmetric case of total sample could be available. This is a reason for
testing their basic information, including their occupation, experience and knowledge about
the CFSs. Following this designation, the experience of interviewee about CFSs was
investigated through their years for working, time of being an auditor, length of holding
certified public accountants (CPA), while their knowledge was measured through not only
their CPA but also their answer about CFSs and consolidated accounting techniques.
Table 6.7: Tests’ contents for normality and validity
Purpose and contents Variable Name of tests
Independent Dependent in SPSS
1.Occupation and interviewees’ knowledge
Job and having CPA Occupation Having CPA Chi-square;
Job and knowledge on accounting Occupation Answer of accounting for goodwill Somer’s d;
for goodwill or non-controlling or non-controlling interest Kendall’s
interest stau-b or
2.Experience and interviewees’ knowledge Gamma;
Experience and knowledge about Experience Answer of characteristics of Homogeneity
CFSs (years/time) CFSs of Variances;
CPA ownership duration and CPA ownership Answer of knowledge on CFSs ANOVA;
knowledge on CFSs duration Post hoc Test
Number of being auditor of CFSs Number of Answer of knowledge on CFSs and Kruskal-
and knowledge on CFSs/ being auditor and accounting for Wallis Test
accounting techniques of CFSs consolidation
Firstly, the relationship between job and respective knowledge criterion was tested.
Wherein the answers’ occupation was defined as the independent variable, others were
observed as the dependent variables. Secondly, the correlation between their experience and
others respectively was attested, in which the experience was an independent factor, and
others were the dependent ones. The mean tests for these correlations were conducted
following the pair of variables such as: job and having CPA; job and accounting for goodwill
or non-controlling interest; experience in working and knowledge about CFSs or accounting
technique; length of holding CPA and knowledge about CFSs or accounting technique; the
number of being CFS auditor and knowledge about CFSs or accounting technique.
Basically, the Chi-square test was done at first. Then depending on valuation of Sig in
Chi-square test, the study did or did not carry out extra tests of Kendall's tau-b or Gamma.
For instance, the research examined the correlation between occupation and having CPA. The
results of these tests are showed in Tables 6.8 to 6.11.
Table 6.8: Descriptive statistics of relationship between occupation and having CPA
Occupation having Certified Public Accountants (CPA) Total
No Yes
Auditor 2 29 31
Researcher 0 2 2
Lecturer 15 1 16
Creditor 2 0 2
Consultant 3 2 5
Officer (Policy maker) 0 3 3
104
Chief accountant 4 0 4
Accounting staff 9 0 9
Leader of executive board 2 0 2
Total 37 37 74
Table 6.9: Chi-Square Tests of relationship between occupation and having CPA
Value df Asymp. Sig. (2-sided)
a
Pearson Chi-Square 57.966 8 .000
Likelihood Ratio 73.543 8 .000
Linear-by-Linear
25.773 1 .000
Association
N of Valid Cases 74
a. 14 cells (77.8%) have expected count less than 5. The minimum expected count is 1.00.
Most of Sig. (2-sided) in Table 6.9., lower than 0.05 (mean α = 95%), shows that the
relationship between the job and having or not having CPA was able to occur in the sample.
However, the information at the end of Table 6.9 with “77.8% (>20%) count less than 5”
provides the mean test with Sig value in the table is not convincing. Therefore, the study had to
do Somer’s d, Kendall's tau-b or Gamma tests to reinvestigate into their relation.
Table 6.10: Directional Measures of relationship between occupation and having CPA
Value Asymp. Std. Errora Approx. Tb Approx.
Sig.
Ordinal Symmetric -.624 .067 -10.154 .000
Somers
by Job-Dependent -.782 .077 -10.154 .000
'd
Ordinal Having CPA- Dependent -.520 .062 -10.154 .000
a. Not assuming the null hypothesis.
b. Using the asymptotic standard error assuming the null hypothesis.
Table 6.11: Symmetric Measures of relationship between occupation and having CPA
Value Asymp. Std. Errora Approx. Tb Approx. Sig.
Kendall's tau-b -.637 .068 -10.154 .000
Ordinal by
Kendall's tau-c -.782 .077 -10.154 .000
Ordinal
Gamma -.829 .072 -10.154 .000
N of Valid Cases 74
a. Not assuming the null hypothesis.
b. Using the asymptotic standard error assuming the null hypothesis.
With the data from Tables 6.10 and 6.11 about most Sig value of Somer’s d, Kendall's
tau-b or tau-c; Gamma at 0.000 (the mean α nearly = 100%), the study absolutely has
evidence to provide “there are the influence of job on the getting CPA of interviewee”. In
other words, the interviewees did or didn’t have the CPA depending on their occupation and
Table 6.8 shows that the auditors normally hold the CPA rather than others.
Applying the similar tests to other pair of variables, the research found that there were
influences of occupation to the answers’ knowledge about accounting recognition and
measurement for goodwill and non-controlling interest on the date of acquisition, whereas
there was no effect between job and understanding about CFSs as well as other accounting
techniques such as: the characteristics of CFSs; the differences between CFSs and other
statements; the recognition, measurement and disclosure goodwill or non-controlling interest
105
on the date of CFS preparation. Notably, similar tendencies of these results were also found
on working experience respectively, but quite different following CPA ownership duration.
The study also found that there were no differences in doing auditor of interviewees
influencing to their answers about the recognition, measurement or disclosure of goodwill,
but they had occurred quietly in accounting for non-controlling interest on the date of
acquisition between the interviewees holding CPA and not CPA.
To create more proofs for primary data, the study continued applying other strong tests to
get expectation, especially in the case of unclear relationship among variables of features. In
fact, after testing of Chi-square, Somer’s d, Kendall's tau-b or Gamma, the study added
Homogeneity and ANOVA tests for these cases. For instance, the test’s results for
relationship between job and understanding about identifying parent company is showed as
bellows in Tables 6.12 to 6.15
Table 6.12: Descriptives
In your opinion, how to identify the parent company who must to prepare CFSs following the Vietnamese accounting regulation system?
N Mean Std. Std. Error 95%ConfidenceIntervalforMean Minimum Maximum
Deviation Lower Bound Upper Bound
Auditor 31 2.0323 1.01600 .18248 1.6596 2.4049 1.00 3.00
Researcher 2 2.0000 1.41421 1.00000 -10.7062 14.7062 1.00 3.00
Lecturer 16 2.5000 .89443 .22361 2.0234 2.9766 1.00 3.00
Creditor 2 2.0000 1.41421 1.00000 -10.7062 14.7062 1.00 3.00
Consultant 5 2.6000 .89443 .40000 1.4894 3.7106 1.00 3.00
Policy maker 3 1.6667 .57735 .33333 .2324 3.1009 1.00 2.00
Chief accountant 4 1.0000 .00000 .00000 1.0000 1.0000 1.00 1.00
Accounting staff 9 2.0000 1.00000 .33333 1.2313 2.7687 1.00 3.00
Leader of executive board 2 1.5000 .70711 .50000 -4.8531 7.8531 1.00 2.00
Total 74 2.0811 .97583 .11344 1.8550 2.3072 1.00 3.00
The data in Table 6.14 presents the results of ANOVA test with some different contents
from the Chi-square and Somer’s d, Kendall's tau-b or Gamma test. At the sig of ANOVA
test equal 0.216, it can be believed that there is no difference in identifying the parent
company between the interviewees in different jobs. This also occurred when the study
examined Dunnett t-tests by one job as a control (auditor) to compare all other groups with
mean test α = 95% (Table 6.15). However, the test of Homogeneity of Variances with the
Sig is 0.005 (< 0.05) presents that the variance of occupation in sample is not equal. It means
the result of ANOVA test has no meaning for any conclusion.
106
Table 6.15: Post Hoc Tests
Multiple Comparisons
Dependent Variable: how to identify the parent company? Dunnett t (2-sided)
(I) What is your job (J) Mean Difference Std. Sig. 95% Confidence Interval
What is (I-J) Error Lower Bound Upper Bound
your job
Researcher auditor -.03226 .69704 1.000 -1.9893 1.9248
Lecturer auditor .46774 .29411 .603 -.3580 1.2935
Creditor auditor -.03226 .69704 1.000 -1.9893 1.9248
Consultant auditor .56774 .46045 .846 -.7251 1.8605
Policy maker auditor -.36559 .57769 .997 -1.9876 1.2564
Chief accountant auditor -1.03226 .50760 .299 -2.4574 .3929
Accounting staff auditor -.03226 .36176 1.000 -1.0480 .9835
Leader of executive board auditor -.53226 .69704 .989 -2.4893 1.4248
a. Dunnett t-tests treat one group as a control, and compare all other groups against it.
To find a better evidence in this case (the sig of ANOVA test is higher than sig value of
mean test), the Kruskal-Wallis test was applied as the stronger test. The results of this test
are provided in Tables 6.16 and 6.17.
Table 6.16: Ranks of Interviewee’s Job
What is your job N Mean Rank
Auditor 31 36.63
Researcher 2 36.00
In your opinion, how to Lecturer 16 45.75
identify the parent Creditor 2 36.00
company who must to Consultant 5 47.70
prepare CFSs following
the Vietnamese Policy maker 3 28.50
accounting regulation Chief accountant 4 16.50
system? Accounting staff 9 35.83
Leader of executive board 2 25.50
Total 74
Table 6.17 shows the Sig of Kruskal-Wallis Test is 0.206 (> 0.05). This means the
answers of interviewees on identifying parent company is not dependent on their occupations.
This differs from the Chi-square and ANOVA test when the study cannot find a suitable sig
valuation for similar conclusion. It is noted that the volume of sample (74 samples)
contributed strongly to the limitation of these tests. In an other expression, the variance tests
of non-parameter for this study are more suitable than parameter tests.
With the same tests for other variables and conjunction of the results of all attests, the
study explores that there are differences among interviewees in the job, experience and their
107
knowledge of consolidated accounting. But those differences seem not so strong. Their
correlations appear as the phenomenon rather than the tendency of sample. This means the
normality and validity of data in the sample are not transgression or the primary data is
absolutely accepted for any statistical analysis of research.
6.1.1.2.1. Tests for reliability
It is no doubt that each job has different requirements about the applicants’ experiences
and knowledge or skill. In other words, there are significant differences among different
interviewees of sample as the characteristics of sample. Normally, the working experience
often correlates with the knowledge and skill. The answerers’ skill and knowledge influence
directly their evaluation for CFS preparation by economic groups. This is the reliability of
data, therefore, the relationship among the knowledge, experience of interviewees and their
respective answers is necessary to examine before being used for research conclusions. For
this reason, the hypothesis Ho was defined for testing as follows:
Ho: there are no influences of different interviewees in jobs, experience on their
evaluations about CFS preparation by economic groups.
Consequently, the matrix among job, experience and evaluations about regulation, human
ability and business characteristics were examined respectively in order to attest Ho. Each
couple of relevant variables were designed in the manner of job and experience. For example:
for job aspect, the study conducted the tests between job and evaluation about legal
framework; job and consideration about internal regulation; job and accounting technique;
job and investigation about the facility applying to accounting operation. In the side of
experience, applying the similar pair of variables as job aspect, the study also did the tests,
such as: experience and evaluation about accounting staff’s skill; experience and answering
about manager’s knowledge and others.
Table 6.18: Variable Matrix of Tests for reliability
Variable matrix Name of test in
Independent Dependent SPSS
1.Occupation and eveluation about CFS preparation
Job Knowledge or skill of accounting staffs
Legal framework
Managers’ knowledge on CFSs
Internal regulation of economic group
Accounting technique for consolidation Chi-square;
other of business characteristics (relate to CFSs) Somer’s d;
2.Experience and evaluation about CFS preparation Kendall’s stau-
Years of working Knowledge or skill of accounting staffs b or Gamma;
(years/time) Legal framework Homogeneity
Managers’ knowledge about the CFSs of Variances;
Internal regulation of economic group ANOVA;
Accounting technique for consolidation Post hoc Test
Other of business characteristics (relate to CFSs) and Kruskal-
Holding CPA Knowledge or skill of accounting staffs Wallis Test
Legal framework
Managers’ knowledge on the CFSs
Internal regulation of economic group
Accounting technique for consolidation
Other of business characteristics (relate to CFSs)
108
CPA ownership Knowledge or skill of accounting staffs
duration Legal framework
Managers’ knowledge on CFSs
Internal regulation of economic group
Accounting technique for consolidation
other of business characteristics (relate to CFSs)
Time of being auditor Knowledge or skill of accounting staffs
of CFSs Legal framework
Managers’ knowledge on CFSs
Internal regulation of economic group
Accounting technique for consolidation
other of business characteristics (relate to CFSs)
Depending on detail level of primary data, each pair of variables have different
appropriate numbers of mean tests following the growth of academic analysis. For example,
in the site of legal framework, the accounting system regulation was separated into law,
standard, policy and circular respectively. Each level of this systenm, the study did the tests
following the fullness, matching, clearness and consistency. In the limitation of pages, this
report presents only several examples of mean tests as emerging contents. The outputs in
detail of most tests were provided in the concise description as the conclusion of this section.
Using the same tests in previous paragraphs, the correlation between occupation and
evaluation about the VAS’s matching is provided in Tables 6.19 to 6.29.
Table 6.19: Case Processing Summary
Cases
Valid Missing Total
N Percent N Percent N Percent
What is your job * the content of VASs is matching 57 77.0% 17 23.0% 74 100.0%
Table 6.20: [What is your job] * [the content of VASs is matching]- Crosstabulation
Content of VASs is matching Total
yes no
Auditor 3 13 16
Researcher 1 1 2
Lecturer 12 3 15
Creditor 1 0 1
What is your job Consultant 4 1 5
Policy maker 3 0 3
Chief accountant 2 2 4
Accounting staff 4 5 9
Leader of executive board 1 1 2
Total 31 26 57
Table 6.21: Chi-Square Tests of Correlation between occupation and evaluation of the matching of VAS
Value df Asymp. Sig. (2-sided)
Pearson Chi-Square 17.255a 8 .028
Likelihood Ratio 19.665 8 .012
Linear-by-Linear Association .555 1 .456
N of Valid Cases 57
. 8 cells (66.7%) have expected count less than 5. The minimum expected count is .46.
109
Following the data in Table 6.21, the value of Sig is 0.028< 0.05 shows that the relation
between interviewees’ job and evaluation about the VAS’s matching may occur. However,
the information “8 cells (66.7%) have expected count less than 5” provides that these
statistics in Tables 6.20 and 6.21 is not significant. To give the better results, the study also
did Somer’s d, Kendall's tau-b or Gamma tests as presentated in Tables 6.22 and 6.23
Table 6.22: Directional Measures of Correlation between occupation and evaluation of the matching
of VAS
Value Asymp. Std. Errora Approx. Tb Approx. Sig.
Symmetric -.208 .122 -1.728 .084
Ordinal by What is your job Dependent -.274 .159 -1.728 .084
Somers' d
Ordinal The content of VASs is
-.168 .099 -1.728 .084
matching Dependent
a. Not assuming the null hypothesis.
b. Using the asymptotic standard error assuming the null hypothesis.
Table 6.23: Symmetric Measures of Correlation between occupation and evaluation of the matching
of VAS
Value Asymp. Std. Errora Approx. Tb Approx. Sig.
Ordinal by Kendall's tau-b -.215 .125 -1.728 .084
Ordinal Gamma -.315 .180 -1.728 .084
N of Valid Cases 57
a. Not assuming the null hypothesis.
b. Using the asymptotic standard error assuming the null hypothesis.
Most of Sig in Somer’s d, Kendall's tau-b or Gamma tests equal 0.084 means the
credibility of tests was less than 95%. For this, it cannot give the conclusion as the
evaluation among interviewees about the VAS’s matching is differences between different
jobs. However, when use ANOVA test to check again, these results are quite different as the
data shown in Tables 6.24 to 6.25.
Table 6.24: Descriptive [the content of VASs is matching] by ANOVA Test
N Mean Std. Std. 95% Confidence Interval Minimum Maximum
Deviation Error for Mean
Lower Bound Upper Bound
Auditor 16 1.8125 .40311 .10078 1.5977 2.0273 1.00 2.00
Researcher 2 1.5000 .70711 .50000 -4.8531 7.8531 1.00 2.00
Lecturer 15 1.2000 .41404 .10690 .9707 1.4293 1.00 2.00
Creditor 1 1.0000 . . . . 1.00 1.00
Consultant 5 1.2000 .44721 .20000 .6447 1.7553 1.00 2.00
Policy maker 3 1.0000 .00000 .00000 1.0000 1.0000 1.00 1.00
Chief accountant 4 1.5000 .57735 .28868 .5813 2.4187 1.00 2.00
Accounting staff 9 1.5556 .52705 .17568 1.1504 1.9607 1.00 2.00
Leader of
2 1.5000 .70711 .50000 -4.8531 7.8531 1.00 2.00
executive board
Total 57 1.4561 .50250 .06656 1.3228 1.5895 1.00 2.00
Table 6.25: Test of Homogeneity of Variances: [the content of VASs is matching], by ANOVA Test
Levene Statistic df1 df2 Sig.
2.523a 7 48 .027
110
Table 6.26: ANOVA-One Way: [the content of VASs is matching] and [job]
Sum of Squares df Mean Square F Sig.
Between Groups 4.281 8 .535 2.605 .019
Within Groups 9.860 48 .205
Total 14.140 56
Table 6.26 shows the information about the description between job and evaluation of
VAS’s matching with α = 0.05. The Test of Homogeneity of Variancesis provided in Table
6.25 to examine the deviation between variances of job and answer of VAS’s matching. Both
of these two tables present the ANOVA tests’ results by One-way. Most Sig of these tables
have been so small (less than α), whereas some of them have been transgressed. Because the
Sig on Test of Homogeneity = 0.027 means that the equal between variances of these
variables do not occurred, the ANOVA tests do not have statistics meaning. This differs
from the Chi-square and Gamma tests. Consequently, there were not any evidences for
relationship between the different job and evaluation about VAS’s matching by ANOVA
One-way tests.
Table 6.27: Levene's Test of Equality of Error Variances
Dependent Variable: the content of VASs is matching
F df1 df2 Sig.
2.550 8 48 .021
Table 6.28: ANOVA-Two Way for dependent variable: [the content of VASs is matching]
Source Type III Sum df Mean F Sig. Partial Eta Noncent. Observed
of Squares Square Squared Parameter Powerb
Corrected
4.281a 8 .535 2.605 .019 .303 20.839 .875
Model
Intercept 49.777 1 49.777 242.327 .000 .835 242.327 1.000
Q2 4.281 8 .535 2.605 .019 .303 20.839 .875
Q5 .000 0 . . . .000 .000 .
Q2 * Q5 .000 0 . . . .000 .000 .
Error 9.860 48 .205
Total 135.000 57
Corrected
14.140 56
Total
a. R Squared = .303 (Adjusted R Squared = .187)
b. Computed using alpha = .05
A comparison with ANOVA One-way, the ANOVA Two way test’s results shows the
similar tendency as numbered in Tables 6.27 and 6.28. Most sigs of ANOVA are less than
0.05 but the sig value of Levene's Test at 0.021 illustrates transgressive meaning. Once gain,
it is difficult to issue a recommendation for relationship between the job and the evaluation
about the matching of current VASs.
As mentioned in Section 6.1.1.2 (validity and normality test), in case both ANOVA and
Chi-square cannot supply the evidence for test conclusion, the study applies the non-
parameter (Kruskal-Wallis Test) to finding better information. Tables 6.29 and 6.30 present
the results of this test with the sig value at 0.031 (less than α) and the condition of data
statistic was not violated.
111
Table 6.29: Ranks of Kruskal-Wallis Test: [Job] and [the matching of VASs]
What is your job N Mean Rank
Auditor 16 39.16
Researcher 2 30.25
Lecturer 15 21.70
Creditor 1 16.00
The content of VASs is Consultant 5 21.70
matching Policy maker 3 16.00
Chief accountant 4 30.25
Accounting staff 9 31.83
Leader of executive board 2 30.25
Total 57
Table 6.30: Test Statisticsa,b by Kruskal-Wallis Test : [Job] and [the matching of VASs]
The content of VASs is matching
Chi-Square 16.953
df 8
Asymp. Sig. .031
a. Kruskal Wallis Test
b. Grouping Variable: What is your job
Putting together all the above tests for job and evaluation about VAS’s matching,
especially in the results of Kruskal Wallis Test, it can be concluded that the evaluation of
interviewees about the matching of VAS has been influenced by their occupation.
It is noted that in purpose of testing relationship between interviewees’ experience and
their evaluation about internal regulation, the study also based on the similar tests by Chi-
square, Gamma ANOVA and Kruskal Wallis Test. These tests’ results are showed by the
numbers in Tables 6.31-6.36. Most Sig values of over 0.05 present that there is no influence
between two these variables.
Table 6.31: Chi-Square Tests for Relation between experience and evaluation of internal regulations
Value df Asymp. Sig. (2-sided)
a
Pearson Chi-Square 36.883 30 .181
Likelihood Ratio 35.402 30 .228
Linear-by-Linear Association .848 1 .357
N of Valid Cases 73
a. 38 cells (90.5%) have expected count less than 5. The minimum expected count is .01.
Table 6.32: Symmetric Measures of Kendall's tau-b and Gamma for Relation between experience and
evaluation of internal regulations
Value Asymp. Std. Errora Approx. Tb Approx. Sig.
Ordinal by Kendall's tau-b .078 .102 .760 .447
Ordinal Gamma .102 .134 .760 .447
N of Valid Cases 73
a. Not assuming the null hypothesis.
b. Using the asymptotic standard error assuming the null hypothesis.
Table 6.33: Test of Homogeneity of Variances for Relation between experience and evaluation of internal
regulations
Levene Statistic df1 df2 Sig.
1.822a 3 67 .152
112
Table 6.34: ANOVA-One Way for Relation between experience and evaluation of internal regulations
Sum of df Mean F Sig.
Squares Square
Between Groups 17.010 5 3.402 1.077 .381
Within Groups 211.675 67 3.159
Total 228.685 72
Table 6.35: Tests of Between-Subjects Effects for Relation between experience and evaluation of internal
regulations
Source Type III Sum df Mean F Sig. Partial Eta Noncent. Observed
of Squares Square Squared Parameter Powerb
a
Corrected Model 30.735 9 3.415 1.087 .385 .134 9.782 .488
Intercept 178.440 1 178.440 56.791 .000 .474 56.791 1.000
Q2 27.369 8 3.421 1.089 .383 .121 8.711 .461
Q5 3.253 1 3.253 1.035 .313 .016 1.035 .171
Q2 * Q5 .000 0 . . . .000 .000 .
Error 197.950 63 3.142
Total 1503.000 73
Corrected Total 228.685 72
a. R Squared = .134 (Adjusted R Squared = .011)
b. Computed using alpha = .05
Table 6.36: Test Statisticsa,b for Relation between experience and evaluation of internal regulations
In your opinion, which points of policy of internal control is one of the
obstacles to prepare CFSs ?
Chi-Square 4.794
df 5
Asymp. Sig. .442
a. Kruskal Wallis Test
b. Grouping Variable: How long did you work that job relates to CFSs
In a similar way for testing the primary data’s liability, the study applied the same tests to
other variables. A result is that the influence by job on the interviewees’ evaluations about
the CFSs preparation is quite more common than by experience. The weight impacts (Annex
8) by job included more than 12 criterion, while by experience was only 8 variables, namely
level knowledge of accounting staff, the matter in applying infrastructure for accounting
operation, the lack of accounting techniques on goodwill and inter-transaction of dividends.
Generally, there were significant correlations between interviewees’ job and their answering
about legal framework, internal regulation, legal regulation and specific accounting
technique. However, there were no impact by different experience on the investigation about
accounting staffs’ knowledge level and internal regulation. Both jobs and experiences do not
have any influence on evaluations of the manager’s knowledge.
With the above interpretation, Ho cannot be denied nor absolutely accepted. Because
following the each details factor of analysis, there are significant influences of different
interviewees in jobs, experience to respondents’ evaluation about the CFS preparation by
economic group. The level of influence depends on the different variables of research. This
means that the evaluations by interviewee group as the manner of study in sample were
absolutely appropriate for doing research as well as further discussions.
113
6.1.2. Factor exploration
With the start by research questions, the hypotheses (H1 and H5) were assumed to look
for the appropriate answers. By the primary data, using attest these hypothesizes (accepted or
denied), the influencing factors were explored. Mainly, the factors were found relevant to the
document analysis including legal framework; accounting staffs’ skill or knowledge;
manager’s knowledge; internal regulations/policy; business characteristic. However, each
factor was also explored linking to one or more than one hypothesis.
H5
Research questions Primary data for attest:
Q1 H2 1. The main reason of preparing
Q2 – Q3 CFSs
Primary data for attest: 2. Organization of submit CFSs
H4
Evaluation about existing
accounting regulation H3
Primary data for attest:
system
1. Level of accountant’s
knowledge
2. Number of staff for group of
making CFSs
3. Number CS in group
4. Training course of program
Legal framework
Accept
H1
Deny Manager’
Accept knowledge
H2
Deny Accounting staffs’
Primary Accept skill or knowledge
H3 data
Deny
Accounting technique
Accept for consolidation
H4
Deny
Internal regulation
H5 Accept
Deny Business
characteristic
Source: Owned contribution
Figure 6.2: Mechanism for influent factor exploration of CFS preparation by primary data
114
Figure 6.2 shows that each hypothesis is correlated to a number of questions in survey.
Through the data analysis in SPSS, the tests of H1 to H5 were conducted. By the mean test
(sig values) or direct primary data, the hypothesis was accepted or denied. During the test
and seeking information to answer the questions of hypothesis, the factors were revealed.
For H1, All CFSs of economic groups are prepared based on current accounting
principles, standards and methods in right ways, the data in Tables 5.16 to 5.18 illustrate
different accounting methods for investment, goodwill and NCI between different economic
groups. For example, in the goodwill recognition, there were different ways. Many groups
presented as the long- term investment, while some others recognized as the long-term assets
or operating expense. These differences mean that H1 is denied. From interviewee’s
evaluation, the study explored the key reasons of these differences including the inconsistent
among different levels of regulations and the accounting staff with poor knowledge.
Moreover, the managers also contribute to the different accounting methods for CFS
preparation among different economic groups because most them depended on their
accountants to present their CFSs while they are also not good at accounting.
For H2, The CFSs by economic groups are supplied in order to serve the demand of
investor rather than others, Tables 5.13 and 5.14 show the major motivation of CFSs
preparation was compulsory of legislation. There were a great number of economic groups
that prepared their CFSs in order to only satisfy demand of local government offices
(auditing office, tax office, financial institute and Ministry manages directly). This means
there were appropriate evidences to deny H2. The major reasons for this situation came from
not only the different types and business industries but also the shortcomings of legal
framework or direct managers. Under the control of respective ministries (direct office of
financial subsidy or business management), the State economic groups normally submitted
their CFSs to meet the requirement of these ministries rather than investors’ interests.
Related to H3, Most accounting staffs in economic groups have good knowledge of
consolidated accounting, the study used both direct and indirect questions for finding
information to test. The number in Table 5.10 provides key results of this finding. Wherein,
more than 71% interviewees commented that the accounting staffs’ specific knowledge was
at low level. Only 20.3% of answers claimed a good level, whereas 8.5% agreed on an empty
point. Most people evaluated the accounting staffs in economic groups being not able to
make accounting for consolidated purpose. In both views inside and outside economic groups,
the lack of respective adjustments, eliminations or subtotal entries for goodwill, inter-
transaction was debated strongly. The core factors for this situation were defined by the
interviewees with the limited human ability, poor internal regulation and the complex
technique of consolidated accounting.
As for H4, The current system of VAS on CFSs is fairly fruitful in the case of economic
group (at least at the present), the study plans to prove directly the factor of legal framework
which has been found by the earlier researches. Using the direct question “In your view, the
Vietnamese accounting regulation system is appropriate system for enterprise, isn’t it?” to
interview, the study found 71.6% supporters in total sample (see Table 5.24 and 5.25). In
which, the VAS and regulation under standard commented as the highest inconsistent
115
systems of legal framework. To explain for this inconsistence, most of the interviewees
complain the current regulation system‘s contents are still far from the real cases of business
activities. Furthermore, the interpretation, accounting technique of business combination was
more complex than common accounting, which was supported by many answerers.
To re-test the influence of legal framework on CFS preparation, the study assumed the H5
for examination. It is noted that the H5, Do most of Vietnamese economic groups prepare
their CFSs by themselves in absolute harmony with VAS and the current legal framework,
was designed to focus on the passive cases. In which, the economic groups proposed that they
want and have enough all conditions to apply the existing regulations, but the asymmetric
correlations among the different regulations may push their CFS preparation into negative
situations. Following this purpose, the questions of survey were also identified respectively.
The answers to these questions are summarized in Table 5.3 and 5.11. Although most
economic groups applied the existing national regulations to their CFS preparation, the
fullness or matching or clearness or consistency of current accounting legislations have been
still not suitable. Moreover, more than 43 % interviewees commented no-multi choice
without VAS, nearly 50% and 75% answers argued the VAS are still in lack of guidance for
implementation and far from the respective practical cases. These numbers help to confirm
that the legal framework is one of now influencing factors to Vietnamese consolidated
accounting.
To sum up, six key influent factors of preparing CFS were explored. They are results of
the correlative analysis between the document and survey data. The next section focuses on
an in-depth investigation into them..
6.2. EVALUATING THE FACTORS
6.2.1. Influence by each factor
With the purpose of issuing research conclusion relevant to each factor’s condition, this
section concentrates on comparing the different views between target groups inside and
outside economic groups. The basic data for this analysis is presented in Table 6.37.
Table 6.37: Investigation of obstacles to CFS preparation by two target groups
Whole sample Group outside Group inside
Quantity Percent (a) Quantity Percent (b) Quantity Percent ©
1. Internal regulation 54 72.9 48 81.4 6 40.0
2. Accounting technique 52 70.3 52 88.1 0 0
3. Knowledge and skill of accounting staff 67 90.5 58 98.3 9 60.0
4. Knowledge of manager about CFSs 48 64.9 39 66.1 9 60.0
5. Current accounting legal framework 56 75.7 47 79.7 9 60.0
6. Characteristic of business and industrial area 53 71.6 45 76.3 8 53.3
Note :(a)calculate on the total sample (74 answers); (b) calculated on the total interviewees (59) of group outside; (c)
Generally, the key factors of CFS preparation were found by the tests of hypotheses but
the significant different views of each factor between inside and outside groups (in Table
116
6.37) need to be clear in order to drive at research objectives. Thus, the following sections
presented more details of each.
Regarding internal regulation contents, in the views inside (in Table 5.8), the internal
regulation by economic group covered most contents of consolidated accounting at high rate.
Moreover, they were formed based on the conjunction between business characteristics and
existing accounting regulations by law and under law. Wherein the accounting methods and
documents were two largest contents, the time-line for submitting or specific information for
accounting was also important point of this system. This is the reason why the answer, Both (1)
& (3), by group inside in Table 6.38 is (around 20%) more than No regulation of form to collect
information (0%). A comparing with the group outside, the rate of evaluation in “All (1)-(3)” of
group inside is only one-sixth of portion, respectively. In contrast, the number of answers in
“both (1) & (3)” by group inside is bigger than by group outside. Although there are quite
different opinions between these two groups, most interviewees agreed that the internal
regulation‘s quality was still inappropriate for consolidated accounting.
117
transaction was simple subtotal or elimination. To explain for this comment, many
interviewees, especially inside economic group, argued the inter-transaction in their groups
was not so many or complex as existing regulations. The primary data in Table 6.39 also
shows a number of this explanation.
Table 6.39: Main types of inter-transaction in economic groups (views of economic groups)
Yes No Total
Name of inter-transaction
answers % answers % answers %
1. Sale goods/productsor supply service 15 100 0 0
100 15
2. Sale fix assets 10 66.7 5 33.3
100 15
3. Loan 12 80.0 3 20.0
100 15
4. Exchange among goods/products and fix assets 6 40.0 9 60.0
100 15
5. Payment of receivables or liability (including operating expenses) 14 93.0 1 7.0
100 15
6. Distribution the earning/profits after the date of acquisition 5 33.3 10 66.7
100 15
7. Extra investment of capital into subsidiary 5 33.3 10 66.7
100 15
8. Divestment of capital 4 26.7 11 73.3
100 15
- from one subsidiary to another subsidiary (inside group) 1 - - -
- -
- from one subsidiary to entity of outside group 3 - - -
- -
Source: Owned survey (2014-2015)
Among business activities, the main inter-transactions (in Table 3.39) are in selling
goods/products or fixed assets or internal payment of receivables or liability. Only some of
economic groups in sample have the divestment of capital from subsidiary (26.7%) or extra
investment of capital into subsidiary (33.3%) or distribution the earnings/ surplus profits after
the date of acquisition.
However, when seeking further information about the specific accounting technique for
consolidation, most interviewees refused giving their answers or they answered in an unsure
manner. For example: with the question: what entries of your economic groups apply for
inter-transaction of selling goods/products, the results of survey inside economic group was
presented in Table 6.40.
Table 6.40: Main accounting entries for inter-transaction of selling goods/products (views of economic groups)
Accepted answer No information Total
Accounting entries Quantity % in quantity % in quantity % in
elimination adjustment total total total total
1. Revenues or cost of selling goods/products 8 4 12 80.0 3 20.0 15 100
2. Loss or gain from selling goods/products 5 4 9 60.0 6 40.0 15 100
3. Cost and net profit of selling goods on the first
3 7 10 66.7 5 33.3 15 100
days of accounting term
4. Income tax of earning or gain of selling goods in
4 7 11 73.3 4 26.7 15 100
the inventory at the end of accounting term
5. Income tax comes of earning or gain of selling
goods in the inventory on the first days of 3 6 9 60.0 6 40.0 15 100
accounting term
6. Gain or earning of selling goods relevant to the
3 6 9 60.0 6 40.0 15 100
non-control interest
Source: Owned survey (2014-2015)
Table 6.40 shows that among the accepting answer, the accounting entries for inter-
transaction of selling goods/products were answered in strongly confusing either the
elimination or adjustment among interviewees. With the similar question for other inter-
transactions (fix assets, loan, and payment of receivable), the study also got the same
118
situation. This reflects not only the limited accounting technique for inter-transaction but also
the lack of accounting staffs’ specific knowledge in economic groups. In this case, the
accounting technique seems to be more urgent when the inter-transactions become various or
complicated.
For the accounting staffs’ skill, among 74 interviewees, only 72 answers including 57 in
group outside and 15 in group outside accepted an interview. Generally, most people agreed
on the accounting staffs with poor skill, and a fewer number answering that the accountants
of economic group cannot define the appropriate entries for consolidated transaction.
Moreover, the comment in the ability to synthesize the financial information for CFS
preparation as not good was also supported by a large number (52%).
Table 6.42: Evaluation about accounting staffs’ skill
Whole sample Group outside Group inside
Yes No Total Yes No Yes No
(a) (a) (a) (b) (b) (c)
answers % answers % answers % answers % answers % answers % answers % (c)
1. Poor skill about CFSs 55 76.4 17 23.6 72 100.0 47 82.5 10 17.5 8 53.3 7 46.7
2. Don't identify the
43 59.7 29 40.3 72 100.0 33 57.9 24 42.1 10 66.7 5 33.3
appropriate entries
3. Lack of ability to
synthesize the 52 72.2 20 27.8 72 100.0 40 70.2 17 29.8 12 80.0 3 20
information
Note :(a) calculate on the total answers of sample (72); (b)
calculated on the total answers of group outside (57); (c)
With regard to a concrete investigation of group inside, the ability of synthesis was
considered as the biggest disadvantage with 80%, while the complaint about the accounting
119
staffs’ skill and their ability to identify the consolidated entries at poor were 66.7 % and
53.3 % respectively. Unfortunately, in the views of accounting professionals, the poor skill
also holds the highest percentage (over 82%). Next is the ability to synthesize the information,
and the lowest pattern is the ability of accounting staffs to identify the consolidated entries of
accounting.
It is noted that most answers in group inside commented the business directors with
thinking “doesn’t need to apply the CFSs”. Because, in your views, their inter-transactions
are simple and various they can use the less academic reports than CFSs to present their
position. Additionally, for State owned economic groups, they often have to present their
financial statements under the financial mechanism of national budget rather than demand of
investors. In other words, these economic groups also don’t need to prepare the CFS if these
reports are not compulsory.
Unlike the group inside, the group outside got the rate of answers in “both (1) & (2)” at the
highest. Wherein the answer in “running business well without the CFSs” was nearly 8.5% less
than the investigation “don’t need to apply CFSs”. In total, the answers agreed the knowledge
of manager as a current disadvantage of the CFS preparation by group outside (66.1%) was
more than group inside (60%).
In all samples, many interviewees as business directors or working at level of manager
thought that the differences between the CFSs and General financial statements (GFS) were
only in format or its applicants. Consequently, they do not want to choose the CFSs to present
the financial position for whole group when they are not State groups or listed companies as a
current compulsory regulation. Unfortunately the number of Vietnamese listed companies is
still so big (www.cophieu.com) that the demand for CFSs presentation in Vietnam is also
very low, at least at the present.
120
6.2.1.5. Legal framework
The data of Table 6.37 shows that the legislation was not the biggest problem in the views
of group outside, but it was quite opposite in group inside. In fact, the answers inside
economic groups argue that the current legal framework is one of two biggest obstacles to
CFS preparation (at least at the time of survey). But in group outside, most interviewees
claim legal framework is only in the second position after obstacles in accounting staffs’ skill
and knowledge. In total sample, the respondents’ investigations into legal system were
collected following three elements: law, standards and regulations under standard. Each
level’s influences are provided in data in Table 6.44.
Table 6.44: Evaluation of legal framework by two target groups
Whole sample Group outside Group inside
Quantity Percent (*) Quantity Percent (*) Quantity Percent (*)
1. Accounting law 0 0 0 0 0 0
2. VAS 9 12.1 6 10.2 3 20.0
3. Guidance for implementation 12 16.2 7 11.9 5 33.3
4. Accounting law & VAS 9 12.1 8 13.5 1 6.7
5. Accounting law & guidance for 8.5 0 0
5 6.8 5
implementation
6. VAS and guidance for implementation 5 6.8 5 8.5 0 0
7. All (1) to (3) 7 9.5 7 11.9 0 0
8. No information 27 36.5 21 35.5 6 40.0
Total 74 100 59 100 15 100
Note :(*) calculated on its frequency divide the total sample of each survey group respectively
Source: Owned survey (2014-2015)
In the opinion of group insides, the disadvantages of current legal framework for the
CFSs were strong in the VAS and guidance for implementation. Nevertheless, the
inconsistence of legal system was not only at the VAS or regulations under standards but
also all of its elements in the views of group outside. Additionally, they also mentioned the
non-fullness and non-clarity in policies or circulars’ contents (presented in Table 5.11) as the
negative points. By most investigations in both target group inside and outside, the
regulations under standards (as guidance for implementation) were evaluated as the most
urgent obstacles of current legal system, while the accounting law was not mentioned as
single level of disadvantages by any answer of sample.
121
As for accounting infrastructure, the biggest comments were in both software and facility
for CFS preparation, wherein the inappropriate content of accounting software was
considered strongly by most views in total sample. The poor or drawback feature were
investigated for facility. The rate of agreement in “both (1) & (2)” (in Table 6.45) by the
group outside was higher than the controversy “Inappropriate software for making CFSs”,
but they are in equal portion following the opinion of group inside.
Table 6.45: Different evaluation of business characteristics by two target groups
Whole sample Group outside Group inside
Quantity Percent (*) Quantity Percent (*) Quantity Percent (*)
(1).Poor and drawback facility 2 2.7 2 3.4 0 0
(2).Inappropriate software for making CFSs 19 25.7 15 25.4 4 26.7
(3). Both(1)&(2) 32 43.2 28 37.8 4 26.7
(4). No information 21 28.4 14 23.7 7 46.6
Total 74 100 59 100 15 100
Note :(*) calculated on its frequency divide the total sample of each survey group respectively
Source: Owned survey (2014-2015)
Among 15 target economic groups, there are 6 groups in private sector beside 9 groups in
State ownership. Under different capital owners, the requirement of organization in
submitting CFSs is also different. The particular authorities when submitting CFSs between
State and private sector are presented in Table 6.46.
Table 6.46: Different authorities between State and private sectors when submit CFSs
Total (15 groups) State group Private and other
Organization of (9 groups in total) (6 groups in total)
submit CFSs Quantity Percent Quantity Percent Quantity Percent
(Co.) (in total) (Co.) (in total) (Co.) (in total)
-Taxation office 3 20.0 2 13.3 1 6.7
-Security Office 6 40.0 3 20.0 3 20.0
-Statistic Office 4 26.7 3 20.0 1 6.7
-Authority office 1 6.7 1 6.7 0 0
-Financial institution 1 6.7 1 6.7 0 0
-Manager board 9 60.0 5 33.3 4 26.7
-Bank/creditors 5 33.3 3 20.0 2 13.3
-Shareholders 11 73.3 5 33.3 6 40.0
-Auditing Office 5 33.3 3 20.0 2 13.3
-Ministry of financial 7 46.7 7 46.7 0 0
-Direct Authority 8 53.3 8 53.3 0 0
Units/Ministry of
management
Source: Owned survey (2014-2015)
The respective data in Table 6.46 shows the State groups focused on supplying to taxation,
statistics, direct managers and MOF, while the private and other kinds of groups concentrated
on submitting their CFSs to security offices and shareholders. In the State group, the number
of groups sending their reports to MOF and direct management ministry are more than other
authorities. On the other hand, the shareholders, manager boards and security officers are
main agents when submitting CFSs by private and other groups.
122
6.2.2. Correlation among factors in CFS preparation
As mentioned in chapter 1 and chapter 2, the evaluation among influencing factors on the
CFSs preparation is a new point of this study. The factor analysis of SPSS was designed to
get this point. The description of key achievements in factors analysis is provided as the core
content of this section.
With the factors identified in Section 6.1.1, the correlation among them is described as a
multi-variable function- F (X). Wherein, each of six factors contributes directly to the CFS
preparation by the weight or factor score coefficient respectively. In other words, the CFS
preparation by the economic group is interdependently functional of six different factors
including internal regulation, accounting technique, skill and knowledge of accounting staffs,
knowledge of manager, legal framework and business characteristic. This is displayed as follows:
F(X) = a. A + b. B + c. C+ d. D+ e.E + f.F
Wherein:
F(X): Objective function- preparing the CFSs
a, b, c, d, e, f : weight of variable A, B, C, D, E, F respectively
A: variable of internal regulation
B: variable of accounting technique
C: variable of accounting staff’s skill and knowledge
D: variable of knowledge of manager about accounting for consolidation and the CFS
E: variable of legal framework
F: variable of business characteristic
By the primary data relevant to six exposed factors, at first the correlation matrix among
them was found as in Tables 6.47 and 6.48.
Table 6.47: Descriptive Statistics for Factor Analysis
Mean Std. Analysis
Deviation N
1. Internal regulation 1.2703 .44713 74
2. Accounting technique 1.2973 .46019 74
3. Knowledge and skill of accounting staff 1.0946 .29465 74
4. Knowledge of manager about CFSs 1.3514 .48065 74
5. Current accounting legal framework 1.2432 .43197 74
6. Characteristic of business and industrial area 1.2838 .45391 74
123
Knowledge and skill of
.219 .497 1.000 .439 .247 .206
accounting staff
Knowledge of manager
.189 .141 .439 1.000 .308 .290
about CFSs
Current accounting legal
.293 .320 .247 .308 1.000 .551
framework
Characteristic of business and
.427 .378 .206 .290 .551 1.000
industrial area
Table 6.48 shows the correlation among six factors is obvious. It is strong in relationship
between the couples: legal framework and business characteristic; internal regulation and
knowledge and skill of accounting staffs; accounting technique and knowledge and skill of
accounting staffs. In order to find the factor score coefficient among them, it is necessary to use
the test of KMO and Bartlett's Test to confirm there is or isn’t the correlation between them.
Table 6.49: KMO and Bartlett's Test
Kaiser-Meyer-Olkin Measure of Sampling Adequacy. .655
Approx. Chi-Square 112.483
Bartlett's Test of
df 15
Sphericity
Sig. .000
The value of KMO at 0.655 (> 0.5) and Sig valuation of Bartlett's Test at null (in Table
6.48) illustrates that the correlation among six factors absolutely occurred. Meanwhile there
is the weight among the correlation matrix of these six factors. Thus, the factor analysis is
continued with determination of total variance, component matrix and rotated component
matrix respectively.
Table 6.51: Total Variance Explained
Component Initial Eigenvalues Extraction Sums of Squared Rotation Sums of Squared
Loadings Loadings
Total % of Cumulative Total % of Cumulative Total % of Cumulative
Variance % Variance % Variance %
1 2.697 44.947 44.947 2.697 44.947 44.947 2.207 36.782 36.782
2 1.027 17.123 62.071 1.027 17.123 62.071 1.517 25.289 62.071
3 .948 15.795 77.865
4 .610 10.160 88.025
5 .417 6.946 94.971
6 .302 5.029 100.000
Extraction Method: Principal Component Analysis.
124
Table 6.52: Component Matrixa for Factor Analysis
Component
1 2
Internal regulation .677 -.414
Accounting technique .735 -.178
Knowledge and skill of accounting staff .633 .553
Knowledge of manager about CFSs .549 .647
Current accounting legal framework .684 -.119
Characteristic of business and industrial area .727 -.292
Extraction Method: Principal Component Analysis.
a. 2 components extracted.
Table 6.50 shows the determination is based on eigen-values. In which the eigen-values
of two in six factors (internal regulation and accounting technique) was tested at the suitable
result for analysis (>1). The data of Cumulative % presenting more than 62% of the changes
in these two factors was checked. The number in Table 6.50 also illustrates that the first of
two tested factors is strongly correlated to most others of the six factors. It is the most
relevant to accounting technique and characteristics of business with the factor loading 0.735
and 0.727 respectively. However, after the rotation of factor, the correlation among six
factors with two tested factors has changed. The strongest relevance is internal regulation
with 0.793 (in Table 6.52) instead of accounting technique with 0.735 (before rotation)
Table 6.53: Rotated Component Matrixa for Factor Analysis
Component
1 2
Internal regulation .793 .018
Accounting technique .715 .249
Knowledge and skill of accounting staff .232 .808
Knowledge of manager about CFSs .111 .841
Current accounting legal framework .640 .270
Characteristic of business and industrial area .769 .148
Extraction Method: Principal Component Analysis.
Rotation Method: Varimax with Kaiser Normalization.
a. Rotation converged in 3 iterations.
Table 6.53 provides the method of extraction and rotation in factor analysis in this study.
Varimax with Kaiser is method of factor rotation while Principal Component Analysis is
method of factor extraction.
Table 6.55: Component Score Coefficient Matrix
Component
1 2
Internal regulation .429 -.203
Accounting technique .323 .002
Knowledge and skill of accounting staff -.094 .580
125
Knowledge of manager about CFSs -.170 .640
Current accounting legal framework .276 .040
Characteristic of business and industrial area .381 -.093
Extraction Method: Principal Component Analysis.
Rotation Method: Varimax with Kaiser Normalization.
Component Scores.
Table 6.55 presents the Component Score Coefficient Matrix among six factors
respectively. Following the data of this table, the function of relationship among them to CFS
preparation was explored as bellows:
F(X) = 0.429. A + 0.323 B - 0.094 C- 0.170 D + 0.276 E + 0.381 F
Wherein, the internal accounting has the highest factor score of 0.429 while the lowest is
the factor of knowledge of accounting staff of 0.094. Notably, the factors of internal
regulation, accounting technique, legal framework and characteristic of business have
influences in the same way, while accounting staffs and managers’ knowledge has the
opposite way to CFS preparation.
126
Chapter 7: CONCLUSIONS
7.1. SUMMARY
Under the pressure created by international organizations, Vietnamese government has
effort to improve their international integration process. In accounting sector, the legislation
system has been reformed significantly since the 2000s. It was improved from the situation
without international harmonization standards (in 1990s) to the case of setting convergence
with IFRSs (at present). In fact, most of the VASs were issued during 2001-2005 following the
IASs (before 2004), but the expected achievements of this renovation have been not yet come.
For this situation, beside the cause in limiting conditions of a developing country, the gap
between the legal system and implementation by enterprises has been in strong controversy. It
is noted that in many cases, practical observation is not same as the theory (at least in this study
by data survey). In order to help find appropriate solutions for reducing this gap, this study was
conducted focusing on the CFSs preparation by economic groups in Vietnam.
The aim of this study has been to expose the distinctions between Vietnamese and
international system for consolidated accounting. Moreover, enriching the existing literature on
the few references in English about Vietnamese accounting in the researches worldwide is also
another study target.
Beginning with reference analysis, the historical and developing process of Vietnamese
accounting system and economic groups were reviewed to identify the research questions.
Then based on these questions the hypotheses (H1-H5) were issued to define the key areas
for sample survey. Through the interviews by research questionnaire, the study successfully
collected data with 74 answers in total during the period of 2014-2015. After data processing
and analysis, the picture of current situation in the CFS preparation is discovered with the
following major findings:
127
accounting reports is identified for submission. In which, according to the current regulations
(Article No.8 and No. 208 Law of Enterprise 2014), the State groups also need to submit all
of their financial statements (including the CFSs) to the statistics and taxation organizations,
while the auditing service or financial institutions received the CFSs as the requirement of
direct management unit.
Thirdly, the financial regime regulations for State-owned groups have required strictly
presentation of report type, inter-transaction and which organizations need to submit financial
reports. For instance, in a group (major State group), the inter-transaction of capital is encouraged
from the parent to subsidiaries, but the investing movement directly from the subsidiary with
extra capital to another subsidiary in lack of capital is not encouraged. Therefore, the inter-
transactions in the group were limited and simpler than the requirements of consolidated
accounting techniques. As the result of this situation, many direct managers in group still are not
interested in the CFS’s function.
Finally, compared with State-owned groups, the private groups, especially listed
companies, often face more pressure of the investors. Following this, their CFSs normally are
issued to meet requirements from stockholders or security market or directors rather than the
government authorities or taxation office. The websites or security markets are two main
channels through which the private groups publish their CFSs, while tax office or other
government authorities are only sub-organizations for their submitting purpose. It is noted
that, beside the listed companies, a great number of economic groups (including both State
and private) ignore the CFS preparation (non-preparing) or prepare them by using auditing
service (such as DucGiang Corporation).
7.2.2. Current limited capital market and small demand for CFSs
As mentioned in chapter 4, among the existing listed companies inland, there are small
numbers of economic groups, especially the State-owned groups. Compared with the number
of enterprise total in 2014 (over 373.212[8] enterprises), the rate of listed company has been
so small (around 650/373.212). This also means that the pursuance of CFS preparation from
the investors on security market has not been urgent. In an other expression, the requirement
of investor still has not enough power to become the key motivation for the CFS preparation
by economic groups in Vietnam.
Moreover, in the economic groups, the business consolidated activities are still simple
and not complex as the theoretical assumption (interviewed information). In these cases, they
have the tendency of non-CFS preparation or any financial reports for whole group if it did
not break any law. That’s why the demand for CFS preparation by Vietnamese economic
groups has been small.
7.2.3. Poor management of CFS qualify
The quality of any financial statement reflects through the quality of its financial
information presentation. It depends on the level of transparent and comparable information.
Regarding this, auditing is considered to control the financial statements’ preparation.
[8]
2014 statistic handbook, GSO (2014), p.75
128
However, it is unable to make sure whether all financial reports (including the CFS) auditing
are faithful and accrual presentations. Because most CFSs of groups must be passed by the
control of auditing service before publishing on the security market, the frauds on the CFSs
after publishing keep existing (at least by literature review). Furthermore, the current level of
knowledge and skill of accountants (accounting staff) as well as managers in Vietnam have
been at low level (primary data). The misunderstandings of recognitions between the
elimination and adjustment for business combination respectively are popular (especially in
goodwill and NCI). This means the frauds on the CFS of groups have been not reduced, even
increased in the case of complex inter-transactions (by reference analysis).
Except for the big auditing organization (Big Four Corporations), there was not any
public organization to persuade Vietnamese enterprises (consider around the domestic
market) to control the financial information quality of their statements. In the other side, there
were not many Vietnamese groups with sufficient financial resources to use the services of
Big Four Corporations for their publishing. Therefore, the matter of financial statement
quality seemingly does nt have any appreciated solutions. In this meaning, the CFSs also
have not been better.
7.2.4. Legal framework as an influencing factor but not as the most influencing
By the factor analysis (in chapter 6), the study discovered the correlation of different
influent factors to the CFS preparation as the below function:
F(X) = 0.429. A + 0.323 B - 0.094 C- 0.170 D + 0.276 E + 0.381 F
The F(X) shows that the legal framework is one important obstacle but not the most
influence to the CFS preparation (at least at the time of survey). This seems a quite opposite
conclusion with the previous researchers in the same topic. Many of them concluded the
inconsistence among different level regulation or the inappropriate points in current VAS
were the most influencing to the CFS preparation in Vietnam. In fact, there were many more
researches on legal framework than other theme relevant to the CFSs during the last two
decades in Vietnam (reference analysis). Additionally, in the views of group inside, not only
accounting regulations but also other relative existing regulations have strong direct impact
on their CFS preparation, wherein the compulsory or not compulsory is the key point of
preparing or non-preparing the CFSs. Moreover, some of interviewees in sample mentioned
the inconsistence among accounting regulations as the foremost reason of the CFS
preparation in wrong ways (interviewed information).
Unfortunately, the result of research data analysis presents that the legal framework is
only just one of three lowest factors in six influencing factors explored in the study. The
respective number of the above function –F(X) illustrates that the effect of legal factors is
stronger than two factors: accounting staffs’ and managers’ knowledge, but it weighs less
than internal regulation, accounting technique, or business characteristics. This also means
that the CFS preparation does not depend at high level on changing of accounting regulations
in the past as the thinking of both interviewees inside and outside (at least in this survey). In
other words, it can be concluded that the current inconsistence of existing regulation system
129
for consolidated accounting affected the decision of preparing or not preparing CFSs, but it is
not the biggest reason.
7.2.5. Internal regulation and business characteristics as two biggest influencing factors
Normally, the internal regulations and business characteristics are the passive factors in
the side of economic groups. Business directors often change or reset these regulations to fit
their objectives which depend on their business conditions. Obviously, these changes will
influence directly CFS preparation. However, the finding in this study (after factor analysis)
is that these factors were not only common but also the biggest influencing factors.
It is noted that under the power of director, any accounting reports can be prepared for
business transaction at the firm level. It is more realistic when these reports do not depend on
any factors from outside of firm. They only rely on the internal regulations to meet
requirements. For example, the presentation of income report (including consolidated income
report) needs the basic guidance of calculation, type of income, and period of time for report.
The internal regulation often sets up these kinds of information. The details of these
regulations depend on the business characteristics and business governance rather than the
changing of legal framework. This reflects that the internal regulation and business
characteristics factors are absolutely able to be the most influencing factors of CFS
preparation in the practical cases.
This finding implies that the more details and consistence of internal regulation, the more
advantages for CFS preparation by economic groups. It can be understood that in an
economic group with good internal regulation or infrastructure, the CFS preparation will be
fuller, clearer and more consistent than other ones (no or unsuitable internal regulation).
7.2.6. Managers and accounting staffs’ knowledge influencing paradoxically CFS preparation
The result of factor analysis in the last section of Chapter 6 shows that the skill and
knowledge of accounting staffs and manager have negative influence on CFS preparation
with the minus value of factor scores (-0.094 and – 0.17 respectively). For this minus values,
it is necessary to make clear that the factors function (of preparing CFSs) was not like the
simple or common mathematical equation. It was the result of comprehensive achievement of
many factors in business environment relevant to the CFSs. The score of CFS preparation
was observed by not only figures but also the making decisions. In which, the making
decisions was presented through the answer in “yes” or ”no” not only in acceptation of
preparing but also in the choice of legal system as well as level of accounting consolidated
requirements. Furthermore, the CFS quality has been also measured through factors of
function but it is not the objective score of study.
In case the accounting staffs or managers have good knowledge about the CFS, they tend to
make the higher system for preparing CFSs. For example, in the situation of this research, most
of the economic groups applied the national accounting system to prepare their CFSs instead of
international regulations. One of the key reasons for this tendency is the accounting staffs with
poor knowledge about the CFS preparation. Because they didn’t know or didn’t have enough
130
knowledge to comply with the other system of standards, they were mainly trained or updated
with knowledge about the national system.
7.2.7. Building frame of factor analysis in CFS preparation
Let’s return to Chapter 2 in the research method section, the factor analysis is the method
that has been not popular in accounting research (at least in Vietnam). For this meaning, the
study is one of very few initiatory researches in accounting with the frame of factor analysis
in the CFS preparation explored in Figure 2.7.
Based on the literature review, especially in theory of factor analysis, the study presented
the logical mechanism of analysis to find the influencing factors in accounting sector. This
mechanism can be applied to next researches in not only the same topic but also any themes
of evaluation of accounting quality (including quality of financial statements).
The key contribution of frame is exploratory approach for accounting research. The
conjunction between document and data analysis is main points to identify influencing factors.
In which the literature analysis often supplies the primal factors, and the results of data
analysis provide the evidences for attest of early factors and other exploratory factors. The
combination of two analysis approaches will help to expose the appreciate research
recommendations.
7.2.8. No way rather than gradually harmonizing with IFRSs
It is no doubt that under current economy, culture and society conditions, Vietnam cannot
adopt immediately all contents of IFRSs for domestic market because it can bring about
unexpected results while the current gaps between two systems and the staffs’ low level of
specific knowledge are still the big current negative points. On the other hand, the choice of
international integration cannot avoid facing the pressure from international organizations in
which Vietnam has been a member. Thus, the way of step by step to harmonize the national
with international one has been the best choice for Vietnam at the present.
The study focused on the consolidated accounting to reveal the convergence areas between
existing VAS and current IFRSs. This contributes to making clearer current situation of
Vietnamese accounting system. Through the description presented in Figure 3.7, the
harmonization process of VAS to IFRS was explored. The convergence area between them has
been increased from 2003 to 2014, whereas it seems very slow because of no reformation in
accounting standards from the first issued in 2000s. This becomes more urgent, while the
respective IFRSs have been several updated from 2004. Moreover, the IFRSs apply fair value for
all, the VASs is majority using historical cost. In this case, the study continued to make clear the
existing requirement of revising the system of VASs that was found by the previous studies.
7.3. RECOMMENDATIONS
Based on the findings, the study tries to offer some recommendations for improvement of
current situation as follows:
The first: Continuously reforming VAS and regulations under standards
131
During the survey, beside the finding factors influencing to CFS preparation, the study
also focused on finding comments for improvement. The major interviewees (81.4%)
supplied the idea renewing the existing accounting regulation as the foremost solution. In
their opinion, the promulgation of current legal system for accounting has belonged only to
the government, while many officers or policy makers have lacked academic knowledge as
well as experience of working in business. Many regulations of accounting did not cover the
reliability as illustration of primary data (in chapter 5 and 6). Moreover the non-fullness and
unclearness have occurred in all levels of current accounting legal framework. Therefore, the
reformation of content in respective level of regulation should be continued.
Concerning the CFS preparation, the idea about a separate accounting standard system for
economic groups should be also considered. However, it is necessary to pay attention to the
demand for the CFSs. Because the economic group will be not supported in the case of
limited capital market and lack of academic staffs, they will have a tendency to avoid the
complex statement (such as the CFSs) to disclose their financial position. Otherwise, the
economic groups will do significant frauds in the financial statements.
The second: Moving function of setting regulation under law to independent professional
association
With the lessons from other countries and launching a regulation in accounting sector, the
accounting professional sector should play an important role in setting the academic contents
of accounting regulation. Nevertheless, most existing accounting regulations in Vietnam are
drawn up and issued by the government. Although the professional accountancy association
can take part in the setting regulation process, this depends on the plan or organization of the
government (MOF). In fact, beside the VACPA, the DAP, department of legal affair as their
task and other officers of the MOF also help to build the VAS system but they are only as the
sub-organizations of the process.
It is noted that the promulgation of accounting regulations belonging only government
often bring the opposite benefits to enterprises because the enterprises normally run their
business following the market demand, while the government concentrates to manage the
national budget and public communication rather than market requirements. For this, the idea
of moving the role of setting regulation under law to the independent association of
professional accountancy should be considered.
The third: Setting up academic research institution and accounting professional body
This recommendation is to conduct the previous comment relevant to professional
accountancy association. At the moment, most of the accounting professional associations
(including VAA and VACPA) do not operate by self-regulated cause but still under MOF’s
controlling. Moreover, these organizations also do not have the power or its authority in other
countries, because most of their members are very old or so young persons. Many of them
lack academic knowledge in consolidated accounting. In this case, the government should
reform these organizations and establish an institution of accounting for the quality
management of accounting and auditing service in the domestic market (at least in specific
knowledge).
132
Furthermore, this institution will contribute to corporate not only in setting regulation but
also in creating the movement for accounting researches. This is important for developing
accounting harmonization with international standards and forming the academic body of
accounting sector in Vietnam.
The fourth: Preparing appropriate accounting human resource by compulsory training
According to the primary data in chapters 5 and 6, the knowledge of both accounting staffs
and managers about the CFSs is at low level. The lack of qualifications in academic managers
or accountants has occurred. Furthermore, in some cases, an accountant who was not trained in
consolidated accounting can be appointed as a staff or a chairperson of group in CFS
preparation. Hence, these people, sometimes, do not distinguish which is proper between State
administration and company management, or which is appropriate accounting measurement for
recognizing business combination activities. In several cases of State economic groups, the
accounting staffs do not have enough skill and specific knowledge to prepare the CFSs. In
order to address these situations, the training course about specific knowledge should be
compulsory for all accounting staffs. At least the basic information relevant to the CFS
preparation needs to be supplied to them. Additionally, in the long run, the accounting staffs
who are assigned with CFS preparation also need to be trained in specific programs.
The fifth: Building detail internal regulations and fit to each situation of economic group.
As the biggest factor that influences the CFS preparation (factor analysis) the internal
regulations of economic groups need to be improved. Depending on each situation of enterprise,
the content of internal regulations should be detailed or unified for all entities in the economic
group. In the author’s opinion, the more details about the accounting methods, the easier the
measurement and recognition for accounting implementation. The basic contents of internal
regulation should follow the current legal system and fit to business characteristics of enterprise.
It is possible that the accounting document forms or the type of documents, the measurement,
the recognition and accounting methods should be unified in entire group to ease data
accumulation and synthesizing information at the end of accounting term.
The sixth: Adding consolidated accounting syllabuses into graduated training program
In fact, most of the universities, colleges or financial academies in Vietnam have not yet
set any subjects or syllabus about the consolidated accounting at the level of under graduated
students. Many of them put these subjects into the advanced or post graduated program.
Unfortunately, the accounting staffs in a lot of economic groups (or common enterprises) did
only undergraduate programs. This means their backgrounds are often empty about the
consolidated accounting. Therefore, a syllabus or a main subject of specific section in
undergraduate program about this topic should do to improve the basic information for
accounting staffs and managers in the near future.
7.4. FURTHER CONSIDERATIONS AND CONCLUSIONS
Beside adding a academic reference to research worldwide, the study did make quite clear
the weight of each influencing factor to CFS preparation in Vietnam by factor analysis.
Although the primary data presented the evidences of at least six influencing factors to CFS
133
preparation by economic groups, it may be quite defective to conclude that the findings of
study are correct for all economic groups in Vietnam. With the limitations of a study, the
results should be interpreted with care because some interviewees may have a bias towards
providing non-committal answers or answers in general to the questions in the questionnaire.
Moreover, the small sample size could not cover for all. For example, the tests to show
information deeply based on the factor pair (legal framework and CFS preparation; internal
regulation and CFS preparation; and so on) is limited.
Further research in the same topic should be conducted soon, especially in the level of
influence by each factor in depth. Moreover, the CFS quality in convincing the users or the
choice of standard system to CFS preparation also should be discovered. But the topic needs
to speed up for research should be relevant to the accounting staffs’ knowledge and skill level
as urgent studies next time.
134
REFERENCES
Adhikari, A. and Emenyonu, E. N. [1997], “Accounting for Business combinations and foreign currency
translation: An empirical comparison of listed companies from develop economies”, Advances in
International Accounting, Vol. 10, pp. 45-62.
Aisbitt, S. and Evans, L. [2004], Developments in Country Studies in International Accounting-
Euroup, The New library of International Accounting, Edward Elgar Publishing,670p.
Albrigt, J. J. and Park, H. M. [2009], “Confirmatory Factor Analysis using Amos, LISREL, Mplus,
SAS/STAT CALIS”, Working Paper, The University Information Technology Services (UITS)
Center for Statistical and Mathematical Computing, Indiana University, available at
http://www.indiana.edu/~statmath/stat/all/cfa/index.html
Adil, M., Ghaswyneh, Dr. O. F. M. A. and Albkour,A. M.[2013], “Servqual and server: a review of
measures in Services Marketing Research”, Global journal of management and
businessresearchmarketing, Vol. 13, Issue 6, 2013,pp. 65-76.
Aleonard, L. [1997], Systems of Accounting in Vietnam, Accounting in the Asia-Pacific Region,
Baydoun N, Nishimura A and Willett R. (eds), Singapore: John Willey, 1997.
Alexander, D. J. A. and Jermankowicz, E. K. [2006], “A True and Fair View of the Principle/Rules
Debate”, Abacus, Vol. 42, No. 2, pp. 132-164, June, 2006.
Alsharairi, M.A. R. and Al-Abdullah, R. J. [2009], “The Reflections of the International Accounting
Harmonization on Emerging Economies: Jordan as an Example”, Economic e-Journal, Archives
of Vols, 1-2, 2009-10 06/2009. DOI: 10:2139/ssrn.1410084
Amstrong, J. S. [1967], “Derivation of Theory by Means of Factors Analysis or Tom Swift and his
Electric Factor Analysis Machine”, The American Statistician, Vol. 21, pp. 17-21.
Andersson, P., Aspenberg, K. and Kjellberg, H. [2005], “Market technologies and configuration of
market actors”, Workingpaper submitted to the 21st IM conference, Rotterdam, September, 2005.
Angel de la Fuente [2000], “Convergence across countries and regions: theory and empirics”, Working Paper
447.00, European Investment Bank Conference on Economics and Finance: Regional development policy
and convergence in the EU, 2000.
Arnold, P. J. [2012], “The Political Economy of Financial Harmonization: the East Asian Crisis and
the rise of International Accounting standards”, Journal of Accounting Organization and Society,
Vol 37 (2012), pp 361-381.
Baboukardos, D. and Rimmel, G.[2014], “Goodwill under IFRRRelevance and Disclosure in an
Unfavorable Environment”, Accounting Forum. Vol. 38 (2014), pp. 1-17. Available at:
http://dx.doi.org/10.1016/j.accfor.2013.11.001
Baker, C. R. and Barbu, E. M. [2007], “Trends in research on international accounting harmonization”,
The international Journal of Accounting, 42 (2007) 272-304. DOI: 10.1016/j.intacc.2007.06.003
Baker, C. R., Biondi, Y. and Zhang, Q. [2009], “Should Merger Accounting Reconsidered?: A Discussion
Based on the Chinese Approach to Accounting for Business Combinations”, Research Paper No.91,
the 20th Asian Pacific Conference (APC) on international accounting issues, Paris - France available at:
http://ssrn.com/abstract=1303636
Baker, C. R., Biondi, Y. and Zhang, Q. [2010], “Disharmony in international accounting standards setting:
The Chinese approach to accounting for business combinations”, Critical Perspectives on Accounting,
Vol. 21 (2010), pp. 107–117.
Baltariu, C. A and Cîrstea, A. [2012], “Harmonization of Goodwill Reporting Practice in the Consolidated
Financial Statements of Romanian Group”, Annales Universitatis Apulensis Series Oeconomica, Vol
14(2), 2012, pp. 311-319.
135
Barbu, E. [2004], “Tracing the Evolution of Research on International Accounting harmonization”,
Working Paper, No. 2004-03. Laboratoire Orléanais de Gestion - université d'Orléans.online
available at: http://www.univ-orleans.fr/log/Doc-Rech/Textes-PDF/2004-3.pdf (application/pdf)
Bao, B.H. and Chow, L. [1999], “The Usefulness of Earnings and Book Value for Equity Valuation in
Emerging Capital Markets: Evidence From Listed Companies in the People’s Republic of China”,
Journal of International Financial Management and Accounting, Vol. 10 (2), Summer, pp. 85-
104.
Bennett, B., Bradbury, M. and Prangnell, H. [2006], “Rules, Principles and Judgments in Accounting
Standards”, Abacus, Vol. 42, No. 2, 2006, pp. 189-204, Available at: doi: 10.1111/j.1468-
4497.2006.00197.x
Benston, G. J., Bromwich, M. and Wagenhofer, A.[2006], “Principle – Versus Rules-Based Accounting
standards: The FASB’s Standard Setting Strategy”, Abacus, Vol. 42, No. 2, 2006, pp. 165-
188 .Available at: doi: 10.1111/j.1468-4497.2006.00196.x
Biondi, Y. and Zhang, Q. [2007], “Accounting for the Chinese context: a comparative analysis of
international and Chinese accounting standards focusing on business combinations”, Socio-Economic
Review (2007), Vol. 5, pp. 695–724.
Bircher and Paul,[1988], ‘The Adoption of Consolidated Accounting in Great Britain”,Accounting and
Business Research, Vol.19, No.73, pp.3-13
Blonimaert, J. [1996], “Preparation and information content of consolidated financial statements”, The
European Accounting Review, Vol. 5, No. 2 (1999), pp. 383-39
Bohman, Mary and Lindsey, P. J. [1997]: “Harmonization of Environmental Policies in Agriculture
Under NAFTA” Canadian Journal of Agricultural Economics, 45 (1997):383-391
Borhani, S. A., Mehrabadi, S. G. and Daneshpajooh, A. A., [2012], “The effect of the Consolidated
Financial Statements on Decision-Making”, American Journal of Scientific Research, ISSN
1450-223X Issue 51 (2012), pp. 37-50.
Bourguigon, F. and Spadara, A.[2005], “Microsimulation as a Tool for Evaluating Redistribution
Policies”, Working paper No 2005-02, Paris –Jourdan Sciences Economiques, Alshs-00590863,
version 1-5 May 2011.
Bran (Stan), N. C., Mărgărit (Stănescu), S.G. and Eftene, N. [2011], “IASB framework regarding the
harmonization of Financial Statements”, Annals of the University of Petroşani, Economic. Vol.
11(4).2011, pp. 53-60.
Brandt, L., Ma, D. and Rawski,T. G. [2012], “From Divergence to Convergence: Re-evaluating
theHistory Behind China’s Economic Boom”, Working Papers No. 158/12, Department of
Economic History, London School of Economics, Houghton Street, London, WC2A 2AE.
BTI (Bertelsmann Stiftung’s Transformation Index) [2012], “Vietnam Country Report”, Working
Paper, Bertelsmann Stiftung, Gütersloh, pp. 1-36, available at http://www.bti-project.org.
Buch-Hansen, M., Nguyen, N. K. and Nguyen, H. A. [2013], “Paradoxes in Adaptation: Economic
Growthand Socio-Economic Differentiation. A Case Study of Mid-Central Vietnam”, Research
Paper, Springer-Verlag Berlin Heidelberg, O. Bruun and T. Casse (eds.), On the Frontiers of
Climate and Environmental Change, Environmental Science and Engineering, DOI:
10.1007/978-3-642-35804-3_2,
Bui, T. M. V.[2011], “A Study of the Development of Accounting in Vietnam”, Doctoral dissertation
(in English), School of Accounting, College of Business, RMIT University, Melbourne, August,
2011, 462p.
Bui, X. H.[2006], “Vietnamese Company Law: The Development and Corporate Governance Issues”,
Bond LawReview, Volume 18, Issue 1, 2006. http://epublications.bond. edu.au/blr
136
Bui X. H and Nuiror C., [2008], “Corporative Governance in Vietnam; A system Transaction”,
Hitotsubashi Journal of Commerce and Management, Vol. 42 (2008), pp.45-65.
Caňibano, L. and Mora, A. [2000], “Evaluating the statistical significance of “de facto” accounting
harmonization: A study of European Global Players”, European Accounting Review, Vol. 9. No. 3,
pp. 349-370.
Černá, A. [2012], “Economic and social harmonization of sustainable public transport”, Prague
Economic Paper,Vol 1, (2012),pp. 83-100, Available at
https://www.vse.cz/polek/download.php?jnl=pep&pdf=412.pdf
Cîrstea, A. and Baltariu, A. C. [2014], “Convergence of consolidated financial statements regulations: are
we there yet?”, Procedia Economics and Finance, Vol.5 (2014), pp. 1297-1303.
Chaponnière, J. R. and Cling, J. P. [2009], “Vietnam’s Export-Led growth model and Competition
with China”, International Economic: (Économie international) 118(2009), pp. 101-130.
Childs, W. H. [1949], Consolidated Financial Statement: Principles and Procedure, New York. NY:
Cornell University Press.
Choi, F. D. S. and Hiramatsu, K.[1987], Accounting and Financial Reporting in Japan, Van Nostrand
Reinhold (UK) Co.Ltd.
Christoper, W. R.[2011], “Small Medium Enterprise (SME) in Vietnam”, Working paper, Business-
in- Asia.com, http://www.business-in-asia.com/vietnam/sme_in_vietnam.html
Chu, T.[2004], “Accounting changes in a transition economy: the case of Vietnam”, Doctoral
dissertation, University of Wollongong, May, 2004, Available at http://ro.uow.edu.au/thesis/1903.
Chuc, A. T. [2008], “The New Regulation for Preparing Consolidated Financial Statements”, (in
Vietnamese: Quy định mới về phương pháp lập báo cáo tài chính hợp nhất”, Vietnam Auditing
Review, Vol. 72(2008), pp. 43-45.
Chuc, A. T.[2009], “The most basic contents of income taxation in enterprises”, (in
Vietnamese:NHững vấn đề cơ bản nhất về thuế thu nhập doanh nghiệp”, Vietnam Auditing
Review,Vol. 10/2009, Available at http://www.webketoan.vn/trangchu/vn/tin-tuc/ke-toan-tai-
chinh/nhung-van-de-co-ban-nhat-ve-thue-thu-nhap-doanh-nghiep/530/1
CIEM (Centre Institute for Economic Management) [undated], “The Vietnamese economic group-
status and developing perspective” (in Vietnamese: Tập đoàn kinh tế Việt Nam-hiện trạng và xu
hướng phát triển), Research Paper, available
at:www.vnep.org.vn/Modeles/CMS/Upload/6/Tap%20Doan%20Kinh%20Te-%20tung.pdfogg
CIEM., DoE., ILSSA.and UNU-WIDER. [2012], Characteristics of the Vietnamese Business
Environment: Evidence from a SME survey in 2011, Labour and Social Publisher, November,
2012
Collins, D. L., Pasewark, W. R. and Riley, M. E.[2012], “Financial Reporting Outcomes under Rules-
Based and Principles-Based Accounting Standards”, Accounting Horizons, Vol. 26, No. 4, 2012,
pp. 681–705
Costello, A. B. and Osbome, J. W. [2005], “Best Practices in Exploratory Factor Analysis: Four
Recommendation for Getting the Most From Your Analysis”, Practical Assessment Research and
Evaluation, Vol. 10 No. 7, July 2005, ISSN 1531-7714.
Cronin, J. J. and Talor, S. A. [1992], “Measuring Service Quality: A Re-examination and Extension”,
Journal of Marketing, July, 1992. Vol. 56 (3),pp. 55-68.
Dang, N. H.[2009], “The must to reject inter-transactions of selling in preparing consolidated
financial statements”, (in Vietnamese: Sự cần thiết phải loại trừ các giao dịch bán hang nội bộ khi
lập báo cáo tài chính hợp nhất), Journal of Auditing Science, Vol. 5/2009. Available at:
http://www.khoahockiemtoan.vn/Category.aspx?newsID=212
137
Dang, T. T. H and Pham Q. [2015], “Impact of Financial Statements on the decision of investors in
Stocked Market in Vietnam”, (in Vietnamese: Ảnh hưởng của báo cáo tài chính đến quyết định
của nhà đầu tư trên thị trường chứng khoán Việt Nam), Accounting and Auditing Reviews, Vol. 10
(2015), pp. 11-13.
Day.R., and Sparos, J. [1996], “A study of Accountant’s adjustment with respect to the provision of
Conolidated Financial Statements”, Abacus, Vol.32, No. 1 (1996), pp. 62-80.
DeCoster, J. [1998], Overview of Factor Analysis, Available at: http://www.stat-help.com/notes.html
Deloitte, [2012], IFRSs in your Pocket, 2012. Available at: www.iasplus.com
Deloitte, [2014], China Taxation and Investment 2014. A publication of Deloitte Touche Tohmatsu
Limited. Available at www2.deloitte.com/content/dam/.../Tax/dttl-tax-chinaguide-2014.pdf
DAP (Department of Accounting Policy), [2001], “Theoretical framework of Vietnam Accounting
Standards”, Research Paper, Project under the Vietnamese Ministry of Finance. Director by
Phung Thi Doan, No. 2000-98-027, May, 2001.
Dell, M., Lane N. and Querubin, P. [2015], “State Capacity, Local Governance, and
EconomicDevelopment in Vietnam”, Workingpaper, Harvard and NBER, IIES, and NYU, March
2015.
Dinh, T. T. [2008], “The Sense of Big Enterprise in Vietnam” (in Vietnamese: Một số nét về doanh
nghiệp lớn ở Việt Nam), Vietnam Economic Management Review (VEMR), Vol. 20 (5+8/2008),
pp. 70-75.
Dinh, X. L., Nguyen, V. K. and Nguyen, D. L. [2000]. General Vietnamese History, (in Vietnamese:
Đại Cương Lịch Sử Việt Nam), Education Publisher House, Hanoi, Vietnam.
Ding, Y. and Su, X. [2008], “Implementation of IFRS in a regulated market”, Journal of Accounting
and Public police, Vol. 27 (2008), pp. 474-479.DOI: 10.1016/j.jaccpubpol.2008.09.005.
Doan, N. P. A. [2012], “The Adoption of Western Management Accounting Practice In Vietnamese
Enterprises during Economic Transaction”, Doctoral dissertation, Department of Accounting,
Finance and Economics, Griffith Business School, Griffith University.
Doan, T. D.[2012], “Consolidated Financial Statements-Theory, Practice and Recommendation for
Hoang Ha group, Vietnam”, (in Vietnamese: Báo cáo tài chính hợp nhất-những vấn đề lý luận,
thực trạng và giải pháp cho tập đoàn kinh tế Hoàng Hà),Doctoral dissertation, Academy of
Finance, No. 62.34.30.01.
Doan, T. H. N. [2015], “Measurement and Presentation of Goodwill on Consolidated financial
Statements under VAS 11- the negative point for enterprises”, (in Vietnamese: Xác định lợi thế
thương mại trong báo cáo tài chính hợp nhất theo VAS 11 những vướng mắc khi áp dụng tại
doanh nghiệp), Accounting and Auditing Review, Vol. 1+2 (2015), pp. 45-47.
Doan, X. T [2010], “Vietnamese Accounting Standards- the necessary improvement continuously for
negative points”, (Hệ thống chuẩn mực kế toán Việt nam-Những bất cập cần tiếp tục hoàn thiện),
Auditing Review, Vol. 12/2010, available at: http://www.kiemtoannn,gov.vn
Doan, X. T., Nguyen, V. L., Truong, T. T., Luu, D. T., Nguyen, T. H.V., Nguyen D. T. and Trinh, D.
V. [2004], “Research the model of accounting system for State Corporation following the parent-
subsidiary companies structure in Vietnam”, (in Vietnamese: Xây dựng mô hình tổ chức công tác
kế toán doanh nghiệp theo loại hình công ty mẹ, công ty con ở Việt Nam), ResearchPaper,Project
under Academic of Finance, Funded by Ministry of Finance, 2004, pp. 1-128.
Eccher, E. and Healy, P. M. [2000], ‘The Role of International Accounting Standards in Transitional
Economies: A study of the People’s Republic of China”, Working paper, available at
http://papers.ssrn.com/paper.taf?abstract _id=233598
138
Edwards, J. R.[1991], “The Process of Accounting Innovation: The Publication of Consolidated Accounts
in Britain in 1910”, Accounting Historians Journal. Vol.18, No.2, pp.113-132
Emenyonui, E. N. O. [1993], “International Accounting Harmonisation in Developed StockMarket
Countries: An Empirical Comparative Study of Measurementand Associated Disclosure Practices
in France, Germany, Japan, United Kingdom, and the United States of America”, Doctoral
Dissertation, Department of Accounting and Finance. Faculty of Law and Financial Studies of the
University of Glasgow in Fulfilme.
Epstein, B. J. and Jermakowicz, E. K. [2010], “Interpretation and Application of International
Financial Reporting Standards”, Published by John Willey & Sons, Inc., Hoboken, New Jersey,
2010.
Estrades, C.[2013], “Guide to Micro-simulations Linked to CGE Models: How to Introduce Analysis
of Poverty and Income Distribution in CGE-based Studies”, AGRODEP technical Note TN-09,
May 2013
Fabrigar, L. R., Wegener, D. T., MacCallum, R. C. and Strahan, E. J. [1999], “Evaluating the use of
exploratory factor analysis in psychological research”, Psychology Methods, Vol. 4, No. 3, pp.
272-299.
Ferdy van Beest [2009], “Rules-Based and Principles-Based Accounting Standards and Earnings
Management”, NiCE (Nijmegen Center for Economics), Working Paper 09-114, Institute for
Management Research, Radboud University Nijmegen, December 2009.
Frey, B. S. and Eichenberger, R.[1996], “To harmonization or to complete? That’s not the question”,
Journal of Public Economic, Vol. 60, No. 9 (1996), pp. 335-349. SSDI 0047-2727(95) 01555-8
Friedrich-Eckey, H. and Tűrck, M. [2007], “Convergence of EU-Regions: A literature Report”.
Investigaciones Regionales, núm. 10, primavera, 2007, pp. 5-32. Asociación Espaňola de Ciencia
Regional Espaňa. ISSN: 1695-7253.
Fritz, S. and Lämmle, C. [2003], “The international harmonization process of Accounting
Standards.International Master Program Strategy and Culture”. Working paper. Economiska
Institutionen 58183 linköping, Available at:
http://www.ep.liu.se/exjobb/eki/2003/jek/2003.Date20/1/2003
Gabriele A., [2005], “Strategic Service Polices and International Trade Integration in Vietnam”,
Journal of Economic Integration, Vol. 20 (2), June 2005; pp. 263-293.
Gardini,S. and Grossi, G. [2014], “Voluntary adoption of the Consolidated Financial Statement and fair value
accounting by Italian local governments”, Journal of Public Budgeting, Accounting and Financial
management, Vol. 26 (2), pp. 313-344.
Gassmann, O and Enkel, E.[2004], “Towards a Theory of Open Innovation: Three Core Process
Archetypes”,Research paper, R&D Management Conference (RADMA), July, 2004.
Godin, B.[2005], “The linear Model of Innovation: The historical Construction of an Analytical
Framework”, Project on the History and Sociology of S&T Statistics. Working paper No. 30, 2005.
Godin, B.[2013], “Invention, Diffusion and Linear Models of Innovation”, Project on the Intellectual
History of Innovation, Working paper No. 15, 2013.
Gomez, F. and Ganuza, J. J. [2011], “An economic analysis of harmonization regimes: full
harmonization, minimum harmonization or optional instruments?”, European Review of Contract
Law. Vol 7 (2), 2011, pp. 275-294. ISSN (print): 1614-9920. ISSN (online): 1614-9939. DOI:
10.1515/ercl.2011.275.
GSO (General Statistic Office) [2012], “Report on the result of survey the firm number in 2012”, Online Paper,
June 2012. Available at http://www.gso.gov.vn/default.aspx?tabid=382&idmid=2&ItemID=12481
139
GSO (General Statistic Office)[2014], Statistical Handbook of Vietnam, Statistical Publisher House,
Publishing Decision No. 23/QD-NXBTK, 30th March 2015.
Grandell, L. T., Grandell, C. H. and Vander Zander, A. W.[2009], Theory of Development, Part one:
Study of human Development, McGraw-Hill. Ninth Edition, Available at :
www.mhe.com/crandell9forup-to-date
Hai Bang. [2013], “The new notations in the frauds of the financial statements”, (in Vietnamese:
Những lưu ý mới về gian lận trong báo cáo tài chính”, Vietnam Economic Times, Jan. 2013,
ICPNo. 797/GP-BTTTT,Available at:
http://www.vacpa.org.vn/index.php?o=modules&n=forum&f=forum_detail&idforum=691&page=6
Hang Phuong. [2012], “Finding the frauds on the financial statements of enterprises”, (in Vietnamese:
Bắt lỗi sai sót trong báo cáo tài chính của doanh nghiệp). Available at website:
http://www.vacpa.org.vn/index.php?o=modules&n=forum&f=forum_detail&idforum=675&page=8
Hail, L., Leuz, C. and Wysocki, P. [2009], “Global Accounting Convergence and the Potential
Adoption of IFRS by the United States: An Analysis of Economic and Policy Factors”, Working
paper, available at: http://ssrn.com/abstract=1357331
Hammersley, M. and Atkinson, P. [1983], Ethnography Principles in Practice, Tavistock Publication,
London and New York.
Haney, L. H. [2003], Business Organization and combination: An analysis of the evolution and nature
of business organization in the United States and a tentative solution of the corporation and trust
problems,Batoche Books, Kitchener, edition published, 2003 (originally published, 1913), 289.p,
Available at: socserv2.socsci.mcmaster.ca/econ/ugcm/.../haney/BusinessCombination.p.
Hansen, H., Rand, J. and Tarp, F. [undated], “Enterprise Growth and Survival in Vietnam: Does
Government Support Matters?”, Working paper, DERG (Development Economics Research
Group), Department of Economics, University of Copenhagen
Haw,In-Mu., Qi, D. and Wu, W.[2000], “Timeliness of Annual Report Releases and Market Reaction
to Earnings Announcements in an Emerging capital Market: The case of China”, Journal of
International Financial Management and Accounting, Vol. 11 (2). 2000, pp. 108-130.
Heald, D. and Georgious, G.[2000],”Consolidation prickles and practices for UK government
sector”,Accounting and Business Research, Vol. 30 (2), pp. 153-167.
Herrmann, D., Inoue, T. and Thomas, W. B. [2001], “The relation between Incremental Subsidiary
Earnings and Future Stock Returns in Japan”, Journal of Business Finance and Accounting, Vol.
28 (9) and (10), November/December 2001.0306-686X.
Herring, H. C III [2003], Business Combination and International Accounting, Thomson, South-
Western Publisher, 2003, 346p.
Hillman, A. D., Heaston, P. H. and James, L. D.[2012], “Convergence or Adoption of IFRS in the
United State?”, Drake Management Review, Volume 1, Issue 2, April 2012.
Hurley, A. E., Scandura, T. A., Schriesheim, C. A., Brannick, M. T., Seer, A., Vandenberg, R. J. and
Williams, A. J. [1997], “Exploratory and confirmatory factor analysis: guidelines, issues, and
alternatives”, Journal of Organizational Behaviour, Vol. 18, pp. 667-683.
Ian Coxhead.[2007], “Globalization, Poverty and Environment in Vietnam”, A review of empirics,
methods and policy issue, Research proposal, Ford Foundation project, University of Wisconsin-
Madison. July, 2007.
IASB-International Accounting Standards Board [2012], “IFRS 10-Consolidated financial Statements
and IFRS 12 Disclosure of interest in Other Entities, Effect Analysis”, InternationalAccounting
standards, September, 2012: Available at:
www.ifrs.org/.../EffectAnalysis_IFRS10andIFRS12_UpdatedJanuary201.
140
IASCF-International Accounting Standards Committee Foundation [2004], International Financial
Reporting Standards (IFRSs), including International Accounting Standards (IASs) and
interpretations as at 31 March 2004, International Accounting Standards Board, IASCF
Publication Department, London, United Kingdom.
IASB [2006], “Conceptual Framework: Phase D: Reporting Entity-Parent Company Approach”, IASB
Meeting –December 2006
IFRS [2008], International Financial Reporting Standard No. 3: “Business combination”, IFRS Foundation
IFRS [2011], International Financial Reporting Standard No. 10: “Consolidated Financial Statements”,
IFRS Foundation
Ishizuka, F. [2011], “Economic restructuring and Regional Distribution of Enterprises in Vietnam”,
Discussion paper, IDE (Institute of Developing Countries), JETRO (Japan External Trade Organization)
Islam, N. [2003], “What have we learnt from the convergence debate?], Journal of Economic Survey. Vol. 17,
No 3, 2003, pp. 309-362. DOI: 0950-0804/03/03 0309-54
Joe Tidd.[2006], “A review of Innovation model”,Discussion paper, Tanaka Business school,
Imperial College London,(2006).
John Papley, [2007], Understanding Development: Theory and Practice in the Third World, Third
Edition, Luynne Rienner Publishers, 2007, pp. 1-12.
Kajiwara, A.[1999],“The function of Consolidated Financial Statement in Japan”,The Book of The
Japanese style of business accounting, edited by Shyam Sunder and Hedetoshi Yamaji. First
published, 1999.
Kanamori, E.[2005], “The development of Group Accounting in the United Kingdom: Setting the
Scene”, The Ritsumeikan Business Review, Vol. XLIII No.5, Jan. 2005, pp. 243-262.
Kawasaki, T. and Sakamoto, T. [2014], General Accounting Standard for Small and Medium sized
entities in Japan, Willey Publishing Japan, 15 September 2014.
Kim, S., Lee, H. and Lee, M. H. [2010], “Research in Convergence: A literature Analysis”, Journal of
research and Practice in Information Technology, Vol. 42, No 3. August 2010, pp. 191-205.
Kim, W., Nam, II. G. and Tran, T.C. [2010], “On the Governance of State – Owned Economic
Group in Vietnam”, Preliminary consultation paper to the 2009, Knowledge Sharing Program
(KSP) between Republic Korea and the Socialist Republic Vietnam, April 12, 2010, Available at:
http://ssm.com/abstract=1729093
Kitchen, J.[1973], “Consolidate Accounts and Disclosure: Retrospect and Prospect”, Accountancy, January
1973, pp.14-17.
KPMG. [2011], Investing in Vietnam, MARIVN01-1011, available at http//: www.kpmg.com.vn
KPMG.[2012], Vietnam: Taxation of Cross-Border Mergers and Acquisitions, Available at
http://www.kpmg.com/Global/en/IssuesAndInsights/ArticlesPublications/cross-border-mergers-
acquisitions/Documents/vietnam-2012.pdf.
KPMG. [2016], Law on Accounting 2015 – Financial Report Alert, February , 2016, KPMG limited, a
Vietnamese limited liability company, available at http//: www.kpmg.com.vn
Lambert, T., [undated], “A brief History of Vietnam”, Working paper, available at:
http://www.localhitories.org/viethist.html
Le, D. D. [2015], “The Past and the Hopeful Future of Vietnam’s Economy”, Asian Management
Insights, Vol. 2, pp. 29-34.
Le, V. L. [2015], “The inconsistence in accounting for inter-transaction of fix assets selling follows
Circular No. 202”, (in Vietnamese: Bất cập hạch toán loại trừ ảnh hưởng của giao dịch bán tài sản
cố định trong kỳ của Thông tư 202), Accounting and Auditing Reviews, No.3 (2015), pp. 39-40.
141
Le, V. L. and Phi, T. D. H. [2014], “Discussion about the method of rejecting the inter-transaction
between the parent and associate company”, (in Vietnamese: Bàn về phương pháp loại trừ giao
dịch nội bộ của công ty mẹ và công ty liên kết), Vietnam Accounting and Auditing Review. Vol.4
(2014), pp. 25-26.
Le, V. N. T. and Phan, T. N. [2015], “Accounting for Business combination in Vietnam – converging
to international accounting standards”, (in Vietnamese: Hợp nhất kinh doanh trong kế toán
Vietnam-Sự tiếp cận chuẩn mực kế toán quốc tế), Accounting and Auditing Reviews, Vol. 10
(2015), pp. 23-25.
Lee, E., Walker,M. and Zeng, C. [2013], “Does IFRS Convergence Affect Financial Reporting Quality in
China?”, Certified Accountants Educational Trust, ACCA, 2013,pp. 1-21.
Léger, A. and Swaminathan, S.[2007], “Innovation Theories: Relevance and Implication for
Developing countries Innovation”,Discussion papers 743. DIW, Berlin, German Institute for
Economic Research. November, 2007, ISSN print edition 1433-0210. ISSN electronic edition
1619-4535.
Lehman, G. [2003], “A Critical Perspective on the Harmonisation of Accounting in a Globalizing World”,
Critical Perspectives on Accounting, Vol.16 (2005), pp.975–992.
Levmore, S.[2012], “Harmonization, Preference and the calculus of consent in Commercial and other Law”,
Olin Research Paper No. 602 Public Law Working Paper No. 387, June, 2012; pp. 1-20.
DOI: 10.2139/ssrn.2079295
Lin, S., Riccardi, W. and Wang, J. [2012], “Relative Benefits of adoption of IFRS and Convergence between
IFRS and US GAAP: Evidence from German”, Working paper,Available at:
https://business.fiu.edu/soa/pdf/IFRS_USGAAP_LRW_FIU.pdf
Lindsey, J. and Bohman, M.[1997], “Environmental Policy Harmonization”, Proceedings section -
original document under NAPTA, 1997, pp 93-111, Available at:
ageconsearch.umn.edu/bitstream/16915/1/ag970093.pdf
Lowe, H.D.[1990], “Shortcoming of Japanese Consolidated financial Statements”, Journal of Accounting
Horizons. September 1990
Mack, J. [2004], “An investigation of the information requirements of users of Australian public
sector financial reports”, Doctoral thesis, Queensland University of Technology,Brisbane,
Australia, Available at: eprints.qut.edu.au/15854/1/Janet_Mack_Thesis.pdf
Mack, J., Ryan, C. and Danstun, K. [undated], “Users of local government annual reports: An
Exploratory study”, Working paper No. 4. Available at: www.victoria.ac.nz/sacl/centres-and-
institutes/cagtr/.../WP04.pdf
MAG. [2014], Vietnamese Macroeconomic report 2013- Challenges in future, (in Vietnamese: Báo
cáo kinh tế vĩ mô 2013- Thách thức còn ở phía trước), Central Economic Committee of National
Assembly, Tri Thuc Publisher House.
Mai, P. H., Yang, J. W. and Nguyen, T. V.[2013], “Achievements and Barriers to Vietnam’s
Economic Development”, International Journal of Economics, Finance and Management Sciences.
Vol. 1, No. 6, 2013, pp. 374-381. doi: 10.11648/j.ijefm.20130106.24.
Mai, T. H. M. [2010], “Evaluation of preparing Consolidated Financial Statements following VAS”,
(in Vietnamese: Đánh giá việc lập báo cáo tài chính hợp nhất theo quy định của Chuẩn mực kế
toán Việt Nam) Vietnam Auditing Review, Available at http://www.tapchiketoan.com.vn, 17th
March 2010
Mantovani, A. and Vancauteren, M. [2003], “The harmonization of technical barriers to trade
innovation and export behavior: theory with an application to EU environmental data”, Working
142
paper, The Ecomod conference, August, 2003,pp 1-29, Available at
www.wti.org/...trade.../05_Trade_effects_of_MRL_Harmonization.pdf.
Meyer, S. and Schulz, N. S.[2008], “Ownership with Adjectives Donor Harmonization: between
Effectiveness and Democratization Synthesis Report”, Working paper, Fride, March, 2008.
McGee, R. W. [2009], “Corporate Governance in Developing Economies. Country Studies of Africa,
Asia and Latin America”, Springer Science +Business Media, LLC 2009
Mian, L. S. and Smith, W.A. Jr. [1989], “Incentives for unconsolidated financial reporting”,Journal of
Accounting and Economics, Vol. 12 (1990), pp. 141-171, North Holland.
Mian, L. S. and Smith, W.A. Jr. [1990], “Incentives associated with changes in consolidated reporting
requirement”, Journal of Accounting and Economics, Vol. 13 (1990), pp. 249-266, North Holland.
Micheline, R. and Nguyen, C. P.[2007], “The new system of business accounting in Vietnam: An
empirical evaluation”,Research conference: Chaire d’information financiere et organisationnelle
[Chair of financial and organizational information]. March, 2007.
Mijoč, I. and Starčević, D. P.[2013], “Measurement of accounting Harmonization and
standardization”,MEST journal, Vol. 1, No. 1, pp. 126-136, January, 2013.
MOF (Ministry of Finance) [2003], Decision No. 234/2003/QĐ-BTC. Issuance of Six Vietnamese
Standards on Accounting (Batch 3): Accounting Standards No. 25; 21; 07; 08; 05; 26, (in
Vietnamese)
MOF (Ministry of Finance) [2005], Circular No. 23/2005/TT-BTC: Guidance for implementation of
Decision No. 234/2003/QĐ-BTC, Accounting regulations (Circulars), (in Vietnamese).
MOF (Ministry of Finance) [2005], Decision No. 100/2005/QD-BTC. Issuance of Four Vietnamese
Standards on Accounting (Batch 5): Accounting Standards No. 11; 18; 19; 30, (in Vietnamese).
MOF (Ministry of Finance) [2007], Circular No. 161/2007/TT-BTC: Guidance for implementation of
Vietnamese Accounting standards (revised 2005), Accounting regulation, (in Vietnamese).
MOF (Ministry of Finance) [2010], Decree No 443/QD-BTC date 10/3/2010: Processing of the
building or publishing Accounting Standards, (in Vietnamese).
MOF (Ministry of Finance) [2011], Decision No 1001/QD-BTC date 4 May 2011: Reforming the
Vietnamese Accounting standards Board (in Vietnamese).
MOF (Ministry of Finance) [2013], “National Debt Statistical Data 2010-2012”, (in Vietnamese: Bản
tin công nợ- các số liệu thống kê 2010-2012), Department of Debt Management and External
Finance (DMEF), Bulletin Public Debt. Vol. 2, October, 2013.
MOF (Ministry of Finance)[2013a], Recapitulative report of the implementation of accounting law-
2003, (in Vietnamese: Báo cáo tổng kết, đánh giá việc thi hành luật kế toán 2003), Available at
http://duthaoonline.quochoi.vn/DuThao/Lists/DT_TAILIEU/Attachments/1591/Baocaotongketdangia.doc.
MOF (Ministry of Finance) [2013b], Archive No. 2098/BTC-CĐKT “Recapitulation of
implementation of accounting law” (in Vietnamese: Công văn số 2098/BTC-CĐKT về tổng kết,
đánh giá việc thực hiện luật kế toán), Dated on 7/2/2013 Available at:
ttp;//www/langson.gov.vn/ubnd/system/file/vbd/2089.pdf.
MOF (Ministry of Finance)[2015], “Comparison of Law on Accounting 2003 and Law of revising
Accounting Law”, (in Vietnamese: Bảng so sánh luật kế toán 2003 và Luật sửa đổi bổ sung luật kế
toán), Dated on 6/3/2015, Available at:
http://duthaoonline.quochoi.vn/DuThao/Lists/DT_TAILIEU_COBAN/Attachments/1823/Bang_so_sanh-
Luat_ke_toan_2003_va_Luat_sdbs.docx
MOJ (Ministry of Justice) [2016], Proposal for Introducing Accounting Law, (in Vietnamese: Đề
cương giới thiệu Luật kế toán), Ministry of Justice and Ministry of Finance, 2016 Available at:
143
http://moj.gov.vn/qt/tl-
pbgdpl/Lists/Decuong/Attachments/209/De%20cuong%20Luat%20ke%20toan.%20final.doc.
MoIT – UNIDO.[2011], Vietnam Industrial Competitiveness Report 2011, Ministry of Industry and
Trade of Vietnam and United Nations Industrial Development Organization, pp. 1-88
Moldascl, M.[2010], “Why Innovation Theories Make no Sense”, Papers and Preprints of
Department of Innovation Research and Sustainable Resource Management (BWL IX),
Chemmitz University of Technology. No. 9/2010,pp. 1-18.
Moonitz, M.[1942], “The Entity Approach to Consolidated Statements”, The Accounting Review, Vol.
17(3), pp. 236-242.
Moonitz, M. [1944, 1951], The Entity Theory to Consolidated Statements, Brooklyn: the Foundation
Press. Inc.
Mora, A. and Rees, W. [1998], “The Early Adoption of Consolidated Accounting in Spain”, The European
Accounting Review, Vol. 7, No.4, pp.675-696
MSU (Michigan State University). [2014], “Vietnam – History”, Onlinepaper, Asian Studies Center,
available at: asia.isp.msu.edu/wbwoa/southeast-asia/Vietnam/history.html
Müller, V. O. [2010], “Developments and enquires in the field of consolidated financial statements”,
Doctoral thesis, Universitatea babes- Bolyai, 2010.
Müller, V. O. [2011], “Value relevance of consolidated versus parent company financial statements:
Evidence from the largest three European capital markets”, Accounting and Management Information
Systems, Vol. 10, No. 3, pp. 326–350, 2011
Müller, V. O. [2014], “ The impact of IFRS adoption on the quality of consolidated financial reporting”,
2nd World Conference On Business, Economics And Management -WCBEM 2013Procedia - Social
and Behavioral Sciences 109 (2014), pp. 976 – 982
Mustaţă, R. V. and Matiș, D. [2007], “Measurement of need for harmonization between national
accounting standards and international financial reporting standards”, Munich Personal RePEc
Archive (MRA) Research Paper No. 6183, December 2007 16: 27 UTC. Online Available at:
http://mpra.ub.uni-muenchen.de/6183/
Narayan, F. B. and Godden, T. [2000], Financial management and governance issues in Vietnam,
Asian Development Bank 2000,
Newlove, G. H. [1926], Consolidated Balance Sheet. Ronald Press, New York, 309 p.
Newlove, G. H. [1949], Consolidated Statements including Mergers and consolidations, D.C Heath and
Company, Printed in United State of America.
Nghiem, X. D. and Doan, T. D. [2015], “Discuss about the inconsistent contents of circular No 200
and recommendations”, (in Vietnamese: Bàn về những bất cập của thông tư 200 và những kiến
nghị), Accounting and Auditing Reviews, No. 7(2015).
Ngo, T. C., Truong, T. T., Le, V. L. and Nguyen, T. H. V. [2005], Prepare the consolidated financial
statements following Vietnamese accounting standard - VAS 25, (in Vietnamese: Lập báo cáo tài chính
hợp nhất theo chuẩn mực kế toán Việt Nam-VAS25). Statistical Publisher House.Publishing license No.
33-333/TK 2005.46-1328/XB-QLXB. 12th August 2005.
Ngo, T. C. and Pham, V. D. [2013], Vietnamese Accounting System: The sketch of Establishment and
Development, Financial Academic (in Vietnamese: Kế toán Việt Nam: Quá trình hình thành và
Phát triển) Financial Publisher House, Publishing license No:16-2013/CXB/322-160/TC and
QDXB: 163/QD-NXBTC, 13th August, 2013.
Nguyen, A. T [2012], “The written source of criminal Law” (in Vietnamese), Science Journal of
National University, Vol. 28 (2012), pp. 95‐100
144
Nguyen, A. T. and Guangming, G. [2012], “Vietnamese Accounting Reform and International
Convergence of Vietnamese Accounting Standards”International Journal of Business and
Management. Vol. 7, No. 10; May 2012.
Nguyen, C.P. [2009], “Discuss about the methods of consolidating financial statements”, (in
Vietnamese: Phương Pháp hợp nhất báo cáo tài chính), Vietnam Accounting Review, Vol. 80
(2009), Available at: http://www.misa.com.vn/tabid/91/newsid/5559/Phuong-phap-hop-nhat-bao-cao-tai-
chinh.aspx
Nguyen, C. P. [2013], “Co-existence of Accounting Standards and a Uniform Accounting System in
Vietnam”, (in Vietnamese: Về mô hình chuẩn mực-chế độ kế toán Việt Nam), Journal of
Economy and Development, Vol. 194, 8/2013, pp. 31-37.
Nguyen, C. P. and Richard, J., [2011], “Economic Transition and Accounting System Reform in
Vietnam”, European Accounting Review (ISI), Vol. 20, No.4, pp: 693-725, 2011.
Nguyen, D.T.[2002],“Effect of Economic Globalization on developing countries”,Nature, Society and
Thought journal. Vol. 5 No. 2 (2002), pp. 221-232.
Nguyen, D. T. and Pham, H. [1997], “Vietnam”, Financial Reporting in the Pacific Asia Region,
Ronald Ma (editor), World Scientific.
Nguyen, H. A. and Doan, T. D. [2015], “Accounting for revenue under regulation of the circular 200”,
(in Vietnamese: Về kế toán doanh thu bán hàng theo thông tư 200), Accounting and Auditing
Reviews, available at:vaa.net.vn
Nguyen, H. C., Gallery, G. and Artiach, T. [2013], “Interim Financial reporting in the Asia-Pacific region:
A review of regulatory requirements”, Corporate Ownership and Control, Vol. 10, Issue 3, 2013.
Nguyen, K. [2012], “An economic group: A model of management and development strategy” (in
Vietnamese: Tập đoàn kinh tế-Mô hình quản lý và chiến lược phát triển), Vietnam National
University’s (VNU) Journal of Science, Vol. 28(2012), pp. 16‐22
Nguyen, L., Hooper, K. and Sinclair, R. [2012], “Resistance or Change in the Vietnamese Accounting
Field?”, Working paper, ARA 2012 Conference 30th November 2012, AUT City Campus, Private Bag
92006, Auckland 1142, New Zealand
Nguyen, L, Hooper, K. and Sinclair, R. [2012], “Resistance or Change in the Vietnamese Accounting
Field?”, Proceedings of World Business and Economic research conference, 2012, Corporate
Ownership and Control journal, Volume 11, Issue 1, 2013
Nguyen, N. B. [2010], “The Recent Economic Situation of Vietnam and Investment Risks”,
Discussion Paper No. A-2, Center for Risk Research Faculty of Economics, Shiga University.
Nguyen, P. G. [2009], Accounting for business combination and consolidated financial statements, (in
Vietnamese: Kế toán hợp nhất kinh doanh và hợp nhất báo cáo tài chính), Financial Publisher House,
623p.
Nguyen, T. K. O. [2015], “Improving the Consolidated Financial Statements (CFSs) of Vietnam National
Coal –Mineral Inductries (Vinacomin) Group”, (in Vietnamese: Hoàn thiện hệ thống báo cáo tài chính
hợp nhất của tập đoàn công nghiệp than-khoáng sản Việt Nam), Doctoral dissertation. Academic of
Financial, No. 62.34.03.01, April, 2015.
Nguyen, T. P. U. [2013], “Conservation, Change and Resistance: A Bourdieuian study of Vietnamese
accounting field”,Doctoral dissertation, Auckland University of Technology, 2013.
Nguyen, T. B. L. and Nguyen, G. D. [2013], “Apparent information-the urgent problem of Stock
Market in Vietnam”.Science of Finance and Accounting Journal (in Vietnamese: Minh bạch
thông tin-Vấn đề cấp thiết của thị trường chứng khoán Việt Nam), Vol. 08 (121), 2013, pp. 30-33.
Nguyen, T. and Eddie, I. A. [1995], “Reform of the Accounting System in Vietnam”.International
Journal of Business Studies, Vol. 2, pp. 1-15
145
Nguyen Tri Tri [2015], “Applying the Circular No. 202/2014/TT-BTC to present the divesting
investment of parent company from the subsidiary on the consolidated Financial Statements”, (in
Vietnamese: Áp dụng thông tư 202/2014/TT-BTC để xử lý thoái vốn đầu tư của công ty mẹ trong
công ty con trên báo cáo tài chính hợp nhất), Accounting and Auditing Reviews, Vol. 5 (2015), pp.
16-18.
Nguyen Trong Thap [2014], “Discuss on the function of economic group in Vietnam”, (in
Vietnamese: Bàn về vai trò của tập đoàn kinh tế Việt Nam), Economy and Forecast Review, Vol
14 (7/2014), pp. 25-27
Nguyen, T. T. M. and Nguyen, T. T. H. [2013], “ Restructure of State Owned Enterprises focusing
onSate Economic group and Corporation-Sences of contemporary, perspective and
recommendations”, (in Vietnamese: Tái cấu trúc doanh nghiệp nhà nước, trọng tập là các tập đoàn
kinh tế nhà nước và các tổng công ty nhà nước: vài nét về thực trạng, triển vọng và giải pháp),
Economic and Developing Journal, Vol. 189, No. 3 (2013), pp. 42-51.
Nguyen, T. T. P. [2015], “Discuss about the VAS-Borrowing Cost in the implementation and study”,
(Bàn về chuẩn mực kế toán-Chi phí đi vay trong quá trình vận dụng và nghiên cứu) Accounting
and Auditing Reviews, Vol. 5 (2015), pp. 32-34.
Nguyen, V. H. [2013], “The information of Consolidated Financial Statements and the influence of
understanding of users on making business decision” (in Vietnamese: Thông tin trên báo cáo tài chính
hợ nhất và những iểu biết của người sử dụng ảnh hưởng đến việc ra quyết định), Research paper,
Available at www.ntu.edu.vn/Portals/60/.../v%20huong.doc
Nguyen, V. T. [2012], “Improving the restructure of Sate-owner Enterprises: Urgent working”, (in
Vietnamese: Đẩy mạnh tái cấu trúc doanh nghiệp nhà nước: Nhiệm vụ cấp bách hiện nay)”,
University of Economics and Finance’s (UEF) Development and Integration News, Vol. 7 (17) -
11-12/2012, pp. 26-30
Nguyen, X. H [2015], “Overview of Vietnamese Accounting system since 1975 and the Process of
Vietnam’s Convergence to IFRS”, Journal of Morden Accounting and Auditing, May 2015, Vol.
11, No.5, pp 260-268.
Nisbett, A. V. and Sheikh, A. [2007], “Accounting Scandals: Does “rule vs. Principles” Matter?”,
Tennessee CPA journal, November 2007, pp. 10-12.
Nobes, C. W.[2004], Developments in International Accounting – General Issues and Classification,
The New library of International Accounting, Edward Elgar Publishing, 2004
Nobes, C. [2005], “Rules-based Standards and the Lack of Principles in Accounting”, Accounting
Horizons, March 2005, Vol.19, No.1, pp.25-34
Nobes C and ParkerR.,[2000], Comparative International Accounting, Sixth Edition in Great Britian,
Prentice Hall Europe (1998), Pearson Education Limited (2000).
Odell, A. L. and Castillo, A. F. [2008], “Vietnam in a Nutshell: An Historical, Political and
Commercial Overview”, NYSBA International Law Practicum, Autumn 2008, Vol. 27, No. 2, pp.
82-91.
OECD.[2013], “Structural Policy Country Note Viet Nam”, Southeast Asian Outlook 2013: with
perspectives on China and India, Available at:
www.oecd.org/countries/vietnam/Viet%20Nam.pdf
Oguri, T.[2002], The Genesis and History of Consolidated Financial Statements in USA (in Japanese),
Marc 2002, 265p.
Oguri, T. and Hara, Y. [1990], “A critical Examination of Accounting Regulation in Japan”,
Accounting Auditing and Accountability Journal, Vol. 3 No. 2, 1990.
146
Oseni, A. I., Ireghah, M. M. and Ali-Momoh, B. [2011], “Accounting theory Formulation as a TOOL
for enhancing International Harmonization of Accounting Standards”, Journal of Innovative
research in management and Humanities, Vol. 2(1), April, 2011, ISSN: 2141-8217, pp. 1-14.
Pacter, P. [2014], “IFRS as global standards: a pocket guide”, The IFRS Foundation Publication
Department, 2014, Available at: www.cicuruguay.com.uy/ccea.../ifrs-as-global-standards.pdf.
Pacter, P. and Yuen, J. [2001], “Chinese standards in the international arena”, International
Accounting and. Business Journal, March, pp. 36–39
Pan, P., Patel, C. and Mala, R.[2014], “The Influence of Personality Variables on Chinese Professional
Accountants’ Judgments Relating to Consolidated Financial Reporting”, Presentated paper, 26th
Asian-Pacific Conference on International Accounting Issues Regent, Taipei, Taiwan, R.O.C.From
26-29 October, 2014.
Parasuranman, A., Zeithaml, A. A. and Berry, L. L.[1985],“A conceptual Model of service quality
and its implications for Future Research”, Journal of Marketing, Vol. 49 (fall 1985), pp. 41-50.
Peng, S., Tondkar, R. H., Van der Laan Smith, J. and Harless, D. W. [2008], “Does Convergence of
Accounting Standards Lead to the Convergence of Accounting Practices?, A study from China”,
The international Journal of Accounting, Vol 43 (2008), pp. 448-468.
Pieterse, N.[2010], Trend in Develop Theory, 2e-3890-CH-01: Giulianotti-3852-Ch-01.qxp.qxp, 2009,
pp. 1-18.
Pham, H. H. [2010], “De-jure convergence between Vietnamese and International Accounting
Standards”,(in Vietnamese: Mức độ hài hòa giữa chuẩn mực kế toán Việt Nam và chuẩn mực kế
toán quốc tế), Journal of Science and Technology, Da-Nang University, Vol. 5 (40), pp. 155-164.
Pham, H. H. [2012], “A comparative study of Vietnamese and international accounting standards”,
Doctoral thesis, Curtin University, School of Accounting.
Pham, H. N. [2008], “Review of Historical Development of Vietnamese legal system from 1945 to
present”, (in Vietnamese; Nhìn lại những chặng đường phát triển của pháp luật việt Nam từ 1945
đến nay), Working paper (VNH3.TB7.853), at the 3th International conference on Vietnamese
studies: Vietnamese legislation section, VNU (Vietnam National University, Hanoi) and VASS
(Vietnam Academy of social Science), 5th-7th December, 2008, pp. 627-645.
Pham, N. Q., Trinh, B. and Nguyen, T. D. [2007], “Economic performance of Vietnam, 1976-2000:
New evidence from input-output model”, Working Paper Series No. 2007/13, available at
http://www.depocenwp.org
Pham, Tr. [2012], “International Financial Reporting Standards effects on Banks in Vietnam”,
Bachelor´s Thesis, Jyväskylä University of Applied Science,
Pham, T. T. H. [2014], ”The disadvantage and advantage of Vietnamese Accounting standards in
preparing consolidated financial Statements”, (in Vietnamese: Chuẩn mực kế toán Việt Nam-
Thuận lợi và khó khăn trong công tác lập BCTC hợp nhất), Vietnam Accounting and Auditing
Review, Vol. 6, 2014, pp. 30-33.
Pham T. T. H. [2015], “Negative and Positive Points of Preparing the Consolidated Financial
Statements in the enterprises of Vietnam Civil Engineering Construction Corporation”, (in
Vietnamese: Thuận lợi và khó khăn trong công tác lập báo cáo tài chính hợp nhất tại các tổng
công ty xây dựng công trình giao thông của Việt Nam), Accounting and Auditing Reviews, Vol. 6
(2015), pp.24-25.
Phan, D. [2013], “Make better the accounting regulation system: Improving the quality of
Accounting-Auditing operations and the international Integration, (in Vietnamese: Hoàn thiện hệ
thống pháp luật kế toán- Nâng cáo chất lượng hoạt động kế toán kiểm toán và hội nhập quốc tế),
Journal of Development and Integration, Vol. 12 (22)-9-10/2013,pp. 70-77.
147
Phan, M. N and Ramstetter,E. D. [2006], “Economic Growth, Trade, and Multinational Presence in
Vietnam's Provinces”, Working Paper Series Vol. 2006-18.Kyushu University.
Phan, D., Mascitelli, B.and Barut,M. [2013], “Reception of Accounting Professionals towards
International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS) in Developing country: Evidence from
Vietnam”, Research Paper, Proceedings of 3th Global Accounting, Finance and Economics
Conference. 5-7 may, 2013, Ryges Melbourne, Australia.
Phan, T. H. D., Mascitelli, B. and Barut, M. [2014], “Perceptions Towards International Financial
Reporting Standards (IFRS): The case of Vietnam”, Global Review of Accounting and Finance.
Vol. 5, No.1. March 2014, pp. 132-152.
Phi, T. D. H. [2006], “Improving the consolidated financial statements of Vietnam Airline group” (in
Vietnamese), Master thesis, Hanoi Commercial University, Vietnam, Under-graduated Faculty.
Phi, T. D. H. [2008], “The current regime of accounting for Agricultural Cooperatives – many
inadequate points, Vietnam Review of Accounting, 2008, Vol.70: 33-34.
Phi, T. D. H, [2014], “The Vietnamese Accounting System: History and Development”, The
Economic Review of Komazawa University, Vol 46, No 2, pp. 73-92
Phi, T. D. H, [2015], “Convergence Accounting Standards on Consolidation in Vietnam”, Research
Paper, 30th Conference on Accounting in Komazawa University, 10th-12nd October, 2015
Phi, T. D. H, [2016], “Harmonization and Convergence in Accounting system: the experiment from
other countries for Vietnam”, The Economic Review of Komazawa University, Vol 47, No 1, pp.
19-38
Porter, M. E. [1985], Competitive Advantage: creating and sustaining superior performance with a
new introduction, The Free Press (Simon & Schuster Inc).
Prater –Kinsey, J. [2006], “Developing countries converging wit developed-country accounting
standards: Evidence from South Africa and Mexico”, The International Journal of Accounting,
Vol. 41 (2006), pp. 141-162. DOI: 10.1016/j.intacc.2006.04.2007.
Psaros, J. and Trotman, K. T. [2004], “The Impact of the Type of Accounting Standards on Preparers’
Judgments”, Abacus, Vol. 40, No. 1, 2004, pp. 76-93.
Quang, T. [2013], “Vietnam: An Emerging Economy at a Cross Roads”, Working paper No. 2013/09.
Maastricht school of management, Available at: www.msm.nl/resources/uploads/2014/02/MSM-
WP2013-09.pdf
Ramanna, K. and Ewa, S. [2009], “Why do countries adopt International Financial Reporting
Standards?”,Working paper, 09-102, Harvard Business School, 2009.
Reich-Graefe, R. [2005], “ Changing Paradigm: The Liability of Corporate Group in Germany”,
Recommended Citation, Conneticut Law Review, Vol. 37 (2005), Faculty Publications at Digital
Commons@ Western New England University School of Law, pp. 785-817.
Richards, W. D. Jr. and Seary, A. J. [1997], “Convergence Analysis of communication Network”, Project
paper by a grant from the Social Sciences Humanities research Council of Canada. Available at:
www.sfu.ca/~richards/pages/converge.pdf
Rhys, J.[2006], “Globalization, FDI and Employment in Vietnam”, Transnational Corporations,
April 2006. Vol .15, No .1. pp. 115-142
Robbins, L.[1968], Theory of Economic Development in the history of Economic Through Revised
and Extended, Machillan ST Martin’s Press, 1968.
Robson, T. B. [1946, 1969], Holding Company and Their Subsidiaries: Consolidated accounts, principles
and procedures, London: Gee and Company Ltd (Publisher). 109p.
Rogers, E. M. [1995], Diffusion of Innovation, First Edition, The Free Press,NewYork, pp. 161-251.
Rogers, E. M. [2003], Diffusion of Innovation, Fifth Edition, The Free Press, New York.
148
Romero, H., Dijkman, R., Grefen, P. and Arjan van, W.[2012], “A literature review in process
harmonization: a conceptual framework”, Working paper No 379, NUR 982, Apirl, 2012.
Available at http://cms.ieis.tue.nl/Beta/Files/WorkingPapers/wp_379.pdf
Ryan, B. and Gross, N. C. [1943], “Acceptance and Diffusion of Hybrid Corn Seed in Two Iowa
Communities”, Agricultural Experiment station Iowa state College of Agriculture and Mechanic
Arts, Sociology Subsection, Economics and Sociology section, Ames, Iowa, Research Bulletin-
v029-b372. January, 1950. Pp 663-705.
Saloheimo, M.[2008], “Conceptual Model for defining role and their interaction in business
networks”, Annals of University of Bucharest, Economic and Administrative Series, Nr. 2.(2008),
pp. 58-69.
Sapienza, S. R. [1964], “Business Combinations and Enterprise Evaluation”, Journal of accounting
research, Vol. 2.1964, pp. 50-66
Sarikas, R. H.S., Vu, D. H. and Djatej, A. M. [2009], “International Influence on Accountancy in
Vietnam”, R.W. McGee (ed.), Corporate Governance in Developing Economies, DOI
10.1007/978-0-387-84833-4_19, Springer Science+Business Media.
Sauders, D.[2009], “A theory of financial Innovation and Monetary Substitution with an Application
to a Century of Data on the M1- Income Ratio (Preliminary)”, Working paper, Purdue University,
March 2009.
Shalev, R. [2009], “The Information Content of BusinessCombination Disclosure Level”, The
Accounting Review, Vol. 84, No. 1, 2009, DOI: 10.2308 / accr.2009.84.1.239, pp. 239–270.
Schipper, K. [2003], “Principles-Based Accounting Standards”, Accounting Horizons, March 2003,
vol. 17, No. 1, pp. 61-67.
Schmidt, U.[2004], “Vietnam’s integration into the global economy: achievement and challenges”,
Asia Europe journal (2004),Vol. 2, pp. 63-83. DOI: 10.2007/S10308-004-0075-Y.
Schumpeter, J. A. [1939], Business Cycles: A Theoretical, Historical, and Statistical Analysis of the
Capitalist Process, First Edition. Vol II, McGraw Hill Book Company. Inc.
Spearman, C.[1904], “General intelligence objectively determined and measures”, American Journal
of Psychology, Vol. 15, pp. 201-293.
Srinivasan, P. and Narasimhan, M. S. [2008], “An Analysis of Consolidated and Parent-Only
Financial Statements of Indian Companies”, The Icfai University Journal of Accounting Research,
Vol. VII, No. 3, 2008, pp. 27-42.
State Secretariat for Economic Affair (SECO).[2013], Vietnam Country Strategy 2013-2016, Swiss
Economic Cooperation and Development, Science and Technics Publishing House.
Street, D. L., Gray, S. J. and Bryant, S.M.[1999], “Acceptance and Observance of International
Accounting Standards: An Empirical Study of Companies Claiming to Comply with IASs”, The
International Journal of Accounting, Vol. 34, No. 1, pp 11-48, ISSN” 0020-7063.
Sunder, S. and Yamaji, H. [1999], The Japanese Style of Business Accounting, Quorum Books, Westport,
Connecticut-London, 268p.
Suojanen, W. W. [1954], “Accounting Theory and The large Corporation”, The Accounting Review, Vol.
29(3). pp. 391-398
Suojanen, W. W. [1958], “Enterprise Theory and Corporate Balance Sheets”, The Accounting Review, Vol.
33(1). pp. 236-242
Svensson, A. [2008], “Consolidated Financial Statements”, Akelius University, Working paper,
Online available at: university.akelius.de/library/pdf/consolidated_fi_anders_svensson.pdf
Tabachnick, B. G. and Fidell, L. S. [2007], Using Multivariate Statistics, Pearson International Edition, 980p.
149
Taherdoost, H., Sahibuddin, S. and Jalaliyoon, N. [2014], “Exploratory Factor Analysis: Concepts and
Theory”, Advances in Applied and Pure Mathematics, WSEAS Press. pp. 375-382.
Taylor, P.A. [1987], Consolidated Financial Statements: Concepts, Issues and Techniques, Harper & Row,
Publishers.
Tarca, A.[2003],“Achieving international Harmonisation through accounting policy choice”,Research
paper, The AAANZ 2001 PhD Colloqurium, AAA International Group 2002 Mid-Year Meeting,
Online available at: http://papers.ssrn.com/sol3/paperscfm?.abstract-id:321540.
Thoburn, J. [2009], “Vietnam as a Role Model for Development”, Research Paper No. 2009/03.
UNU-WIDER (United Nation University – World Institute for Development Economic Research).
Tongzon, J. L. [1999], “The Challenge of Regional Economic Integration: The Vietnamese
respective”, The Developing Economics, Vol. XXXVII-2, June, 1999, pp. 137-161.
Tran, H. V.[2014], “The convergence between Vietnamese and international accounting for
preparation and presentation of the consolidated financial statements: from accounting standards
to practical situation”, (in Vietnamese: Sự hài hòa giữa kế toán Việt nam và quốc tế trong lập và
trình bày báo cáo tài chin hợp nhất: Từ chuẩn mực đến thực tiễn), Doctoral
dissertation,University of Economic Ho Chi Minh City, Under-graduated Institution, Jan. 2014.
Tran, Q. T. [2012], “The threats of international accounting convergence process and the lessons for
Vietnam”, (in Vietnamese: Thách thức của hội nhập kế toán quốc tế và bài học cho Việt Nam),
Vietnam Auditing Review, Vol. 3, 2012.
Tran, Q. T. [2013], “Trend to build Vietnamese financial report standards to satisfy international
accounting convergence”, (in Vietnamese: Định hướng xây dựng chuẩn mực báo cáo tài chính
Việt Nam đáp ứng xu thế hội tụ kế toán quốc tế), Doctoral dissertation, University of Economics
Ho Chi Minh city, No.62340301 May, 2013.
Tran, Q. T. [2014], “The solutions for improving the applying Vietnam Accounting Standards for
Vietnamese Enterprises”, (in Vietnamese: Các giải pháp hoàn thiện việc vận dụng chuản mực kế
toán Việt Nam của các doanh nghiệp Accounting and Auditing Reviews, available at vaa.net.vn
Tran, Q. T. [2015], “Evaluating the Provision of Information in the Financial Statements of
Enterprises: Empirical Evidence from Vietnam”, Journal of Modern Accounting and Auditing,
September 2015, Vol. 11, No. 9, pp. 435-442.
Tran T. A. [2007], “The current situation and recommendation for enterprise in preparing the consolidated
Financial statement in Vietnam”, (in Vietnamese: Thực trạng và giải pháp để lập báo cáo tài chính hợp
nhất cho các doanh nghiệp tại Việt Nam), Master thesis, University of Economic Ho Chi Minh City,
Under-graduated Institution, No. 60.34.30 .2007.
Tran, T. C., Le, X. S and Nguyen, K. A.[2008], “Vietnam’s enterprises development: Characteristics,
constraints and policy recommendation”, SME in Asia and Globalization, ERIA Research project
report. 2007.5. pp 323-364.
Tran, T. C. T. [2015], “Improving the financial reporting system of Vietnamese enterprises in the
period of integration”, (in Vietnamese: Hoàn thiên hệ thống báo cáo tài chính của các doanh
nghiệp Việt Nam trong thời kỳ hội nhập), Accounting and Auditing Reviews, Vol. 5, pp. 29-31.
Tran, T. T. H. [2015], “An Analysis of the Factors Affecting the Adoption of Accounting Legislation
by Small and Medium-Sized Enterprises (SMES) in Vietnam”, International Journal of Business
and Management, Vol. 10, No. 2; 2015, pp. 176-185.
Tran, V. H. and Nguyen, T. N.[2015], “Improvement of Law on Accounting 2003 follows the current
economy”, (in Vietnamese: Hoàn thiện Luật Kế toán 2003 phù hợp với nền kinh tế hiện nay),
Accounting and Auditing Reviews, available at: www.vacpa.org.vn
150
Tran, V. T. [2003], Economic development in Vietnam during the secondhalf of the 20th century:
How to avoid the danger of lagging behind, Chapter 2 in The Vietnamese Economy: Awakening
the dorming dragon, ed. by Binh Tran Nam and Chi Do Pham, RoutledCurzon, 2003.
Tran,X . N. [2015], “Inconsistence and unsuitable points of Circular 200” (in Vietnamese: Một số
điểm mâu thuẫn và bất hợp lý của thông tư 200), Online paper, Available at:danketoan.com
Truong, Q. D. [2008], “Development of economic group in Vietnam”, (in Vietnamese: Phát triển tập
đoàn kinh tế ở nước ta), Online Paper, available at http://.saigonact.edu.vn
Truong, Q. [2013], “Vietnam: An Emerging Economy at a Cross Roads”, Working Paper No. 2013/09,
Oxford Handbook of Asian Business Systems by Michael de Witt (ed.), Summer, 2013
Tucker, L. R. and MacCallum, R. C., [1997], “Exploratory Factor Analysis”, Unpublished manuscript,
Available at: www.ffzg.unizg.hr/psiho/phm/nastava/Book-Exp
Uddin, Md. K., Akhtar, R., Rashid, Md. M. and Lucky, R. Y. [2013], “Economic growth and Income
convergence: A literature review” Bangladesh Research Publication Journal. Vol. 8, Issues 2, pp.
134-145. March – April, 2013. ISSN: 1998-2003.
US SEC (United States Securities and Exchange Commission). [2002], Study Pursuant to Section
108(d) of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 on the Adoption by the United States Financial
Reporting System of a Principles-Based Accounting System, Online Paper, Available
at:https://www.sec.gov/news/studies/principlesbasedstand.htm
VACPA.[2012],“The Vital Role of Professional Accountancy Organizations”, Discussion papers on
proceeding of The Vietnam Association of Certified Public Accountants Conference. August,
2012. 96p
Van der Tas, L.G. [1988], “Measuring Harmonization of Financial Reporting Practice”,Accounting
and Business Research, Vol. 18 (70),pp. 157-169.
VDIC (Vietnam Development Information Centre).[2012]. “Vietnam Development Report 2012-
Market Economy for a Middle-income Vietnam”, Joint Donor Report to the Vietnam
Consultative Group Meeting, December 06, 2011. Publishing licence No: 727/QĐLK-LĐ CXB
1142-2011/CXB/08-118-LĐ date: 2/12/2011. Available at: http://www.griffith.edu.au
Vietnam Assembly’s Economic Committee, [2013], Vietnamese economy 2013-After one year with
the re-structure of economy. Spring 2013 report, (in Vietnamese: Kinh tế Việt Nam 2013-Sau một
năm tái cấu trúc nền kinh tế, Mùa xuân 2013), Project under UNDP, 2013, Tri Thuc Publisher
House. 671p.
Vietnam Government [2012], “Report No. 336/BC-CP about the business result of state-owned
economic groups and corporation before 2011 – Recommendations and Solution for period 2012-
2015” (in Vietnamese: Báo cáo soos 336/BC-CP, Tình hình tài chính và hoạt động sản xuất kinh
doanh của các tập đoàn, tổng công ty nhà nước năm 2011 Phương hướng, nhiệm vụ, giải pháp giai
đoạn 2012 – 2015), National Report, Dated on 16/11/2012.
Vietnam Government [2014], “Vietnam’s socio-economic development strategy for the period of
2011-2020” (in Vietnamese: Chiến lược phát triển kinh tế xã hội Việt Nam giai đoạn 2011-2020),
Unofficial Translation, Available at :www.economica.vn
Vietnam Government [2014], Decree No. 69/2014/NĐ-CP: State Owned Economic group and State
Owned Corporation, (in Vietnamese: Nghị định số 69/2014/NĐ-CP về tập đoàn kinh tế nhà nước
và tổng công ty nhà nước), Dated on 15 July 2014.
Vietnam National Assembly, [2003], Law No 03/2003/QH11: Accounting Law date 17th June 2003.
Vietnamese National Assembly [2014], Law on Enterprise No. 68/2014/QH13, (in Vietnamese: Luật
Doanh Nghiệp số 68/2014/QH13), Dated on 26/11/2014
151
Vietnamese National Assembly [2015], Accounting Law No. 88/2015/QH13, (in Vietnamese: Luật kế
toán số 88/2015/QH13), Dated on 20/11/2015
Vu, K. B. A. H.[2012], “Determinants of Voluntary Disclosure for Vietnamese Listed Firms”,
Doctoral thesis, CurtinUniversity, School of Accounting, June 2012.
Vu, Q. N. [2002], “The State-Owned Enterprise Reform in Vietnam: Process and Achievements”,
ISEAS Visiting Research, series No. 4 (2002), Institute of Southeast Asian Studies, June-August
2002, available at: http://www.iseas.edu.sg/pub.html
Vu, T. M.,Yamada, H. and Otsuki, T. [2014], “The rise and fall of multinational enterprises in
Vietnam:survival analysis using census data during 2000-2011”, OSIPP Discussion Paper: DP-
2014-E-001
Vo, V. N. and Le, H. P. [2011], “Convergence between Vietnamese and International Accounting
Standards: The current situation, causes and oriented development”, (in Vietnamese: Hội tụ chuẩn
mực kế toán Việt Nam và Quốc tế: Thực trạng, nguyên nhân và định hướng phát triển), Vietnam
Auditing Review, Vol. 12, 2011.
Vu, X. T. [2007], “The drawbacks of Accounting practice in Vietnamese enterprises and
recommendations”, (in Vietnamese: Những bất cập trong công tác kế toán doanh nghiệp ở Việt
Nam hiện nay và giải pháp khắc phục), Vietnam Economic and Management Review, Vol. 6
(9+10/2007), pp. 54-57, 72.
Vu, X. T., [2011], “Review Accounting law 2003” (in Vietnamese: Báo cáo ra soát luật kế toán 2003),
Working paper under government project for renovation of legal framework, VFAM, 2011.
Walker, R.G.[1976], “An Evaluation of the Information Conveyed by Consolidated Statements”, Abacus,
Vol.12, No.2, pp.77-115.
Walker, R.G. [1978a], Consolidated Statements: A History and Analysis, Arno Press, 410p.
Walker, R.G.[1978b], “International Accounting Compromises: The Case of Consolidation Accounting”,
Abacus, Vol. 14, No. 2, pp.97-111.
Walker, R. G. and Mack, J. [1998], “The Influence of Regulation on the Publication of Consolidated
Statement”, Abacus, Vol. 34, No. 1 (1998), pp.48-73.
Willey, J.[2011], IFRS-Practical Implementation Guide and Workbook, Second Edition.
Williams, B., Brown, T., and Onsman, A.[2010], “Exploratory factor analysis: A five-step guide for
novices”Australasian Journal of Paramedicine, Vol. 8, issue 3, 2010, Retrieved from
http://ro.ecu.edu.au/jephc/vol8/iss3/1.
Williamson, J. G. [1996], “Globalization, Convergence and History”, The Journal of Economic
History, Vol. 56, Issue 2, Paper presented at the Fifty –Fifth Annual Meeting of the Economic
History Association, pp. 277-306. Available at: http://links.jstor.org/sici?sici=0022-
0507%28199606%2956%3A2%3c277%3AGCAH%3E2.0.CO%3B2-T
Whittred, G. [1986], “The Evolution of Consolidated Financial Reporting in Australia”, Abacus, Vol.22,
No.2, pp. 103-120.
Whittred, G. [1987], “The derived demand for consolidated financial reporting”, Journal of
accounting and economics, Vol. 9 (1987), pp. 259-285. ISSN 0165-4101
Whittred, G. [1988], The Evolution of Consolidated Financial Reporting in Australia: An Evaluation of an
Alternative Hypothesis, New York: Garland Publishing, 183p.
World Bank and Donor Working Group.[2012], Market Economic for a middle – income
Vietnam.Vietnam Development report-a joint Donor report to the Vietnam Consultative Group
Meeting. December 06, 2011. Vietnam Development report 2012. Available at:
www.economica.vn/ChangePages.aspx?...A18N26398606375120&c...
152
Yang, D. C. and Nguyen, A. T.[2003].“The enterprise accounting system of Vietnam and United
States generally accepted accounting principles: A comparison”, Advances in International
Accounting, Vol. 16, pp. 175-204.
Yong, A. G. and Pearce, A.[2013].“A beginner’s Guide to Factor Analysis: Focusing on Exploratory
Factor Analysis”, Tutorials in Quantitative Methods for Psychology. 2013. Vol. 9 (2). pp. 79-94.
Yoshio, A. [1978], “A Brief Survey of Actual Events concerning Consolidated Accounting in the United
States”, Sangyo Keiri (Industrial Accounting), Vol.38, No.3, pp.48-54 (in Japanese)
Young, S. D. [1999], “From plan to market: financial statements and economic transition in the East German
enterprise”, The European Accounting Review, 1999. Vol. 8:1, pp. 157-189
Zarzeski, M. T. [1996], “Spontaneous Harmonization Effects of Culture and Market Forces on
Accounting Disclosure Practices”, Accounting Horizons, Vol. 10, No. 1, March 1996, pp. 18-37.
Zehri, C. and Abdelbaki, A.[2013], “Does adoption of international accounting standards promote
economic growth in developing countries?”, International open journal of Economic, Vol.1, No.
1, July 2013, pp. 1-13, available at http://acascipub.com/Journals.php.
Zimmermann, J., Kilian, J. and Schymczyk, J. [2010], “Six country cases of transforming regulatory
landscape”, Translate Working papers No. 119, Bremen, 2010.
Zimmermann, J. and Werner, J. R. [2013], Regulating Capitalism? The Evolution of Transnational
Accounting Governance, Palgrave Macmillan.
Zhang, H. and Liu, X. [2010], “On the Construction of China’s Accounting Standard System with
International Convergence in Accounting Standards”, International Journal of Business and
Management. Vol. 5, No. 4; April 2010, pp. 200-203, Available at www.ccsenet.org/ijbm.
Website:
http://www.chinhphu.vn
http://www.cophieu68.com
http://www.gso.gov.vn
http://www.vaa.net.vn
http://www.vacpa.org.vn
153
APPENDIX
Acc.for State.organization
Acc .regulation:
private Stare (1996)-DecisionNo.1999 Decree
MOF (1988) organi- Acc.for
VACPA
(1945) Acc. Policyfor
Accounting practitioners
Guide
State *Sate-owner enterprises(SOE) *Sate-owner enterprises(SOE) *SOEs; * SMEs;* foreigndirect investmententerprises docu-
Enterprises enterprises *Privateenterprises; *SmallandMediumenterprise(SMEs) *securities Investment Fund;
Public ments
Ex; *Non-stateBusiness *AgriculturalCooperative; *Non-state firmsineducation andhospitalsector;
organizations Industrial; *Cooperative * Constructibleenterprise; * SocialInsuranceOrganization;
construction *Ownerbusiness * Satecorporationand Investmentcapital
154
ANNEX 2: The theory of consolidation
Concept of group
Legal extension Single Single economic Single economic
of the parent economic reporting unit reporting unit
company reporting unit
Primary users
Shareholders of Stakeholders of Parent company Parent company
the parent the whole group
company
Method
Proportional Full Full consolidation Full consolidation
method consolidation under “purchase” under “purchase”
under method method
“acquisition”
method
Recognition of identifiable assets and liabilities
Only parent’s 100% of the Only parent’s share 100% of the fair
share fair value fair value fair value acquired value acquired
acquired acquired
Measurement of Non-controlling interests
NA Fair value basis Book value basis Fair value basis
Disclosure of Non-controlling interests
NA Shareholders’ Liability Quasi-liability/
equity shareholders’
equity
Intercompany transaction adjustments
Partially Eliminated in Eliminated in full Eliminated in full
eliminated full (different impact of (different impact of
upstream/ upstream/
downstream downstream
transaction on transaction on
minority interests) minority interests)
Source: IASB [2006]; Gardini and Grossi [2014], p.323
155
ANNEX 3: Non-convergence area on consolidated accounting between VAS and IFRS
Non-convergence area
Criteria
IFRS 3(revised 2008), IFRS 10 (2012) VAS 25(2003), VAS 11 (2005)
Objective and Improve the relevance, reliability and To prescribe the accounting policies and
scope comparability of information on the financial procedures in relation to business
statements in a business combination combinations
Establish principles and requirements for how
acquirer
Acquisition Requires recognizing and measuring the Require measuring the cost of business
method identifiable assets acquired, liabilities assumed, combination and allocating this cost,
non-controlling interest in the acquire and at the acquisition date, to the assets
goodwill or gain from a bargain purchase acquired and liabilities and contingent
liabilities assumed.
Measurement The investment in each subsidiary is measured at Using the cost method to carrying
fair value amount of the investment
Consolidation Mention to combine or eliminate the cash flow of No mention to combine cash flow of the
Procedure the parent and its subsidiaries, respectively parent and its subsidiaries
Potential Regulate for the potential voting or other derivative Present on the regulation under
voting rights containing potential voting rights exist the rate of accounting standards
profit or loss and changes in equity allocated to the
parent and non-controlling interest in CFSs
156
ANNEX 5: List of Big state –owned economic groups in Vietnam (update to August 2016)
No Name in English Vietnamese name Time of establishment
1 Vietnam Posts and Telecommunications Tập đoàn Bưu chính Viễn thông Việt Established in 2005
Group (VNPT) Nam(VNPT),
(Chartered capital: 72,237 billion VND)
2 Vietnam National Coal - Mineral Tập đoàn Công nghiệp Than - Khoáng Decision No 563/QĐ-TTg date
Industries Group- Vinacomin sản Việt Nam(Vinacomin), 10/10/1994 and Decision No
(Chartered capital: 14,794 billion VND) 345/2005/QĐ-TTg date 26/12/2005
3 Baoviet Holdings Tập đoàn Tài chính-Bảo hiểm Bảo Decision No 310/2005/QĐ-TTg
(Chartered capital: 6,804 billion VND) Việt (Bảo Việt), date 28/11/2005
4 The Vietnam National Textile and Tập đoàn Dệt May Việt Nam Decision No 314/2005/QĐ-TTg and
Garment Group (Vinatex), (Vinatex) Decision No 316/2005/QĐ-TTg
(Chartered capital: 3,400 billion VND) date 2/12/2005
5 Vietnam Rubber Group (VRG) Tập đoàn Công nghiệp Cao su Việt Decision No 248/2006/QĐ-TTg
(Chartered capital: 18,574 billion VND) Nam (VRG), ngày 30/10/2006
6 Vietnam Electricity (EVN) Tập đoàn Điện lực Việt Nam (EVN), Decision No 147/2006/QĐ-TTg date
(Chartered capital: 110,000 billion VND) 22/6/2006.
7 VIETNAM OIL AND GAS Tập đoàn Dầu khí Quốc gia Việt Nam Decision No 198/2006/QĐ-TTg and
GROUP (PVN) (PetroVietnam), Decision No 199/2006/QĐ-TTg date
(Chartered capital: 177,628 billion VND) 29/8/2006
8 Viettel Group(Viettel) Tập đoàn Viễn thông Quân đội Decision No 2078/QĐ-TTg date
(Chartered capital: 50,000 billion VND) 14/12/200
9 Vietnam National Chemical Group Tập đoàn Công nghiệp Hóa chất Việt Decision No 2179/QĐ-TTg date
(Vinachem) Nam 2009 23/12/2009.
(Chartered capital: 8,000 billion VND)
10 Vietnam National Petroleum Group Tập đoàn Xăng dầu Việt Nam Decision No 828/QĐ-TTg date
(Petrolimex) 31/5/2011
(Chartered capital: 10,700 billion VND)
Three entities were established as group model (before 10/2013) but then they have transformed to holdingor corporation model
11 Housing and Urban Development Tập đoàn phát triển nhà và đô thị Việt Decision No 54/QĐ-TTg date
Holdings. (HUD) Nam 12/1/2010
12 Song Da corporation (VNIC, Song Da) Tổng công ty xây dựng Sông Đà (Tập Decision No 52/QĐ-TTg date 12/
đoàn Công nghiệp Xây dựng Việt 01/2010,
Nam, Sông Đà)
13 Shipbuilding Industry Corporation Tổng công Công Nghiệp tàu thủy Established 2006. Revised 2013 to
(2013)- tiền thân là Tập đoàn Công shipbuilding industry corporation by
nghiệp Tàu thủy Việt Nam (vinashin) Decision No 3287/QĐ-BGTVT date
21/10/2013
157
ANNEX 6: List of Economic Groups in Research Sample (interviewees)
No Name in English Vietnamese name Address
1 Garment 10 Corporation –Joint Tỏng công ty May 10- 765 Nguyen Van Linh street, Sai
Stock Company Công ty Cổ phần Dong town, Long Bien district,
Hanoi city, Vietnam
2 Hoa Phat Group, (HPG Group) Công ty cổ phần tập 39 Nguyen Dinh Chieu street, Hai
đoàn Hòa Phát Ba Trung district, Hanoi city,
Vietnam.
3 Lilama Corporation (Vietnam Tổng công ty lắp máy 124 Minh Khai street, Hai Ba Trung
Machinery Installation Việt Nam district, Hanoi city, Vietnam
Corporation)
4 Hanoi Construction Corporation Tổng công ty xây 57 Quang Trung street, Hoan Kiếm
(HANCORP) dựng Hà Nội district, Hanoi city, Vietnam.
5 Southern Vietnam Food Tổng công ty lương 6 Ngo Quyen street, Hoan Kiem
Corporation thực miền Bắc district, Hanoi city, Vietnam
(VINA FOOD)
6 Vietnam airline Corporation Tổng côtng ty hàng 200 Nguyen Son street, Bo De ward,
(VN Airline) không Việt Nam Long Bien district, Hanoi city,
Vietnam.
7 VIETNAM OIL AND GAS Tập đoàn dầu khí Việt 18 Lang Ha street, Dong Da district,
GROUP (PVN- PetroVietnam Nam Hanoi city, Vietnam
group)
8 Hoàng Hà Group Công ty Cổ Phần Tập No. 2, New urban area Dai Kim, Dai
đoàn Hoàng Hà Kim town, Hoang Mai district,
Hanoi city, Vietnam.
9 Duc Giang Corporation Công ty Cổ phần tập 59 Đức Giang street, Long Biên
(DUGARCO) đoàn may Đức Giang district, Hanoi city, Vietnam
10 Vietnam National Petroleum Tập đoàn xăng dầu No.1 Kham Thien street, Dong Da
Group (Petrolimex) Việt Nam district, Hanoi city, Vietnam
11 FPT Corporation Tập đoàn FPT Cau Giay Building, Duy Tan street,
Dich Vong Hau ward, Cau Giay
district, Hanoi, Vietnam
12 Mobifone Viet Nam Tập đoàn viễn thông 105 street, Dong Da district, Hanoi
Mobifone city, Vietnam
13 Thien Viet securities joint stock Công ty Cổ phần 22 Lang Ha street, Dong Da district,
company chứng khoán Thiên Hanoi city, Vietnam
Việt
14 Vietnam national coal-mineral Tập đoàn than khoáng 226 Le Duan street, Dong Da
industries holding corporation sản Việt Nam (TKV- district, Hanoi city, Vietnam.
limited (Vinacomin) Vinacomin)
15 Peacesoft-group Vietnam Công ty Peacesoft 18 Tam Trinh street, Hai Ba Trung
Việt Nam district, Hanoi city, Vietnam
158
ANNEX 7: List of Interviewees
No Name in English Current Address/phone number
Occupation
1 Nguyen Viet Loi Researcher 173 Trung Kinh Ha Noi-0913583609
2 Pham Thi Hien Auditor To Hieu-Thuong Tin-Hanoi
3 Nguyen Ngoc Khue Auditor CPA course, 2015, in Ha Noi
159
30 Nguyen Tra Ngoc Vy Lecturer 262 Dien Hong, Quy Nhon, Binh Dinh, VN
31 Doan Thi Dung Auditor P903-madarin,Trung Hoa, Cau Giay, Hanoi
32 Nguyen Thi Van Consultant Hanoi
33 Ho Quang Hai Auditor Ho Chi Minh
34 Nguyen Cam Chi Auditor 12 Tran Cao Van, Ha Noi
35 Nguyen Thi Thanh Huong Auditor CPA course, 6/2015, Hanoi
36 Tran Tuan Anh Auditor Thai Ha, Dong Da, Hanoi
37 Nguyen Huong Giang Creditor 24/9 Thanh Binh, Dong Da, Hanoi
38 Nguyen Thu Ha Auditor Pham Huu Dieu, Le Chan, Hai Phong
39 Nguyen Thu Phuong Creditor VP Bank
40 Le Thi Huong Giang Auditor Hai Phong
41 Tran Thi Hong Van lecturer Ho Chi Minh city, Vietnam
42 Phan Thanh Long Auditor ACPA, Hanoi, Vietnam
43 Tran The Nu lecturer Hanoi
44 Nguyen Thi Phuong Dung lecturer Hanoi
45 Hoang Viet Huong Consultant Hanoi
46 Hoang Nhat Thanh Consultant Long Bien, Hanoi
47 Le Van Lien lecturer Hanoi
48 Tran Quang Trung lecturer Hanoi
48 Truong Thi Thuy lecturer Hanoi
50 Lai Thuong Thao lecturer Hanoi
51 Mai Huu Tho Consultant Hanoi
52 Nguyen Thi Thuy lecturer Hanoi
53 Bach Hong Vy Consultant Private Accounting Service
54 Nguyen Dinh Huu lecturer Finance University, Hanoi
55 Nguyen Thi Lan Phuc lecturer Hanoi
56 Le Thi Kim Son lecturer National University of Agriculture
57 Le Thi Tuyet Nhung Policy maker DAP, MOF
58 Ha Thi Ngoc Ha Policy maker DAP, MOF
59 Trinh Duc Vinh Policy maker DAP, MOF
60 Nguyen Trong Ha Chief Accountant 765 Nguyen Van Linh street, Sai Dong
town, Long Bien district, Hanoi city,
Vietnam
61 Hoang Thi Thanh Huong Chief Accountant 39 Nguyen Dinh Chieu street, Hai Ba Trung
district, Hanoi city, Vietnam.
62 To Phi Son Accounting staff 124 Minh Khai street, Hai Ba Trung district,
Hanoi city, Vietnam
63 Duong Ngoc Quang Chief Accountant 57 Quang Trung street, Hoan Kiếm district,
Hanoi city, Vietnam.
160
64 Hoang Thanh Loan Chief Accountant 6 Ngo Quyen street, Hoan Kiem district,
Hanoi city, Vietnam
65 Mai Huu Tho Leader of executive 200 Nguyen Son street, Bo De ward, Long
board Bien district, Hanoi city, Vietnam.
66 Tran Thi Mai Trang Accounting staff 18 Lang Ha street, Dong Da district, Hanoi
city, Vietnam
67 Doan Thi Dung Leader of executive No. 2, New urban area Dai Kim, Dai Kim
board town, Hoang Mai district, Hanoi city,
Vietnam.
68 Nguyen Thi Van Oanh Accounting staff 59 Đức Giang street, Long Biên district,
anoi city, Vietnam
69 Ngo Kim Huyen Accounting staff No.1 Kham Thien street, Dong Da district,
Hanoi city, Vietnam
70 FPT Corporation Accounting staff Cau Giay Building, Duy Tan street, Dich
Vong Hau ward, Cau Giay district, Hanoi,
Vietnam
71 Tran Thi Nhi Accounting staff 105 street, Dong Da district, Hanoi city,
Vietnam
72 Le Quang Tien Accounting staff 22 Lang Ha street, Dong Da district, Hanoi
city, Vietnam
73 Vina comin Accounting staff 226 Le Duan street, Dong Da district, Hanoi
city, Vietnam.
74 Nguyen Ngan Huong Accounting staff 18 Tam Trinh street, Hai Ba Trung district,
Hanoi city, Vietnam
161
ANNEX 8: Summary Results of Test Normality, Validity and Reliability(for independent variable : occupation and experience)
Note: mean test α = 0.05; (+): higher than α; (-): smaller than α; =: equal 0.05; [*]:Result has got notation of “count less than 5”; #: No test because of
limited number variable respectively
Non-
ANOVA
parameter
One way Two way Kruskal-
Chi- Kendall's
No Variables Somers'd Gamma Post Hoc Between-Subjects Effects Wallis
square tau-b
Test
Homogeneity Anova Tukey Tukey Levene's Corrected Dependent
Intercept
HSD HSDa,b Model Variable
Occupation
I
1.1 Having CPA -[*] - - - - - - + - - + + -
Level of
1.2 knowledge -[*] + + + - + + + - + + + -
Skill of Acc.
1.3 technique
(1) Obstacle or not -[*] - - - - - + + - + + + -
(2) Poor knowledge + + + + - + + + - + + + +
(3) Don’t identify + + + + - + + + - + + + +
(4) Ability synthesis + + + + - + + + - + + + +
1.4 Legal framework
(1) Obstacle or not -[*] + + + - - + + - - + + -
(2) No many choice -[*] - - - - - # # - + + + -
(3) Lack of guidance + + + + - + # # - + + + +
(4) Not reliability + - - - - + # # - + + + +
1.4.1 Law
(1) Fullness = + + + - - # # - + + + +
(2) Matching + + + + - + # # - + + + +
(3) Clearness + - - - - + # # - + + + +
162
(4) Inconsistency -[*] - - - - - - - + + -
1.4.2 VAS -
(1) Fullness + - - - - - - + + + -
(2) Matching -[*] + + + - - - - + + -
(3) Clearness + - - - - + - + + + +
(4) Inconsistency -[*] - - - - - - + + + +
1.4.3 Acc. Policy
(1) Fullness + + + + - + - + + + +
(2) Matching + - - - - + - + + + +
(3) Clearness + - - - - + - + + + +
(4) Inconsistency + + + + - + - + + + +
1.4.4. Acc. Guidance
(1) Fullness + - - - + + - + + + +
(2) Matching + + + + - + + + + + +
(3) Clearness + + + + - + - + + + +
(4) Inconsistency -[*] + + + - - - + + + -
Manager’s
1.5 knowledge
(1) Obstacle or not + + + + - + + + - + + + +
(2) Which point… - + + + - + - + + + +
Business
1.6 characteristics
(1) Obstacle or not -[*] + + + - - + + - - + + +
(2) Matter of facility -[*] - - - - - - + - - +
1.7 Internal regulation
(1) Obstacle or not -[*] - - - - - + + - - + + -
(2) Which policy + + + + - + + + - + + + +
163
(3) Which point + + + + - - # # - - + = -
1.8 Acc. technique
(1) Obstacle or not -[*] - - - - - + + - - + + -
(2) Simple subtotal + + + + - + # # - + + + -
Lack of
(3) adjustment GW + + + + - + # # - + - +
Lack of
(4) adjustment profit + + + + - + # # - + + +
Lack of
adjustment
(5) current value + + + + - + # # - + + +
Lack of
adjustment
(6) dividend -[*] + + + + - # # - + - + -
Reason of
1.9 Preparing CFSs + + + + + + + + + + + + +
Identify Parent
1.10 Co. -[*] + + + - + + + - + + - +
1.11 CFS & GFS
(1) Difference or not + + + + - + + + +
Which points
(2) differ + + + + + + + + +
1.12 Submit CFS +
(1) Tax office -[*] + + + - - + + +
(2) Security office -[*] + + + - - + + -
(3) Statistic office + + + + - + + + +
(4) Authority + + + + - + + + -
(5) Manager - + + + - - + + +
(6) Creditor + + + + - + + + -
(7) Investor + + + + - + + + +
(8) Auditor + + + + - + + + +
164
(9) Financial institute + + + + - + + + +
(10) MOF + + + + - + + + +
Ministry of direct
(11) management -[*] - - - - - + + -
1.13. Internal regulation
(1) Necessary or not + + + + - + + + +
(2) Format + + + + - + + + +
Timeline of
(3) submit + - - - - + + + +
(4) Specific content + + + + - + + + +
Recognize
1.14 Investment
1.14.1 In subsidiary
Acc.measurement
on the date of
(1) acquisition -[*] + + + - - + + -
Acc. Method on
(2) the date of CFS -[*] + + + - + + + +
Acc. Entry on the
date of
(3) acquisition -[*] - - - - - + + +
In associates or
jointly control
1.14.2 entities
Acc.measurement
on the date of
(1) acquisition + + + + - + + + -
Acc. Method on
(2) the date of CFS -[*] + + + - - + + +
Acc. Entry on the
date of
(3) acquisition -[*] + + + - + + + +
Recognize
1.15 Goodwill
165
How disclose on
the date of
(1) Acquisition -[*] - - - - - + + -
How account
after the date of
(2) acquisition + + + + - + + + +
(3) How entry - + + + - - + + +
1.16 NCI
How account on
the date of
(1) Acquisition -[*] - - - - - + + -
How account on
(2) the date of CFS + + + + - + + +
(3) How disclose -[*] + + + - + + +
Experience
II
Level of
2.1 knowledge + + + + + + # # +
Skill of Acc.
2.2 technique
(1) Obstacle or not + - - - - + # # +
(2) Poor knowledge + + + + - + # # +
(3) Don’t identify + + + + - + # # +
(4) Ability synthesis + + + + - + # # +
2.3 Legal framework
(1) Obstacle or not + + + + - + # # +
(2) No many choice -[*] - - - - - # # -
(3) Lack of guidance + + + + + + # # +
(4) Not reliability -[*] - - - - + # # -
2.3.1 Law
(1) Fullness + + + + + + # # +
166
(2) Matching + - - - - + # # +
(3) Clearness + + + + - + # # +
(4) Inconsistency + + + + + + # # +
2.3.2 VAS
(1) Fullness -[*] - - - + + # # +
(2) Matching -[*] - - - + - # # -
(3) Clearness + + + + + + # # +
(4) Inconsistency + + + + - + # # +
2.3.3 Acc. Policy
(1) Fullness + - - - + + # # +
(2) Matching + - - - - + # # +
(3) Clearness + + + + + + # # +
(4) Inconsistency + + + + - + # # +
2.3.4. Acc. Guidance
(1) Fullness + + + + + + # # +
(2) Matching + + + + + + # # +
(3) Clearness + + + + + + # # +
(4) Inconsistency + + + + - + # # +
Manager’s
2.4 knowledge
(1) Obstacle or not + + + + - + # # +
(2) Which point… + - - - + + # # +
Business
2.5 characteristics
(1) Obstacle or not + + + + - + # # +
(2) Matter of facility -[*] - - - + + # # +
2.6 Internal regulation
167
(1) Obstacle or not + + + + - + # # +
(2) Which policy + + + + + + # # +
(3) Which point + + + + + + # # +
2.7 Acc. technique
(1) Obstacle or not + - - - - + # # +
(2) Simple subtotal + + + + + + # # +
Lack of
(3) adjustment GW -[*] - - - - - # # -
Lack of
(4) adjustment profit + - - - + + # # +
Lack of
adjustment
(5) current value + - - - - + # # +
Lack of
adjustment
(6) dividend -[*] - - - - - # # -
Reason of
2.8 Preparing CFSs + + + + - + # # +
Identify Parent
2.9 Co. + + + + + + # # +
2.10 CFS & GFS
(1) Difference or not + + + + + + # # +
Which points
(2) differ -[*] + + + + - # # +
2.11 Submit CFS
(1) Tax office + + + + - + # # +
(2) Security office + + + + - + # # +
(3) Statistic office + + + + - + # # +
(4) Authority + + + + - - # # +
(5) Manager + + + + - - # # +
(6) Creditor + - - - - + # # +
168
(7) Investor + + + + - + # # +
(8) Auditor -[*] - - - - + # # -
(9) Financial institute -[*] - - - - + # # -
(10) MOF + + + + - + # # +
Ministry of direct
(11) management -[*] - - - - - # # -
2.12. Internal regulation
(1) Necessary or not + + + + + + # # +
(2) Format -[*] - - - - + # # +
Timeline of
(3) submit + - - - - + # # +
(4) Specific content + - - - - + # # +
Recognize
2.13 Investment
2.13.1 In subsidiary
Acc.measurement
on the date of
(1) acquisition + + + + - + # # +
Acc. Method on
(2) the date of CFS + + + + + + # # +
Acc. Entry on the
date of
(3) acquisition + - - - + + # # +
In associates or
jointly control
2.13.2 entities
Acc.measurement
on the date of
(1) acquisition + + + + + + # # +
Acc. Method on
(2) the date of CFS + + + + + + # # +
Acc. Entry on the
(3) date of + - - - + + # # +
169
acquisition
Recognize
2.14 Goodwill
How disclose on
the date of
(1) Acquisition + + + + + + # # +
How account
after the date of
(2) acquisition + + + + + + # # +
(3) How entry + + + + + + # # +
2.15 NCI
How account on
the date of
(1) Acquisition + + + + + + # # +
How account on
(2) the date of CFS + + + + + + # # +
(3) How disclose + + + + + + # # +
170
ANNEX 9: Questionnaire - Type 1
Câu 2-Q2: Công việc chính của Ông/Bà liên quan đến kế toán là gì/What is your work in the below
categories
2.1. Kiểm toán viên-CPA/Auditor 2.2. Nhà nghiên cứu/researchers
2.3. Giảng viên kế toán/Lecturers 2.4. Nhà đầu tư/investors:
2.5. Nhân viên tín dụng NH/ creditor 2.6. Khác/Others: (detail……………………….).
…………………………………………………………………………………………………….
Câu 3- Q3. Ông/Bà biết gì về báo cáo tài chính hợp nhất (BCTCHN) không?/Have you ever known
about consolidated financial statement?
3.1. Không/No
-Ông/bà có muốn tìm hiểu hay quan tâm đến không? Do you want to know?
3.1.1. Không quan tâm/No interested
3.1.2. Có/yes. Tại sao/Why?.
3.1.2.1. Tìm cơ hội tốt hơn trong công việc/create the better change or position
3.1.2.2. Muốn hiểu biết thêm/ break the knowledge
3.1.2.3. Yêu cầu của kế toán trong tương lai/Requirement of accountant in future
3.1.2.4. Khác/ Others:……………….………………………….
3.2. Có/Yes
-Theo Ông/bà, BCTC tổng hợp và BCTC HN có khác nhau không? In your view, have got
any difference between CFSs and GFS?
3.2.1. Không / No
3.2.2. Có/yes. Khác ở điểm nào? What are the differences?
Điểm khác biệt BCTCchung/general financial reports BCTCHN/CFSs
31.2.2.1.HÌnh thức/Format ……………..………….. …………
31.2.2.2. Đơn vị áp dụng?Applicants ………………………… .……
31.2.2.3.Nội dung/Contents ………………………… …….…
31.2.2.4.Khác/Others………… ………………………… ….……
-Theo Ông bà, ai/đối tượng nào quan tâm đến BCTC tổng hợp hay BCTCHN của TCT
hoặc tập đoàn?In your opinion, who or what organization interest in CFSs of corporation?
3.2.4. Cơ quan thuế? Taxation office 3.2.9. Hội đồng quản trị/ Mmanagers
3.2.5. Cơ quan chứng khoán/Security Office 3.2.10. Ngân hàng-Bank/Creditors
3.2.6. Cơ quan thống kê/Statistic Office 3.2.11. Nhà đầu tư, cổ đông? Investors/Shareholders
3.2.7. Cơ quan cấp phép KD? Authority Office 3.2.12. Đơn vị kiểm toán/Auditing Office
3.2.8. Sở tài chính/ Financial institutions 3.2.13. Bộ tài chính/MOF
3.2.14 Khác/Others: ……..……………..………. …………………………………………….
Câu 4-Q4: Theo Ông/bà hệ thống pháp lý liên quan đến BCTCHN hiện nay ở Việt Nam gồm những
gi? what does the legal framework of CFSs/GFSs in Vietnam include in the below categories?
4. 1. Luật kế toán 2003/Accounting law (2003)
4.2.Chuẩn mực kế toán Việt nam/ VASs;
4.2.1. Chuẩn mực kế toán Việt nam số 25/VAS 25
Note: Đánh dấu (x) vào câu trả lời được lựa chọn
9
Có thể không trả lời/don’t necessary answer.
171
4.2.2. Chuẩn mực kế toán Việt nam số 11/VAS11
4.2.3. Khác/Others: (detail………………………………..……)
………………..….. ……………………………..….. ……………………………..…..
4.3.Chế độ kế toán Việt Nam/ accouting policy
4.3. 1. Theo QĐ 15/2006/QD-BTC- Decision No 15/2006/QD-BTC
4.3. 2. Theo QĐ 48/2006/QD-BTC - apply QĐ 48/2006/QD-BTC
4.3. 3. Khác/Others: (detail……………………………………..……
…………………………………….……………………………………
4.4.Thông tư hướng dẫn kế toán/the circular of accounting
4.4.1. Theo 21/2006/TT-BTC - apply 21/2006/TT-BTC
4.4.2. Theo 161/2007/TT-BTC - apply 161/2007/TT-BTC
4.4.3. Khác/Others: (detail………………………………..……)
…………………………………….……………………………………
4.5.Khác/Others: (detail…………………………………………………….
…………………………………………………….……………………………………
…………………………………………………………………………………………………….
…………………………………………………………………………………………………….
Câu 5-Q5 Công việc của Ông/Bà từng có liên quan đến BCTC tổng hợp hay BCTCHNchưa?/Have
you ever worked relate to CFSs?
5.1. Không /No
5.2. Có/Yes
- Đó là công việc gì?What is the area relates to CFSs?
5.2.1. Kiểm toán /Audit
-Ông/bà đã làm kiểm toán bao lâu rồi? How long have you been an auditor?
5.2.1.1. Dưới 1 năm/under 1 year 5.2.1.2. Từ 1-> 2 năm/from 1-2 years
5.2.1.3. Từ 2-3 năm/ from 2-3 years 5.2.1.4. Từ 3-4 năm/from 3-4 years:
5.2.1.5. Từ 4-5 năm/ from 4-5 years 5.2.1.6. Trên 5 năm/Over 5 years: (detail…….).
-Ông/bà đã có chứng chỉ kiểm toán viên hành nghề chưa?Do you have certified public accountants (CPA)?
5.2.1.7. Không /No-
5.2.1.8. Có/Yes . Có từ bao lâu/How long did you get it?
5.2.1.8.1. Dưới 1 năm/under 1 year 5.2.1.82. Từ 1-> 2 năm/from 1-2 years
5.2.1.8.3. Từ 2-3 năm/ from 2-3 years 5.2.1.8.4. Từ 3-4 năm/from 3-4 years:
5.2.1.8.5. Từ 4-5 năm/ from 4-5 years 5.2.1.8.6. Trên 5 năm/Over 5 years: ……..
- Số lần Ông/ bà đã làm kiểm toán BCTCHN/chung cho TCT hay tập đoàn kinh tế Việt Nam là bao nhiêu?
How many times did you work as auditor relately to CFSs in Vietnam?
5.2.1.9. Chỉ 01 time/only 1 time 5.2.1.10. Từ 2->3 lần/from 2-3 times
5.2.1.11. Từ 3-5 lần/ from 3-5 times 5.2.1.12. Từ 5-7 lần/from 5-7 times
5.2.1.13. Từ 8-10 lần/ from 8-10 times 5.2.1.14. Trên 10 lần/Over 10 times: (detail…….).
5.2.3. Tư vấn/consultant
Ông/bà đã làm công việc này bao lâu rồi?How long have you been a consultant?
5.2.3.1. Từ 1-> 2 năm/from 1-2 years 5.2.3.2. Từ 3- dưới5 năm/from 3- under5 years:
5.2.3.3. Từ 5-10năm/ from 5-10years 5.2.3.4 Trên 10 năm/Over 10 years: (detail…….).
5.2.4. Chuyên gia về kế toán/ accounting professor
Ông/bà đã làm công việc này bao lâu rồi?How long have you been an accounting professor?
5.2.4.1. Từ 1-> 2 năm/from 1-2 years 5.2.4.2. Từ 3- dưới5 năm/from 3- under5 years:
5.2.4.3. Từ 5-10năm/ from 5-10years 5.2.4.4. Trên 10 năm/Over 10 years: (detail…….).
5.2.5. Khác/Others: (detail…………………………………………………….)
Câu 6- Q6.Theo Ông/bà, lý do chính hiện nay để các TCT/tập đoàn lập BCTC tổng hợp hay BCTC HN là gi?In
your opinion, what are the main reasons VNese organization of preparing the Financial Statements for whole corporation or
group?
172
6.1.Quy định của Pháp luật / the compulsory regulation
6.2. Yêu cầu của nhà đầu tư, ngân hàng/ requirement of investors or creditors
6.3. Yêu cầu quản lý trong TCT hay tập đoàn / give information for management
(BCTCHN cung cấp các thông tin TC mà BCTC riêng lẻ không cung cấp)
6.4. Cả 3 đáp án trên/ include three previous answers
6.5. Khác/others: (detail…………………………………………………….)
Câu 7-Q7: Theo ông/ bà, về phíaTCT/tập đoàn việc lập và trình bày BCTC tổng hợp hay BCTC HN
hiện nay đang thường vướng mắc ở những khâu nào? Following your experience what are the obstacles of
enterprises about preparing the CFSs/GFSs? (Có thể lựa chọn nhiều đáp án/ multi-choice answers)
7.1. Quản lý tổ chức nội bộ/internal-governance
7.1.1.Không có quy định thống nhất về lập BCTCHN/chung/no internal regulation for preparing CFSs/GFSs
7.1.2. Có quy định nhưng chưa phù hợp/inappropriate regulation forpreparing CFSs/GFSs
7.1.2. 1.Không rõ trách nhiệm của các bên/ the function of subsidiary companies is not clear
7.1.2.2. Không có mẫu biểu báo cáo/sổ/bảng thống nhất/no regulation in the form of
documents for collection or supplying information of making CFSs/GFSs
7.1.2.3.Nội dung thông tin được quy định không phù hợp/ Asymmetricregulatory content of
information to prepare CFSs/GFSs
Cụ thể/detail:
71.2.3.1.quy định về mua bán nội bộ/ regulation in inter-transaction of selling or buying
7.1.2.3.2.quy định về giao dịch cổ tức nội bộ/regulation in the profit of inter-transaction
7.1.2.3.3.quy định về xác định giá trị hiện tại của tài sản /regulation in access the current
valuation of assets
7.1.2.3.4.Khác/others…………
7.1.2.4.Khác/others………………………………………………….……
7.1.3. Liên kết giữa các đơn vị nội bộ chưa tốt/ the relationship among subsidiary companies is still
inappropriate:
7.1.4. Khác/Others: (detail…………………………………………………….)
7.2. Nội dung kỹ thuật nghiệp vụ/accounting technique
7.2. 1. Chủ yếu dừng lại ở cộng hợp và loại trừ đơn giản về giao dịch nội bộ/ Have got only
simple Subtotal/elimination entries for inter-transaction
7.2.2. Không có các bút toán điều chỉnh hợp lý về lợi thế thương mại/lack of adjustment
entries for goodwill
7.2.3. Không có các bút toán điều chỉnh lợi nhận bán hàng nội bộ / lack of adjustment
entries for the profit of inter-transaction of selling or buying
7.2.4. Không có các bút toán điều chỉnh giá trị hiện tại của vốn đầu tư/ lack of adjustment
entries for the access the current value of investment capital
7.2.5. Không có các bút toán điều chỉnh về giao dịch cổ tức nội bộ/ lack of adjustment
entries for the inter-transaction of dividends
10.2.6. Khác/Others: (detail…………………………………………………….
…………………………………………………….……………………………………
7.3. Kỹ năng của cán bộ nghiệp vụ/the skill of accounting staff in enterprises
7.3. 1. Cán bộ nghiệp vụ không có hoặc thiếu kiến thức về BCTCHN/ poor knowledge
about CFSs/GFSs
7.3.2. Không xác định được các bút toán điều chỉnh, hợp cộng hay loại trừ / are not able to
identify the area of Subtotal/elimination or adjustment entries
7.3.3. Không có khả năng tổng hợp thông tin / ability to synthesize the financial information
is not well
7.3.4. Khác/Others: (detail…………………………………………………….
…………………………………………………….……………………………………
7.4. Nhận biết của cán bộ quản lý về loại BC này/ the managers understand the function of CFSs/GFSs not well
7.4. 1. Đơn vị hoạt động tốt không cần BCTCtổng hợp hay BCTCHN / running business
well without the CFSs/GFSs
7.4.2. Quy mô của đơn vị không cần BCTCtổng hợp hay BCTCHN / the CFSs/GFSs
isn’t necessary applying in their business size
7.4.3. Khác/Others: (detail…………………………………………………….
…………………………………………………….……………………………………
7.5. Lựa chọn hệ thống chuẩn mực kế toán hay chế độ kế toán/ applying the accounting regulation system
173
7.5. 1. Không có nhiều lựa chọn-ngoài chuẩn mực kế toán VN/ Don’t have multi-choice
without VASs
7.5.2. Thiếu các hướng dẫn thực hiện chế độ áp dụng/ lack of guide documents for
implementation
7.5.3. Chưa có quy định trong luật cho nhiều nội dung phát sinh thực tế / the content of
Vietnamese regulation system still do not cover the practice situation that happens during
doing business.
(Ví dụ/for instance:……………………………………………..……….)
7.5.4. Khác/Others: (detail…………………………………………………….
…………………………………………………….……………………………………
7.6. Cơ sở vật chất, thiết bị hỗ trợ kế toán / the tool and infrastructure for accounting
7.6. 1. Thiết bị, cơ sở vật chất thủ công và lạc hậu / poor and drawback tool
7.6.2. Phần mềm hỗ trợ không phù hợp/inappropriate software
7.6.3. Khác/Others: (detail…………………………………………………….
…………………………………………………….……………………………………
Câu 8- Q8.Theo Ông/bà, tại các đơn vị Tổng công ty, tập đoàn kinh tế ở Việt Nam hiện nay có hiện
tượng: TCT/tập đoàn phải lập BCTCHN (xét theo đặc điểm về hợp nhất) để phản ánh thông tin tài
chính cho toàn bộ TCT hay tập đoàn nhưng lại lựa chọn BCTC tổng hợp để phản ánh không?/ In your
view, have got any Vietnamese corporation/economic groups which apply the GFS instead of CFSs for
presentation of financial statement for whole the corporation?
8.1. Không/No
8.2.Có/Yes.
Đề nghị cho biết vì sao/Why enterprises don’t chose CFSs? (Có thể lựa chọn nhiều đáp án/ multi-choice
answers)
8.2.1. BCTC HN đỏi hỏi chuyên môn sâu/ Need more specific knowledge in accounting
8.2.2. BCTC tổng hợp đơn giản hơn/ prepare GFSs is more simple than CFSs
8.2.3. Thiếu cán bộ đủ chuyên môn/ lack of academic accountants/staff
8.2.4. Có nhiều quy định khác nhau trong khung pháp lý/many different options in legal framework
8.2.5. Nhận thức của cán bộ quản lý/the limited knowledge of managers
8.2.6. Khác/others: (detail…………………………………………………….)
…………………………………….…………………………………………………….
Câu 9-Q9. Theo Ông/bà, chính sách hay quy định nội bộ về việc lập BCTC tổng hợp hay BCTC HN có
cần thiết lập không? Do you think the internal-regulations are necessary option of preparing CFSs in a
corporation or economic group?
9.1. Không/No
Vì sao/Why?: ………………………….…………………………..……)
9.2.Có/Yes.
Theo Ông/bà nên hình thành những quy đình gì?/What content should be in the internal
regulations?
Đơn vị áp dụng/Applying for area
Main regulations Tất cả đơn vị/ Đơn vị đặc thù/
All entities Separate subsidiaries
9.2.1. Mẫu biểu: Form of doucument s
9.2.2. Thời gian nộp/ Duration
Cụ thể/detail:………………………………….
9.2.3. Nội dung thông tin BC/ Contents of information
Cụ thể/detail:………………………………….
…………………………………………………..
…………………………………………………..
…………………………………………………..
9.2.4. Khác/Others:………………………………
…………………………………………………….. .
Câu 10-Q10: Ông/bà đánh giá thế nào về kiến thức nghiệp vụ liên quan đến việc lập và trình bày
BCTC của cán bộ nghiệp vụ tại các đơn vị TCT/tập đoàn kinh tế Việt Nam hiện nay? In your view,
which level is accountant’s knowledge about CFSs in the Vietnam economic group or corporation?
174
10.1.Không có chuyên môn/empty the specific knowledge
10.2. Chuyên môn thấp/low level knowledge
10.3. Chuyên môn tốt/good knowledge
10.4. Chuyên môn rất tốt/ very good knowledge
Câu 11-Q11: Theo Ông/bà, cán bộ nghiệp vụ có cần cập nhật kiến thức chuyên môn liên quan đến
việc lập và trình bày BCTCHN không? In your view, do need to update the specific knowledge about CFSs
for the accountant of corporation?
11.1. Không/No
Vì sao/Why?: ………………………….…………………………..……)
11.2.Có/Yes.
Nên cập nhật theo cách nào? Which way should be applied for upgrading?
11.2.1.Khuyến khích/ setting as the requirement option
11.2.2.Bắt buộc/ setting as the compulsory option
Cơ quan/đơn vị nào nên đóng vai trò cập nhật kiến thức cho cán bộ nghiệp vụ?
Which organization should play the role of training?
11.2.3. Hội nghề nghiệp độc lập/independent association of professional accountancy?
11.2.4. Hội kế toán Việt Nam/Vietnam Accounting and auditing Association
11.2.5. Đơn vị đào tạo của BTC/Academic institution of MOF
11.2.6. Các trường đại học chuyên ngành/Accounting University
11.2.7. Tất cả các phương án trên/includeall four previous answers
11.2.8. Khác/others: (detail…………………………………………………….)
Nội dung cập nhật nên ở mức nào?which level should be upgraded?
11.2.8. Bồi dưỡng nghiệp vụ/ specific training
11.2.9. Đào tạo ngắn hạn/ short training course
11.2.10. Đào tạo dài hạn/ specific traning program
11.2.11. Khác/others: (detail…………………………………………………….)
Câu 12-Q12: Theo Ông/bà hệ thống pháp lý về lập và trình bày BCTCtổng hợp hay BCTCHN hiện nay
ở Việt nam có hợp lý không? In your view, the Vietnamese accounting regulation system is appropriate
system for enterprises, isn’t it?
12.1.Có/yes
12.2. Không/No
Cụ thể là gì- Vì sao/What and Why area is inappropriate?:
12.2. 1. Luật kế toán 2003/Accounting law (2003)
Điểm chưa phù hợp/Content Lý do/reason
12.2. 1.1.Tính đầy đủ/Fullness …………………………
12.2. 1.2. Tính hợp lý/matching ……………………………
12.2. 1.3.Một số nội dung chưa cụ thể/ unclear in some detail …………………………………
regulation of law ………………………
12.2. 1.4.Còn tồn tại những nội dung không nhất quán với luật/quy ……………………………
định khác liên quan/inconsistentamongdifferentregulationsrespectively
……………………………
12.2. 1.5.Khác/others…………
12.2. 2. Chuẩn mực kế toán Việt nam/ VASs;
Điểm chưa phù hợp/Content Lý do/reason
12.2.2.1. Tính đầy đủ/Fullness …………………………
12.2.2.2. Tính hợp lý/matching ……………………………
12.2.2.3. Còn tồn tại những nội dung không nhất quán với …………………………………
luật/quy định khác liên quan/inconsistentamongdifferentregulations ………………………
respectively ……………………………
12.2.2.4.Khác/others……………………………… …………………………
……………………………………………
12.2. 3. Chế độ kế toán Việt Nam/ accouting policy
175
12.2.3.3. Còn tồn tại những nội dung không nhất quán với …………………………………
luật/quy định khác liên quan/inconsistentamongdifferentregulations ………………………
respectively ……………………………
12.2.3.4.Khác/others……………………………… ……………………………
……………………………………………
Câu 13-Q13. Theo Ông/bà, căn cứ vào quy định khung pháp lý của Việt Nam hiện nay thì công ty mẹ
là đơn vị phải lập BCTCHN được hiểu là đối tượng nào sau đây? In your opinion, how to identify the
parent company who must to prepare CFSs following the Vietnamese accounting regulation system?
13.1. Công ty mẹ trực tiếp/the parent company by direct control
(Công ty mẹ trực tiếp: công ty mẹ có quyền kiểm soát cao nhất)
13.2. Công ty mẹ trung gian/the parent company by indirect control
(Công ty mẹ trung gian: Công ty mẹ chịu sự kiểm soát của các công ty mẹ khác trong tập đoàn)
13.3. Cả hai đáp án trên/include both of previous answers
Câu 14-Q14. Theo Ông/bà, khi trình bày BCTCHN, lợi thế thương mại (LTTM) phát sinh từ hợp
nhất kinh doanh nên tính như thế nào? In your opinion, how account the goodwill to disclosure CFSs?
14.1. Không bao gồm LTTM của cổ đông thiểu số/don’t include the goodwill of non-control
shareholders
14.2. Bao gồm cả LTTM của cổ đông thiểu số/Include the goodwill of non-control shareholders
14.3. khác/other:…………………………..
- Theo Ông/bà, sau ghi nhận ban đầu, lợi thế thương mại đang được quy định xử lý như thế nào theo
quy định hiện hành của Việt Nam? In your opinion, how account the goodwill in the accounting regulation
system in Vietnam?
14.4. Phân bổ dần/amortization of historical cost
14.5. Đánh giá suy giảm/impairment loss
14.6.khác/other:…………………………..
- Theo ông/bà quy định như hiện tại hợp lý chưa? Do you think this is the appropriate regulation?
14.7. Có/yes
14.8. Không/no.
Vì sao/why?:………………………………………………………………………………..
…………………………………………………………………………….……………………………
……………………………………………….…………………………………………………………
……
Câu 15-Q15: Theo Ông/bà, chỉ tiêu lợi ích cổ đông thiểu số khi quyền kiểm soát được thiết lập nên được xác
định như thế nào? In your opinion, how is the non-controlling interest accounted on the date of acquisition?
15.1.Tài sản thuần theo giá trị hợp lý của đơn vị bị mua (không bao gồm LTTM khi đầu tư)/following the net value
of assets
15.2. Giá trị hợp lý(bao gồm LTTM khi đầu tư)/following the fair value of assets
15.3. Khác/others (cụ thể/detail): ……………………..……………………………
-Khi lập BCTC hợp nhất, theo ông/bà chỉ tiêu lợi ích cổ đông thiểu số nên được xác định theo
phương pháp nào? In your opinion, how should account the non-controlling interest on the date of preparing
CFSs?
176
15.4. Phương pháp chuẩn/ benchmark method
15.5. Phương pháp thay thế/allowable method
15.6. Khác/others (cụ thể/detail): ……………………..……………………………
-Khi trình bày Bảng cân đối kế toán hợp nhất, theo Ông/Bà, chỉ tiêu lợi ích cổ đông thiểu số
được trình bày như thế nào? In your opinion, how disclosure the non-controlling interest on CFSs?
15.7. Nơ phải trả/the liability
15.8. Vốn chủ sở hữu nhưng không tách biệt/ the equity
15.9. Vốn chủ sở hữu nhưng tách biệt/ separate criteria in the equity of the parent entity
15.10. Một chỉ tiêu riêng nằm giữa vốn chủ sở hữu và nợ phải trả/separatecriteriaisputbetweentheliabilityandequity
15.11. Khác/others(cụ thể/detail): ……………………..……………………………
Câu 16-Q16: Theo Ông/bà, khi lập BCTCHN các nội dung nào sau đây cần được bổ sung, loại bỏ
hay thay đổi trong khung pháp lý về kế toán của Việt Nam hiện nay? In your view, which content in the
below categories should be added, rejected, or renewed in the current Vietnamese accounting legal framework?
Nội dung/Contents Bổ sung Loại bỏ Thay
đổi
16.1. loại trừ các giao dịch nội bộ giữa công ty con với công ty liên
doanh, liên kết
16.2.loại trừ các giao dịch nội bộ giữa công ty con với công ty con
khác
16.3.xử lý giao dịch cổ phiếu ưu đãi của công ty con
16.4. Khoản lỗ vượt trội phần vốn của cổ đông thiểu số trong công ty
con
16.5. các giao dịch với cổ đông thiểu số mà không làm mất quyền
kiểm soát của công ty mẹ
16.6.loại trừ đối với các khoản dự phòng
16.7.Khác/others (cụ thể/detail):
……………………..……………………………
Câu 17-Q17: Theo Ông/bà có nên thay đổi hệ thống pháp lý hiện tại về vấn đề BCTC HN ở Việt
Nam hay không? Do you think the current Vietnamese regulation for CFSs need to renew?
17.1. Không/No. Vì sao/why?
17.1.1. Có thể lập BCTC tổng hợp thay cho BCTC hợp nhất/Preparing general financial
statements instead of CFSs
17.1.2. Nhu cầu thông tin tài chinh cho toàn bộ TCT hay tập đoàn không nhiều ở Việt
Nam/ the demand of financial information of the whole corporation or group is limited
17.1.3. Khác/others: (detail…………………………………………………….)
………………………………………………….………………………………………
………………………………………………….………………………………………
17.2. Có/yes.Vậy nên thay đổi theo hướng nào/How do change or renew?
17.2.1. Áp dụng trực tiếp theo chuẩn mực kế toán quốc tế tương ứng/Apply directly the
IASs/IFRS about CFSs?
17.2.2. Bổ sung thêm văn bản quy định tương ứng cho những nội dung còn thiếu về
BCTC HN/ Create extra regulations for the existing regulation system in the consolidated area.
Cụ thể, đó là gi/ Please make detail, what need to create?
………………………………………… ………………………….
………………………………………… ………………….……….
………………………………………… …………….
17.2.3. Xây dựng lại thành một chuẩn mực BCTCHN riêng biệt/ Renew the existing
regulation system to separate standard of consolidated financial statement gradually
following international accounting standard.
17.2.4. Khác/others: (detail…………………………………………………….)
………………………………………………….………………………………………
………………………………………………….………………………………………
177
Câu 19-Q19: Ông/bà có ủng hộ việc xây dựng hệ thống chuẩn mực kế toán riêng biệt cho những
đơn vị là TCT, tập đoàn kinh tế (có hoạt động hợp nhất kinh doanh) phải lập và trình bày BCTC HN
không? Do you agree establishment a separate system of accounting standard for a corporation or economic
group that have the business combination, inter-transaction and must to prepare CFSs?
19.1. Không/No-Tại sao/Why?
…………………………………………………..…………………………
………………………………………………………………………………….
19.2.Có/Yes- Tại sao / Why?
…………………………………………………..…………………………
………………………………………………………………………………….
Câu 20-Q20: Hiện nay tại Việt nam, hệ thống pháp lý về kế toán đều do Chính phủ soạn thảo và
ban hành. Theo Ông/Bà, như vậy có phù hợp với việc hội nhập kế toán quốc tế không?/Currently,
the accounting regulation system in Vietnam has been set by government. Do you think this characteristic is
appropriate option for international integration of accounting sector?
20.1. Có/yes-Tại sao / Why?………………………………………………………
…………………………………………………..…………………………
………………………………………………………………………………….
…………………………………………………..…………………………
Câu 21-Q21. Ông/Bà có ủng hộ ý kiến Chính phủ nên giao việc ban hành hệ thống văn bản kế toán
dưới luật cho hội nghề nghiệp độc lập/ How do you think about the opinion that the Vietnamese
government should move their role of setting the accounting regulation under law to independent association of
professional accountancy?
21.1. Hoàn toàn ủng hộ/absolutely agree
21.2. Ủng hộ/agree
21.3. Không ủng hộ/disagree
21.4. Không có ý kiến/no information
21.5. Khác/Others:……………………………………………………………………………
……………………………………………………………………………………………
……………………………………………………………………………………..…
Câu 22-Q22: Xét tổng thể, theo Ông/Bà vấn đề khó khăn hiện nay của đối TCT/tập đoàn trong việc
lập và trình bày BCTC tổng hợp hay BCTCHN là gì? Tại sao? In your opinion, what are disadvantages of
preparing and disclosure CFSs in Vietnam? Why?
178
Đó là thông tư nào/What are guide documents? ……………………………………………
………………………………………….. ……………………………………………
22.2. Trình độ nhân viên nghiệp vụ/ ……………………………………………
Staff knowledge ……………………………………………
22.3. Chính sách quản lý nội bộ/ ……………………………………………
policy of internal control ……………………………………………
22.4. Đặc điểm lĩnh vực kinh doanh/ ……………………………………………
Business characteristic ……………………………………………
22.5.Khác/others…………… ……………………………………………
Câu 23-Q23: Ông/Bà có đề xuất/kiến nghị gì trong việc hoàn thiện công tác lập BCTC hợp nhất của TCT/tập
đoàn kinh tế ?What are your recommendations to improve the quality of CFSs in Vietnam?
23.1. Khung pháp lý/ Legal framework………………………………………………………….
……………………………………………………………………….……………………
……………………………………………………………………….……………………
……………………………………………………………………….……………………
……………………………………………………………………….……………………
23.2. Chính sách quản lý / management policy: ……………………………………………..
……………………………………………………………………….……………………
……………………………………………………………………….……………………
……………………………………………………………………….……………………
…………………………………………………………………….……………………
23.3. Khác/Others…………………………………………………………………………
……………………………………………………………………….……………………
……………………………………………………………………….……………………
Trân trọng cảm ơn/Thank you very much!
179
ANNEX 10: Questionnaire - Type 2
Câu 3-Q3.Đơn vị của Ông/bà thuộc loại hình nào theo cách phân loại dưới đây/ What is your
organization in the below categories?
3.1. Công ty mẹ /Parent company: (detail………………………..…………………………..
3.2. Công ty con/Subsidiary company: (detail………………………....…………………………..
3.3. Khác/Other: (detail……………………………..…………………………..
…………………………………………………………………………………………………….
Câu 4-Q4. Lĩnh vực kinh doanh của đơn vị Ông/ bà là gì?What is your organization in the below categories?
4.1. Sản xuất /Manufactory: (detail………………………..…………………………..
4.2. Thương mại/Commerce/Trade: (detail………………………....…………………………..
4.3. Dịch vụ/Service: (detail………………………....………………………….)
4.4. Khác/Others: (detail……………………………..…………………………..
…………………………………………………………………………………………………….
Câu 5-Q5:Mặt hàng hay dịch vụ kinh doanh chính của đơn vị Ông/Bà là gì? Please, note the main
products/goods or service that your company is doing business?:
…………………………………………………………………………………………………….
…………………………………………………………………………………………………….
Câu 6-Q6:Thị trường kinh doanh chính của đơn vị Ông/ Bà là gì?Please, note the main market of your corporation/group?:
Thị trường đầu vào/Input market Thị trường đầu ra/Output market
6.1. Nội địa/Domestic: (detail……………) 6.1. Nội địa/Domestic: (detail………………)
6.2. Nhập khẩu/Foreign: (detail……………) 6.2. Nhập khẩu/Foreign: (detail……………)
6.3. Khác/Others: (detail……………….. 6.3. Khác/Others: (detail………………..
………………………………………… ………………………………………
Câu 7-Q7. Đơn vị Ông/Bà có bao nhiêu chi nhánh/công ty con hạch toán độc lập? How many
branch/subsidiary company in your corporation/group?:
7.1. Có 1 7.3 Có 4-5
7.2. Có 2-3 7.4. Có >5: cụ thể (detail):…………..
Trong đó có chi nhánh hạch toán độc lập ở nước ngoài không?Are there any branch or subsidiaries
outside Vietnam in your group/corporation?
10
Không nhất thiết trả lớn/Don’t necessary answer!
180
7.5. Không/No
7.6. Có /Yes: (Số lượng/quantity:………….Ở đâu/where:…………………………..)
Câu 8- Q8. Đơn vị ông bà hiện lựa chọn loại BCTC nào sau đây để phản ánh thông tin tài chinh cho
toàn bộ TCT hay tập đoàn (bao gồm cả những đơn vị thàn viên)/ what kind of financial reports in the
below categories are prepared for the whole your corporation or group?
8.1. BCTC hợp nhất /Consolidated Financial statements (CFSs)
=>chuyển đến câu 9/move to Q9
8.2. BCTC tổng hợp ?General Financial statements (GFSs)
Vì sao đơn vị ông bà lại không chọn lập BCTCHN để phản ánh thông tin tài chính cho toàn bộ TCT
hay tập đoàn /Why enterprises don’t chose CFSs? Có thể lựa chọn nhiều đáp án/ multi-choice answers
8.2.1. BCTC HN đỏi hỏi chuyên môn sâu/ Need more specific knowledge in accounting
8.2.2. BCTC tổng hợp đơn giản hơn/ prepare GFSs is more simple than CFSs
8.2.3. Thiếu cán bộ đủ chuyên môn/ lack of academic accountants/staffs
8.2.4. Có nhiều quy định khác nhau trong khung pháp lý/many different options in legal framework
8.2.5. Nhận thức của cán bộ quản lý/the limited knowledge of managers
8.2.6. Khác/others: (detail…………………………………………………….)
…………………………………….…………………………………………………….………
………………………………………………………………….………………………….
8.3. Khác/others…………
Câu 9-Q9: Theo Ông bà, BCTC chung/tổng hợp và BCTC HN có khác nhau không? Khác ở điểm nào?
9.1. Không / No
9.2. Có/Yes
9.2.1. Có/yes. Khác ở điểm nào?What are the differences?
Điểm khác biệt BCTC chung/general BCTCHN/
financial reports CFSs
9.2.1.HÌnh thức/Format ……… ……
9.2.2. Đơn vị áp dụng?Applicants ……… ……
9.2.3.Nội dung/Contents ……… ……
9.2.4.Khác/Others………… ……… ……
9.2.2. Không có thông tin/No information
Câu 11-Q11. Đối tượng nhận BCTCHN của đơn vị Ông/bà hiện nay là những ai hay tổ chức
nào?/Who or What organization does your company need to submit CFSs? (chọn nhiều đáp án/multi-choices)
11.1. Cơ quan thuế? Taxation office 11.5. Hội đồng quản trị/ Managers
11.2. Cơ quan chứng khoán/Security Office 11.6. Ngân hàng-Bank/Creditors
11.3. Cơ quan thống kê/Statistic Office 11.7. Nhà đầu tư, cổ đông?
11.4.Cơ quan cấp phép KD? Authority Office Investors/Shareholders
11.9. Sở tài chính/ Financial institutions 11.8. Đơn vị kiểm toán/Auditing Office
11.11 Khác/Others: ……..……………..…………. 11.10. Bộ tài chính/MOF
…………………………………………….
181
12.1. Thuê ngoài (hire the academic service)
- Đối tượng thuê ngoài của đơn vị Ông/bà là cá nhân hay tổ chức?
12.1. 1 Công ty dịch vụ kế toán/kiểm toán (a business of Accounting/Auditing service)
- Loại hình đơn vị được thuê: (What is your hire business in the below categories)
12.1. 1. Đơn vị nước ngoài/Foreign enterprise: (detail……………………………)
12.1. 2. Đơn vị nội địa/Vietnamese enterprise: (detail……………………………)
12.1. 3. Khác/Others: (detail…………………………………….………..……)
12.1.2. Cá nhân (the professional accountants/auditors)
- Loại hình chuyên gia được thuê /Who is your hire in the below categories?:
12.1.2.1. Chuyên gia nước ngoài/Foreigners: (detail…………………………)
12.1.2.2. Chuyên gia Việt nam/Vietnamese: (detail……………………………)
12.1.2.3. Khác/Others: (detail……………………………………………..……)
12.1.3.Khác/Others……………………………………………. ………
- Phí dịch vụ ước tính thuê ngoài: (the cost of service)
12.1.4.1. So % tổng chi phí KD trong kỳ /the rate of total cost: (detail……………………)
12.1.4.2. So % tổng doanh thu KD trong kỳ/the rate of revenue: (detail……………………)
- Đơn vị phải chuẩn bị nội dung hay tài liệu gì cho việc lập BCTCHN khi thuê ngoài? Have to
supply any document for preparing CFSs by the academic service?
12.1.5.1. Tất cả các chứng từ kế toán/all receipts, accounting vouchers
12.1.5.2. Tất cả các sổ kế toán/ all accounting books
12.1.5.3. Tất cả BCTC riêng/all individual financial reports
12.1.5.4. Cả 3 loại tài liệu trên/ include the previous answers (12.1.5.1->12.1.5.3)
12.1.5.6. Không phải cung cấp tài liệu gì/ no document for supplying
12.1.5.7. Khác/Others……………………………………………. ………
- Vì sao đơn vị thuê ngoài: (Why hire the academic service)
……….………………..……………………………………….………………..…………….………
………..……………………………………….………………..…………….………………..…………
…………………………….………………..…………….………………..………………………………
………
->Chuyển đên câu 13
12.2. Tự lập BCTCHN/self-prepare CFSs
- Đơn vị có tổ chức bộ phận lập BCTCHN riêng không?
12.2.1.Có tổ chức riêng bộ phận hợp nhất/Organize the specific group for making CFSs:
- Số nhân viên trong bộ phận/How many staffs are in the group?:
12.2.1.1: 01 nhân viên/one staff
12.2.1.2: 02 nhân viên/2 staffs
12.2.1.3: 03 nhân viên/3 staffs
12.2.1.4: trên 03 nhân viên/more than 3 staffs (cụ thể/quality………)
- Số nhân viên có chứng chỉ CPA: (How many are CPA in the group?)
Tổng số lượng/total quantity Vietnamese or foreign CPA
VACPA Foreign CPA
11.2.1.5: 01 nhân viên/one staff ……….. …………
11.2.1.6: 02 nhân viên/2 staffs ……….. ………..
11.2.1.7: 03 nhân viên/3 staffs ……….. ………..
11.2.1.8. trên 3 nhân viên/ more than 3 staffs ……….. ………..
12.2.2. Không tổ chức riêng bộ phận hợp nhất: (No specific group for making CFSs)
12.2.3. Khác (Others):…………………………………………….
-Căn cứ vào tài liệu nào để lập/what document does your company use to prepare CFSs?
12.2.4. BCTC riêng của các đơn vị/individual financial statements
12.2.5. Bảng tổng hợp các bút toán điều chỉnh/worksheet of adjustment entries .
12.2.6. Bảng tổng hợp chỉ tiêu hợp nhất/ Summary information of combination
12.2.7. Cả 3 loại tài liệu trên/ include the previous answers (12.2.4->12.2.6)
12.2.8. Khác/Others: (detail……………………………………………………………..……)
Câu 13-Q13: Khi nào đơn vị Ông(Bà) lập BCTC HN? /When does your company prepare CFSs?
13.1. Tại thời điểm đạt được quyền kiểm soát/the date of acquisition
13.2. Theo định kỳ
13.2.1.Giữa niên độ (06 tháng/lần)- 6 months/time
182
13.2.2. Cuối năm tài chính (12 tháng/lần)-12 months/time
13.2.3. Giữa niên độ và cuối năm tài chính- Both the two previous answers
13.2.4. Khác/Others: (detail………………………………..……)
13.3. Cả hai đáp án 13.1.and 13.2/include both 13.1 and 13.2
13.4. Khác/Others: (detail………………………………..……)
Câu 14-Q14. Cán bộ nghiệp vụ của đơn vị Ông/bà có được bổi dưỡng hoặc đào tạo về lập BCTCHN
không? Have got any specific training course or program for accountant in order to prepare CFSs in your company?
14.1.Có /yes:
- Đó là các khóa học hoặc chương trình bổi dưỡng, đào tạo nào?/Which kind of training course were organized?:
14.1.1. Tập huấn nghiệp vụ, cập nhật kiến thức/Up date the new regulation
14.1.2. Hành nghề kế toán, kiểm toán/ CPA
14.1.3. Khác/Others: (detail………………………………..……)
- Do đơn vị hoặc cá nhân nào sau đây thực hiện? Who or which organization plays the trainer?
14.1.4. Hội nghề nghiệp độc lập/independent association of professional accountancy?
14.1.5. Hội kế toán Việt Nam/Vietnam Accounting and Auditing Association
14.1.6. Đơn vị đào tạo của BTC/Academic institution of MOF
14.1.7. Các trường đại học chuyên ngành/Accounting University
14.1.8. Tất cả các phương án trên/includeall four previous answers
14.1.9. Khác/others: (detail…………………………………………………….)
14.2.Không /No:
Tại sao/Why?: ………………………………….………………..……………………………
……….………………..……………………………………….………………..……
Câu 15-Q15. Đơn vị Ông/bà có chính sách hay quy định nội bộ về việc lập BCTC HN không? Are
there any the internal-regulations issued by your company for preparing CFSs?
15.1. Không/No
Vì sao/Why?: ………………………….…………………………..……)
->Chuyển đến câu 16
15.2.Có/Yes. Đó là những quy đình gì?/What are your internal regulations?
Đơn vị áp dụng/Applying for area
Main regulations Tất cả đơn vi/ Đơn vị đặc thù/
All entities Separate entity
15.2.1. Mẫu biểu: Form of document s
15.2.2. Thời gian nộp/ Duration
Cụ thể/detail:………………………………….
15.2.3. Phương pháp kế toán (hàng tồn kho, TSCĐ, …)
–Accoutingmethod(for inventory, fixassets,….
15.2.3. Chỉ tiêu nghiệp vụ/ specific information
- Giá vốn hàng bán (công khai)
- Giá bán nội bộ, giá bán thông thường
- Lãi nội bộ
- Giá trị đầu tư công ty con
- Giá trị đầu tư công ty liên kết
- Bán TSCĐ nội bộ
- CHuyển hàng tồn kho thành TSCĐ nội bộ
-Trình bày lợi ích cổ đông thiểu số
- Cho vay nội bộ
- Phải thu,Phải trả nội bộ
- Phí quản lý
-Khác/other:………………………………….
Câu 16-Q16. Các chính sách hay quy định nội bộ về việc lập BCTC HN của đơn vị Ông/bà dựa trên
căn cứ nào? What are documents of regulation that the internal-regulations are based on in your company?
.16.1. Khung pháp lý hiện hành/the current legal framework
.16.2. Đặc điểm hoạt động sản xuất của đơn vị/thecharacteristics of business
.16.3. Cả hai đáp án trên/include the two previous answers
.16.4. Khác/Others: (detail………………………………..……)
183
- Ai hoặc bộ phận nào đóng vai trò xây dựng nội dung chính sách nội bộ?/Who or which departments
set up the internal-regulations?:
.16.5.Bộ phận kế toán, kiểm toán/ accountant department
.16.6. Bộ phận kiểm soát/ control department
.16.7. Bộ phận quản trị/ department of management
.16.8. Thuê ngoài/consulted service
.16.9. Khác/Others: (detail………………………………..……)
Câu 17-Q17. Hệ thống BCTCHN của đơn vị Ông/Bà gồm những gì?/What includes your system of
CFSs?
17.1. Bảng cân đối kế toán hợp nhất/Statement of Consolidated financial
17.2. Báo cáo KQKD hợp nhất/ statements of consolidated income
17.3. Báo cáo lưu chuyển tiền tệ hợp nhất/ statements of consolidated Cash flow
17.4. Thuyết minh BCTC hợp nhất/ Notes to consolidated financial statements
17.5. Khác/Others: (detail………………………….…………………………..……)
184
19.3. Cộng hợp, loại trừ và điều chỉnh toàn bộ-subtotal, elimination and adjustment in full
19.4. Khác/Others: (detail………………………….…………………………..……)
Câu 20-Q20: Tại đơn vị Ông/bà có phát sinh các khoản đầu tư vào công ty liên kết không? Does your
company have any investments in subsidiary, associates or jointly control entities?
20.1. Không/No->Chuyển đến câu 21/move to Q21
20.2.Có/Yes.
- Tại thời điểm đầu tư, giá trị khoản đầu tư này được đánh giá theo phương pháp nào? On the
date of acquisition, which measure is applied to access the valued investment?
20.2.1. Phương pháp giá gốc/ the pooling method
20.2.2. Phương pháp giá mua/the purchase method
20.2.3. Khác/others: ………………………………………………………………
-Tại thời điểm lập BCTCHN giá trị khoản đầu tư này được trình bày theo phương pháp nào?
On the date of preparing CFSs, what method is applied to access the valuation of investment?
20.2.4. Phương pháp giá vốn/ the cost method
20.2.5. Phương pháp vốn chủ sở hữu/the equity method
20.2.6. Khác/others: ………………………………………………………………
-Khi lập BCTCHN giá trị khoản đầu tư này được xử lý như thế nào? On the date of preparing
CFSs, what entry is applied to account the valued investment?
Chỉ tiêu Loại trừ Điều
hoàn toàn chỉnh
.20.2.7.Lãi và lỗ sau ngày đầu tư trong đơn vị đầu từ đã ghi nhận từ các kỳ trước
.20.2.8. Lãi/lỗ trong kỳ báo cáo /currentyearprofit/loss
.20.2.9. Chênh lệch phát sinh khi mua khoản đầu tư /deferenceofacquiredtransaction
.20.2.10. Giá trị thay đổi trong vốn chủ sở hữu của đầu tư
-Tại thời điểm lập BCTCHN giá trị cổ tức được chia từ lợi nhuận khoản đầu tư sau ngày mua
được xử lý như thế nào? On the date of preparing CFSs, How treat the received earning and profit
in the subsidiary’s investment?
20.2.11.Cộng hợp thuần túy-Subtotal entries
20.2.12. Loại trừ toàn bộ/elimination in full
20.2.13. Cộng hợp, loại trừ và điều chỉnh-subtotal, elimination and adjustment
20.2.14. Khác/Others: (detail………………………….………………………)
Câu 21- Q21.Tại đơn vị Ông/bà có phát sinh các lợi thế thương mại không? Have got the goodwill in your corporation?
21.1. Không/No. Tại sao/Why?…………………………………………………………
->Chuyển đến câu 22
21.2.Có/Yes.
-Khi nào phát sinh/ When do happen?
21.2.1. Khi đầu tư vào công ty con/liên kết- investments in subsidiary, associates or jointly control entities
21.2.2. Khi loại trừ khoản đầu tư trong công ty con/eliminate investment in subsidiary’s again
21.2.3. Khác/others: ………………………………………………………………
-Phát sinh những loại nào?/What kind of goodwill has?
21.2.5. Lợi thế thương mại /positive goodwill
- Tại thời điểm phát sinh, được ghi nhận như thế nào? How is the goodwill
entry on the accounting books?
21.2.5.1. Đầu tư tài chính dài hạn/ long term investment
21.2.5.2. Tài sản cố định /long-term assets
21.2.5.3. Chi phí hoạt động kinh doanh/operatingexpense
21.2.5.4. Thu nhậphoat động kinh doanh/income
21.2.5.5. Khác/others: ……………………………………
21.2.6. Bất lợi thương mại/ bargain on purchase
- Tại thời điểm phát sinh, được ghi nhận như thế nào? How is the goodwill
entry on the accounting books?
21.2.5.1. Đầu tư tài chính dài hạn/ long term investment
21.2.5.2. Tài sản cố định /long-term assets
21.2.5.3. Chi phí hoạt động kinh doanh/ operating expense
21.2.5.4. Thu nhậphoat động kinh doanh/income
21.2.5.5. Khác/others: ……………………………………
185
21.2.7. Cả hai loại trên/both of negative and positive goodwill
- Khi lập BCTCHN giá trị lợi thế thương mại được trình bày trên loại báo cáo nào? Which
financial reports is the goodwill disclosure?
21.2.8. Bảng cân đối kế toán hợp nhất/ consolidated worksheets
21.2.9. Báo cáo KQKD hợp nhất/ consolidated income statements
21.2.10. Cả hai đáp án trên/include all previous answers
21.2.11. Khác/others: ………………………………………………………………
-Giá trị lợi thế thương mại được xử lý như thế nào sau ghi nhận ban đầu? How account the
goodwill after the date of acquisition?
21.2.11. Phân bổ dần/ amortization of historical-cost
21.2.12. Đánh giá suy giảm-impairment loss
21.2.13. Khác/others: ………………………………………………………………
Câu 22-Q22: Tại đơn vị Ông/bà có phát sinh các giao dịch nội bộ (không phải đầu từ vốn) không?
Are there any inter-group transactions in your corporation?
22.1. Không/No->Chuyển đến câu 23
22.2. Có/Yes.
Đó là các giao dich nào và được xử lý ra sao khi lập BCTCHN?What are they and how
consolidated entries are applies?
.22.2.1.Bán hàng nội bộ:Sale goods/products among the entities inside group or corporation
- Các chỉ tiêu sau được xử lý khi lập BCTCHN như thế nào?
Chỉ tiêu Loại trừ Điều
hoàn toàn chỉnh
.22.2.1.1.Doanh thu, giá vốn của hàng tiêu thụ trong kỳ
.22.2.1.2. Lãi/lỗ của giao dịch bán hàng nội bộ trong kỳ
.22.2.1.3. Giá vốn hàng bán và lợi nhuận sau thuế chưa phân phối đầu kỳ
.22.2.1.4. Thuế TNDN do loại trừ lợi nhuận chưa thực hiện trong hàng tồn cuối kỳ
.22.2.1.5. Thuế TNDN do loại trừ lợi nhuận chưa thực hiện trong hàng tồn đầu kỳ
.22.2.1.6. Lãichưathựchiệntronggiaodịch bánhàngnộibộảnhhưởngđếnlợiíchcổđôngTS
186
22.2.4. Chuyển hàng tồn kho thành TSCĐ trong nội bộ tập đoàn
- Các chỉ tiêu sau được xử lý khi lập BCTCHN như thế nào?
Chỉ tiêu Loại trừ Điều
hoàn toàn chỉnh
.22.2.4.1.Doanh thu bán hàng hóa
.22.2.4.2. Giá vốn hàng hóa
.22.2.4.3. Lợi nhuận chưa thực hiện trong nguyên giá TSCĐ của bên mua
.22.2.4.4. Lãi chưa thực hiện trong bán hàng tồn kho của bên bán
.22.2.4.5. Chi phí khấu hao TSCĐ trong kỳ của bên mua
.22.2.4.6. Hao mòn lũy kế do ảnh hưởng của lãi chưa thực hiện trong giá trị của TSCĐ bên
mua
22.2.5. Các khoản phải thu, phải trả nội bộ
22.2.4.1. Loại trừ hoàn toàn / elimination in full
22.2.4.2. Không loại trừ/do not eliminate and adjust
22.2.4.3. Khác/others: ………………………………………………………
22.2.6. Cổ tức được chia từ lợi nhuận sau ngày mua:
22.2.7. Phí quản lý nội bộ
22.2.8. Khác/others: ………………………………………………………………
Câu 23-Q23:Theo Ông/bà, chỉ tiêu lợi ích cổ đông thiểu số khi quyền kiểm soát được thiết lập nên được xác
định như thế nào? In your opinion, how is the non-controlling interest accounted on the date of acquisition?
23.1.Tài sản thuần theo giá trị hợp lý của đơn vị bị mua (không bao gồm LTTM khi đầu tư)/following the net value
of assets
23.2. Giá trị hợp lý(bao gồm LTTM khi đầu tư)/following the fair value of assets
23.3. Khác/others (cụ thể/detail): ……………………..……………………………
-Khi lập BCTC hợp nhất, theo ông/bà chỉ tiêu lợi ích cổ đông thiểu số nên được xác định theo phương
pháp nào? In your opinion, how should account the non-controlling interest on the date of preparing CFSs?
23.4. Phương pháp chuẩn/ benchmark method
23.5. Phương pháp thay thế/allowable method
23.6. Khác/others (cụ thể/detail): ……………………..……………………………
-Khi trình bày Bảng cân đối kế toán hợp nhất, theo Ông/Bà, chỉ tiêu lợi ích cổ đông thiểu số
được trình bày như thế nào? In your opinion, how disclosure the non-controlling interest on CFSs?
23.7. Nơ phải trả/the liability
23.8. Vốn chủ sở hữu nhưng không tách biệt/ the equity
23.9. Vốn chủ sở hữu nhưng tách biệt/ separate criteria in the equity of the parent entity
23.10. Một chỉ tiêu riêng nằm giữa vốn chủ sở hữu và nợ phải trả/separatecriteriaisputbetweentheliabilityandequity
23.11. Khác/others(cụ thể/detail): ……………………..……………………………
Câu 24-Q24: Tại đơn vị Ông/bà có phát sinh nghiệp vụ thoái vốn hay đầu tư thêm không? Does your
corporation have any transference of investment?
24.1. Không/No =>Chuyển đến câu 25
24.2. Có/Yes.
- Kể tên hoạt động phát sinh? Which transaction is in the below categories?
24.2.1. Chuyển nhượng nội bộ/ transfer inside corporation
24.2.2. Chuyển nhượng cho đơn vị bên ngoài/transfer outside corporation
24.2.3. Đầu tư thêm vào công ty con, công ty liên kết/ extra investment in the in subsidiary,
associates or jointly control entities
24.2.4. Khác/others (cụ thể/detail): ……………………..……………………………
-Khi trình bày BCTCHN, những chỉ tiêu nào sao đây phải được loại trừ hoặc điều chỉnh do ảnh
hưởng của hoạt động chuyển nhượng? Which criteria in the below categories are eliminated and adjusted
on the date of preparing CFSs ?
24.2.4. Vốn đầu tư tại công ty con, công ty liên kết/ investments in subsidiary, associates or jointly control entities
24.2.5. Lợi nhuận chưa phân phối/
24.2.6. Phải thu, phải trả nội bộ
24.2.7. Doanh thu, chi phí hoạt động tài chính
24.2.8. Lợi thế thương mại
24.2.9. Cả 5 phương án trên/ include five previous answers
24.2.10. Khác/others (cụ thể/detail): ……………………..……………………………
187
Câu 25-Q25: Tại đơn vị Ông/bà đã từng có sự kiện nào phát sinh sau ngày lập BCTC mà ảnh hưởng
đến thông tin trình bày BCTCHN không? There were any transactions that happen after making CFSs and
influence on the information of CFSs in your corporation/group?
25.1. Không/ No
25.2. Có/Yes
- Đó là các hiện tượng gì? Xảy ra khi nào?/What were they/ When did they happen?
…………………………………………………………………………………………………….
…………………………………………………………………………………………………….
…………………………………………………………………………………………………….
Câu 26-Q26: Theo Ông/Bà vấn đề khó khăn hiện nay của đơn vị mình khi lập BCTCHN là gì? Tại
sao?.In your opinion, What are the obstacles to prepare CFSs? Why?
Điểm khó khăn/Obstacles Nội dung hoặc lý do/reasons
26.1.Khung pháp lý/legal framework: ……………………………………………
Cụ thể là gi/detail?
26.1.1.Luật kế toán/Law ……………………………………………
Cụ thể nội dung/detail?
26.1.11.Nguyên tắc giá gốc/ principaloforiginal cost ……………………………………………
26.1.1.2. Không rõ đơn vị bắt buộc lập ……………………………………………
BCTCHN/Who must to prepare CFSs ……………………………………………
26.1.1.2. Khác/others ………………. ……………………………………………
……………………………………….. ……………………………………………
26.1.2. Chuẩn mực kế toán: VASs ……………………………………………
Đó là chuẩn mực nào/What are standards? ……………………………………………
26.1.2.1.VAS 11. ……………………………………………
26.1.2.2.VAS 25. ……………………………………………
26.1.2.2.VAS 21. ……………………………………………
26.1.2.2.Khác/Others. ……………………………………………
26.1.3. Thông tư hướng dẫn: Guide for implementation ……………………………………………
Đó là chuẩn mực nào/What are guide documents? ……………………………………………
………………………………………….. ……………………………………………
26.2.Trình độ nhân viên nghiệp vụ/ ……………………………………………
Staff knowledge ……………………………………………
26.3. Chính sách quản lý nội bộ/ ……………………………………………
policy of internal control ……………………………………………
26.4. Đặc điểm lĩnh vực kinh doanh/ ……………………………………………
Business characteristic ……………………………………………
26.5.Khác/others…………… ……………………………………………
…………………………………………
Câu 27-Q27: Theo Ông/Bà thông tin trên BCTCHN của đơn vị đã cung cấp thời gian vừa qua như
thế nào? In your opinion, how is the quality of financial information that your corporation did supply on CFSs?.
(có thẻ chọn nhiều đáp án)
27.1 Điểm tích cực/Advantages 27.2 Điểm không tíc cực và lý do
disadvantages reasons
27.1 1.kịp thời/Timeless 27.1 1.không kịp thời/un-timeless ……………………………
27.1.2. đầy đủ/fulless 27.1.2. Không đầy đủ/-unfull ……………………………
27.1.3.Đáng tin cậy/faithful 27.1.3.Không Đáng tin cậy/faithless ……………………………
27.1.4.Trung thực/honesty 27.1.4.Không Trung thực/ ……………………………
27.1.5.Khác /others………… 27.1.5.Khác /others ……………………………
188
Câu 28-Q28: Ông/Bà có đề xuất/kiến nghị gì trong việc hoàn thiện công tác lập BCTC HN của TCT/tập đoàn
kinh tế ? What are your recommendations?
28.1. Khung pháp lý/ Legal framework………………………………………………………….
……………………………………………………………………….……………………
……………………………………………………………………….……………………
……………………………………………………………………….……………………
……………………………………………………………………….……………………
……………………………………………………………………….……………………
……………………………………………………………………….……………………
……………………………………………………………………….……………………
……………………………………………………………………….……………………
……………………………………………………………………….……………………
28.2. Chính sách quản lý / management policy: ……………………………………………..
……………………………………………………………………….……………………
……………………………………………………………………….……………………
……………………………………………………………………….……………………
……………………………………………………………………….……………………
……………………………………………………………………….……………………
……………………………………………………………………….……………………
……………………………………………………………………….……………………
……………………………………………………………………….……………………
……………………………………………………………………….……………………
28.3. Khác/Others…………………………………………………………………………
……………………………………………………………………….……………………
……………………………………………………………………….……………………
……………………………………………………………………….……………………
……………………………………………………………………….……………………
……………………………………………………………………….……………………
……………………………………………………………………….……………………
……………………………………………………………………….……………………
\Xin trân trọng cảm ơn/Thank you so much for your time!
189